OpenCores
URL https://opencores.org/ocsvn/openrisc/openrisc/trunk

Subversion Repositories openrisc

[/] [openrisc/] [trunk/] [gnu-old/] [gdb-7.1/] [bfd/] [elf32-xtensa.c] - Blame information for rev 819

Go to most recent revision | Details | Compare with Previous | View Log

Line No. Rev Author Line
1 227 jeremybenn
/* Xtensa-specific support for 32-bit ELF.
2
   Copyright 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
3
   Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
 
5
   This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
 
7
   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
8
   modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
9
   published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the
10
   License, or (at your option) any later version.
11
 
12
   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
13
   WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14
   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
15
   General Public License for more details.
16
 
17
   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18
   along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19
   Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
20
   02110-1301, USA.  */
21
 
22
#include "sysdep.h"
23
#include "bfd.h"
24
 
25
#include <stdarg.h>
26
#include <strings.h>
27
 
28
#include "bfdlink.h"
29
#include "libbfd.h"
30
#include "elf-bfd.h"
31
#include "elf/xtensa.h"
32
#include "xtensa-isa.h"
33
#include "xtensa-config.h"
34
 
35
#define XTENSA_NO_NOP_REMOVAL 0
36
 
37
/* Local helper functions.  */
38
 
39
static bfd_boolean add_extra_plt_sections (struct bfd_link_info *, int);
40
static char *vsprint_msg (const char *, const char *, int, ...) ATTRIBUTE_PRINTF(2,4);
41
static bfd_reloc_status_type bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc
42
  (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
43
static bfd_boolean do_fix_for_relocatable_link
44
  (Elf_Internal_Rela *, bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *);
45
static void do_fix_for_final_link
46
  (Elf_Internal_Rela *, bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, bfd_vma *);
47
 
48
/* Local functions to handle Xtensa configurability.  */
49
 
50
static bfd_boolean is_indirect_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode);
51
static bfd_boolean is_direct_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode);
52
static bfd_boolean is_windowed_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode);
53
static xtensa_opcode get_const16_opcode (void);
54
static xtensa_opcode get_l32r_opcode (void);
55
static bfd_vma l32r_offset (bfd_vma, bfd_vma);
56
static int get_relocation_opnd (xtensa_opcode, int);
57
static int get_relocation_slot (int);
58
static xtensa_opcode get_relocation_opcode
59
  (bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
60
static bfd_boolean is_l32r_relocation
61
  (bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
62
static bfd_boolean is_alt_relocation (int);
63
static bfd_boolean is_operand_relocation (int);
64
static bfd_size_type insn_decode_len
65
  (bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type, bfd_size_type);
66
static xtensa_opcode insn_decode_opcode
67
  (bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type, bfd_size_type, int);
68
static bfd_boolean check_branch_target_aligned
69
  (bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type, bfd_vma, bfd_vma);
70
static bfd_boolean check_loop_aligned
71
  (bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type, bfd_vma, bfd_vma);
72
static bfd_boolean check_branch_target_aligned_address (bfd_vma, int);
73
static bfd_size_type get_asm_simplify_size
74
  (bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type, bfd_size_type);
75
 
76
/* Functions for link-time code simplifications.  */
77
 
78
static bfd_reloc_status_type elf_xtensa_do_asm_simplify
79
  (bfd_byte *, bfd_vma, bfd_vma, char **);
80
static bfd_reloc_status_type contract_asm_expansion
81
  (bfd_byte *, bfd_vma, Elf_Internal_Rela *, char **);
82
static xtensa_opcode swap_callx_for_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode);
83
static xtensa_opcode get_expanded_call_opcode (bfd_byte *, int, bfd_boolean *);
84
 
85
/* Access to internal relocations, section contents and symbols.  */
86
 
87
static Elf_Internal_Rela *retrieve_internal_relocs
88
  (bfd *, asection *, bfd_boolean);
89
static void pin_internal_relocs (asection *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
90
static void release_internal_relocs (asection *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
91
static bfd_byte *retrieve_contents (bfd *, asection *, bfd_boolean);
92
static void pin_contents (asection *, bfd_byte *);
93
static void release_contents (asection *, bfd_byte *);
94
static Elf_Internal_Sym *retrieve_local_syms (bfd *);
95
 
96
/* Miscellaneous utility functions.  */
97
 
98
static asection *elf_xtensa_get_plt_section (struct bfd_link_info *, int);
99
static asection *elf_xtensa_get_gotplt_section (struct bfd_link_info *, int);
100
static asection *get_elf_r_symndx_section (bfd *, unsigned long);
101
static struct elf_link_hash_entry *get_elf_r_symndx_hash_entry
102
  (bfd *, unsigned long);
103
static bfd_vma get_elf_r_symndx_offset (bfd *, unsigned long);
104
static bfd_boolean is_reloc_sym_weak (bfd *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
105
static bfd_boolean pcrel_reloc_fits (xtensa_opcode, int, bfd_vma, bfd_vma);
106
static bfd_boolean xtensa_is_property_section (asection *);
107
static bfd_boolean xtensa_is_insntable_section (asection *);
108
static bfd_boolean xtensa_is_littable_section (asection *);
109
static bfd_boolean xtensa_is_proptable_section (asection *);
110
static int internal_reloc_compare (const void *, const void *);
111
static int internal_reloc_matches (const void *, const void *);
112
static asection *xtensa_get_property_section (asection *, const char *);
113
extern asection *xtensa_make_property_section (asection *, const char *);
114
static flagword xtensa_get_property_predef_flags (asection *);
115
 
116
/* Other functions called directly by the linker.  */
117
 
118
typedef void (*deps_callback_t)
119
  (asection *, bfd_vma, asection *, bfd_vma, void *);
120
extern bfd_boolean xtensa_callback_required_dependence
121
  (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *, deps_callback_t, void *);
122
 
123
 
124
/* Globally visible flag for choosing size optimization of NOP removal
125
   instead of branch-target-aware minimization for NOP removal.
126
   When nonzero, narrow all instructions and remove all NOPs possible
127
   around longcall expansions.  */
128
 
129
int elf32xtensa_size_opt;
130
 
131
 
132
/* The "new_section_hook" is used to set up a per-section
133
   "xtensa_relax_info" data structure with additional information used
134
   during relaxation.  */
135
 
136
typedef struct xtensa_relax_info_struct xtensa_relax_info;
137
 
138
 
139
/* The GNU tools do not easily allow extending interfaces to pass around
140
   the pointer to the Xtensa ISA information, so instead we add a global
141
   variable here (in BFD) that can be used by any of the tools that need
142
   this information. */
143
 
144
xtensa_isa xtensa_default_isa;
145
 
146
 
147
/* When this is true, relocations may have been modified to refer to
148
   symbols from other input files.  The per-section list of "fix"
149
   records needs to be checked when resolving relocations.  */
150
 
151
static bfd_boolean relaxing_section = FALSE;
152
 
153
/* When this is true, during final links, literals that cannot be
154
   coalesced and their relocations may be moved to other sections.  */
155
 
156
int elf32xtensa_no_literal_movement = 1;
157
 
158
/* Rename one of the generic section flags to better document how it
159
   is used here.  */
160
/* Whether relocations have been processed.  */
161
#define reloc_done sec_flg0
162
 
163
static reloc_howto_type elf_howto_table[] =
164
{
165
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_NONE, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
166
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_NONE",
167
         FALSE, 0, 0, FALSE),
168
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_32, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
169
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_32",
170
         TRUE, 0xffffffff, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
171
 
172
  /* Replace a 32-bit value with a value from the runtime linker (only
173
     used by linker-generated stub functions).  The r_addend value is
174
     special: 1 means to substitute a pointer to the runtime linker's
175
     dynamic resolver function; 2 means to substitute the link map for
176
     the shared object.  */
177
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_RTLD, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
178
         NULL, "R_XTENSA_RTLD", FALSE, 0, 0, FALSE),
179
 
180
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_GLOB_DAT, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
181
         bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_XTENSA_GLOB_DAT",
182
         FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
183
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
184
         bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT",
185
         FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
186
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_RELATIVE, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
187
         bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_XTENSA_RELATIVE",
188
         FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
189
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_PLT, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
190
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_PLT",
191
         FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
192
 
193
  EMPTY_HOWTO (7),
194
 
195
  /* Old relocations for backward compatibility.  */
196
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_OP0, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
197
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_OP0", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
198
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_OP1, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
199
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_OP1", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
200
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_OP2, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
201
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_OP2", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
202
 
203
  /* Assembly auto-expansion.  */
204
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
205
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
206
  /* Relax assembly auto-expansion.  */
207
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
208
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
209
 
210
  EMPTY_HOWTO (13),
211
 
212
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_32_PCREL, 0, 2, 32, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
213
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_32_PCREL",
214
         FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, TRUE),
215
 
216
  /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy.  */
217
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 2, 0, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
218
         NULL, "R_XTENSA_GNU_VTINHERIT",
219
         FALSE, 0, 0, FALSE),
220
  /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage.  */
221
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 2, 0, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
222
         _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn, "R_XTENSA_GNU_VTENTRY",
223
         FALSE, 0, 0, FALSE),
224
 
225
  /* Relocations for supporting difference of symbols.  */
226
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_DIFF8, 0, 0, 8, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
227
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_DIFF8", FALSE, 0, 0xff, FALSE),
228
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_DIFF16, 0, 1, 16, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
229
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_DIFF16", FALSE, 0, 0xffff, FALSE),
230
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_DIFF32, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
231
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_DIFF32", FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
232
 
233
  /* General immediate operand relocations.  */
234
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
235
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
236
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT1_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
237
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT1_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
238
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT2_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
239
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT2_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
240
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT3_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
241
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT3_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
242
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT4_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
243
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT4_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
244
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT5_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
245
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT5_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
246
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT6_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
247
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT6_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
248
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT7_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
249
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT7_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
250
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT8_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
251
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT8_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
252
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT9_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
253
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT9_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
254
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT10_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
255
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT10_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
256
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT11_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
257
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT11_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
258
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT12_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
259
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT12_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
260
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT13_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
261
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT13_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
262
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT14_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
263
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT14_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
264
 
265
  /* "Alternate" relocations.  The meaning of these is opcode-specific.  */
266
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
267
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
268
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT1_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
269
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT1_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
270
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT2_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
271
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT2_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
272
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT3_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
273
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT3_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
274
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT4_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
275
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT4_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
276
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT5_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
277
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT5_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
278
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT6_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
279
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT6_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
280
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT7_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
281
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT7_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
282
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT8_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
283
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT8_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
284
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT9_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
285
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT9_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
286
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT10_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
287
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT10_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
288
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT11_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
289
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT11_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
290
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT12_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
291
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT12_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
292
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT13_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
293
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT13_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
294
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT14_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
295
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT14_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
296
 
297
  /* TLS relocations.  */
298
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
299
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN",
300
         FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
301
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
302
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG",
303
         FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
304
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
305
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF",
306
         FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
307
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
308
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF",
309
         FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
310
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
311
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC",
312
         FALSE, 0, 0, FALSE),
313
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
314
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG",
315
         FALSE, 0, 0, FALSE),
316
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
317
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL",
318
         FALSE, 0, 0, FALSE),
319
};
320
 
321
#if DEBUG_GEN_RELOC
322
#define TRACE(str) \
323
  fprintf (stderr, "Xtensa bfd reloc lookup %d (%s)\n", code, str)
324
#else
325
#define TRACE(str)
326
#endif
327
 
328
static reloc_howto_type *
329
elf_xtensa_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
330
                              bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
331
{
332
  switch (code)
333
    {
334
    case BFD_RELOC_NONE:
335
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_NONE");
336
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_NONE ];
337
 
338
    case BFD_RELOC_32:
339
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_32");
340
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_32 ];
341
 
342
    case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL:
343
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL");
344
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_32_PCREL ];
345
 
346
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_DIFF8:
347
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_DIFF8");
348
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_DIFF8 ];
349
 
350
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_DIFF16:
351
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_DIFF16");
352
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_DIFF16 ];
353
 
354
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_DIFF32:
355
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_DIFF32");
356
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_DIFF32 ];
357
 
358
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_RTLD:
359
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_RTLD");
360
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_RTLD ];
361
 
362
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_GLOB_DAT:
363
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_GLOB_DAT");
364
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_GLOB_DAT ];
365
 
366
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT:
367
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT");
368
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT ];
369
 
370
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_RELATIVE:
371
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_RELATIVE");
372
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_RELATIVE ];
373
 
374
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_PLT:
375
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_PLT");
376
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_PLT ];
377
 
378
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_OP0:
379
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_OP0");
380
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_OP0 ];
381
 
382
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_OP1:
383
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_OP1");
384
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_OP1 ];
385
 
386
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_OP2:
387
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_OP2");
388
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_OP2 ];
389
 
390
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND:
391
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND");
392
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND ];
393
 
394
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY:
395
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY");
396
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY ];
397
 
398
    case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT:
399
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT");
400
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_GNU_VTINHERIT ];
401
 
402
    case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY:
403
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY");
404
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_GNU_VTENTRY ];
405
 
406
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN:
407
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN");
408
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN ];
409
 
410
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG:
411
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG");
412
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG ];
413
 
414
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF:
415
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF");
416
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF ];
417
 
418
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF:
419
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF");
420
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF ];
421
 
422
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC:
423
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC");
424
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC ];
425
 
426
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_ARG:
427
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_ARG");
428
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG ];
429
 
430
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_CALL:
431
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_CALL");
432
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL ];
433
 
434
    default:
435
      if (code >= BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP
436
          && code <= BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_SLOT14_OP)
437
        {
438
          unsigned n = (R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP +
439
                        (code - BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP));
440
          return &elf_howto_table[n];
441
        }
442
 
443
      if (code >= BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT
444
          && code <= BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_SLOT14_ALT)
445
        {
446
          unsigned n = (R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT +
447
                        (code - BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT));
448
          return &elf_howto_table[n];
449
        }
450
 
451
      break;
452
    }
453
 
454
  TRACE ("Unknown");
455
  return NULL;
456
}
457
 
458
static reloc_howto_type *
459
elf_xtensa_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
460
                              const char *r_name)
461
{
462
  unsigned int i;
463
 
464
  for (i = 0; i < sizeof (elf_howto_table) / sizeof (elf_howto_table[0]); i++)
465
    if (elf_howto_table[i].name != NULL
466
        && strcasecmp (elf_howto_table[i].name, r_name) == 0)
467
      return &elf_howto_table[i];
468
 
469
  return NULL;
470
}
471
 
472
 
473
/* Given an ELF "rela" relocation, find the corresponding howto and record
474
   it in the BFD internal arelent representation of the relocation.  */
475
 
476
static void
477
elf_xtensa_info_to_howto_rela (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
478
                               arelent *cache_ptr,
479
                               Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
480
{
481
  unsigned int r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
482
 
483
  BFD_ASSERT (r_type < (unsigned int) R_XTENSA_max);
484
  cache_ptr->howto = &elf_howto_table[r_type];
485
}
486
 
487
 
488
/* Functions for the Xtensa ELF linker.  */
489
 
490
/* The name of the dynamic interpreter.  This is put in the .interp
491
   section.  */
492
 
493
#define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/lib/ld.so"
494
 
495
/* The size in bytes of an entry in the procedure linkage table.
496
   (This does _not_ include the space for the literals associated with
497
   the PLT entry.) */
498
 
499
#define PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 16
500
 
501
/* For _really_ large PLTs, we may need to alternate between literals
502
   and code to keep the literals within the 256K range of the L32R
503
   instructions in the code.  It's unlikely that anyone would ever need
504
   such a big PLT, but an arbitrary limit on the PLT size would be bad.
505
   Thus, we split the PLT into chunks.  Since there's very little
506
   overhead (2 extra literals) for each chunk, the chunk size is kept
507
   small so that the code for handling multiple chunks get used and
508
   tested regularly.  With 254 entries, there are 1K of literals for
509
   each chunk, and that seems like a nice round number.  */
510
 
511
#define PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK 254
512
 
513
/* PLT entries are actually used as stub functions for lazy symbol
514
   resolution.  Once the symbol is resolved, the stub function is never
515
   invoked.  Note: the 32-byte frame size used here cannot be changed
516
   without a corresponding change in the runtime linker.  */
517
 
518
static const bfd_byte elf_xtensa_be_plt_entry[PLT_ENTRY_SIZE] =
519
{
520
  0x6c, 0x10, 0x04,     /* entry sp, 32 */
521
  0x18, 0x00, 0x00,     /* l32r  a8, [got entry for rtld's resolver] */
522
  0x1a, 0x00, 0x00,     /* l32r  a10, [got entry for rtld's link map] */
523
  0x1b, 0x00, 0x00,     /* l32r  a11, [literal for reloc index] */
524
  0x0a, 0x80, 0x00,     /* jx    a8 */
525
 
526
};
527
 
528
static const bfd_byte elf_xtensa_le_plt_entry[PLT_ENTRY_SIZE] =
529
{
530
  0x36, 0x41, 0x00,     /* entry sp, 32 */
531
  0x81, 0x00, 0x00,     /* l32r  a8, [got entry for rtld's resolver] */
532
  0xa1, 0x00, 0x00,     /* l32r  a10, [got entry for rtld's link map] */
533
  0xb1, 0x00, 0x00,     /* l32r  a11, [literal for reloc index] */
534
  0xa0, 0x08, 0x00,     /* jx    a8 */
535
 
536
};
537
 
538
/* The size of the thread control block.  */
539
#define TCB_SIZE        8
540
 
541
struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry
542
{
543
  struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
544
 
545
  bfd_signed_vma tlsfunc_refcount;
546
 
547
#define GOT_UNKNOWN     0
548
#define GOT_NORMAL      1
549
#define GOT_TLS_GD      2       /* global or local dynamic */
550
#define GOT_TLS_IE      4       /* initial or local exec */
551
#define GOT_TLS_ANY     (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_IE)
552
  unsigned char tls_type;
553
};
554
 
555
#define elf_xtensa_hash_entry(ent) ((struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *)(ent))
556
 
557
struct elf_xtensa_obj_tdata
558
{
559
  struct elf_obj_tdata root;
560
 
561
  /* tls_type for each local got entry.  */
562
  char *local_got_tls_type;
563
 
564
  bfd_signed_vma *local_tlsfunc_refcounts;
565
};
566
 
567
#define elf_xtensa_tdata(abfd) \
568
  ((struct elf_xtensa_obj_tdata *) (abfd)->tdata.any)
569
 
570
#define elf_xtensa_local_got_tls_type(abfd) \
571
  (elf_xtensa_tdata (abfd)->local_got_tls_type)
572
 
573
#define elf_xtensa_local_tlsfunc_refcounts(abfd) \
574
  (elf_xtensa_tdata (abfd)->local_tlsfunc_refcounts)
575
 
576
#define is_xtensa_elf(bfd) \
577
  (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
578
   && elf_tdata (bfd) != NULL \
579
   && elf_object_id (bfd) == XTENSA_ELF_DATA)
580
 
581
static bfd_boolean
582
elf_xtensa_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
583
{
584
  return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_xtensa_obj_tdata),
585
                                  XTENSA_ELF_DATA);
586
}
587
 
588
/* Xtensa ELF linker hash table.  */
589
 
590
struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table
591
{
592
  struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
593
 
594
  /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections.  */
595
  asection *sgot;
596
  asection *sgotplt;
597
  asection *srelgot;
598
  asection *splt;
599
  asection *srelplt;
600
  asection *sgotloc;
601
  asection *spltlittbl;
602
 
603
  /* Total count of PLT relocations seen during check_relocs.
604
     The actual PLT code must be split into multiple sections and all
605
     the sections have to be created before size_dynamic_sections,
606
     where we figure out the exact number of PLT entries that will be
607
     needed.  It is OK if this count is an overestimate, e.g., some
608
     relocations may be removed by GC.  */
609
  int plt_reloc_count;
610
 
611
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *tlsbase;
612
};
613
 
614
/* Get the Xtensa ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure.  */
615
 
616
#define elf_xtensa_hash_table(p) \
617
  (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
618
  == XTENSA_ELF_DATA ? ((struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
619
 
620
/* Create an entry in an Xtensa ELF linker hash table.  */
621
 
622
static struct bfd_hash_entry *
623
elf_xtensa_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
624
                              struct bfd_hash_table *table,
625
                              const char *string)
626
{
627
  /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
628
     subclass.  */
629
  if (entry == NULL)
630
    {
631
      entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
632
                                 sizeof (struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry));
633
      if (entry == NULL)
634
        return entry;
635
    }
636
 
637
  /* Call the allocation method of the superclass.  */
638
  entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
639
  if (entry != NULL)
640
    {
641
      struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *eh = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (entry);
642
      eh->tlsfunc_refcount = 0;
643
      eh->tls_type = GOT_UNKNOWN;
644
    }
645
 
646
  return entry;
647
}
648
 
649
/* Create an Xtensa ELF linker hash table.  */
650
 
651
static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
652
elf_xtensa_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
653
{
654
  struct elf_link_hash_entry *tlsbase;
655
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *ret;
656
  bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table);
657
 
658
  ret = bfd_malloc (amt);
659
  if (ret == NULL)
660
    return NULL;
661
 
662
  if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
663
                                      elf_xtensa_link_hash_newfunc,
664
                                      sizeof (struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry),
665
                                      XTENSA_ELF_DATA))
666
    {
667
      free (ret);
668
      return NULL;
669
    }
670
 
671
  ret->sgot = NULL;
672
  ret->sgotplt = NULL;
673
  ret->srelgot = NULL;
674
  ret->splt = NULL;
675
  ret->srelplt = NULL;
676
  ret->sgotloc = NULL;
677
  ret->spltlittbl = NULL;
678
 
679
  ret->plt_reloc_count = 0;
680
 
681
  /* Create a hash entry for "_TLS_MODULE_BASE_" to speed up checking
682
     for it later.  */
683
  tlsbase = elf_link_hash_lookup (&ret->elf, "_TLS_MODULE_BASE_",
684
                                  TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
685
  tlsbase->root.type = bfd_link_hash_new;
686
  tlsbase->root.u.undef.abfd = NULL;
687
  tlsbase->non_elf = 0;
688
  ret->tlsbase = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (tlsbase);
689
  ret->tlsbase->tls_type = GOT_UNKNOWN;
690
 
691
  return &ret->elf.root;
692
}
693
 
694
/* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry.  */
695
 
696
static void
697
elf_xtensa_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
698
                                 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
699
                                 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
700
{
701
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
702
 
703
  edir = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (dir);
704
  eind = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (ind);
705
 
706
  if (ind->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
707
    {
708
      edir->tlsfunc_refcount += eind->tlsfunc_refcount;
709
      eind->tlsfunc_refcount = 0;
710
 
711
      if (dir->got.refcount <= 0)
712
        {
713
          edir->tls_type = eind->tls_type;
714
          eind->tls_type = GOT_UNKNOWN;
715
        }
716
    }
717
 
718
  _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (info, dir, ind);
719
}
720
 
721
static inline bfd_boolean
722
elf_xtensa_dynamic_symbol_p (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
723
                             struct bfd_link_info *info)
724
{
725
  /* Check if we should do dynamic things to this symbol.  The
726
     "ignore_protected" argument need not be set, because Xtensa code
727
     does not require special handling of STV_PROTECTED to make function
728
     pointer comparisons work properly.  The PLT addresses are never
729
     used for function pointers.  */
730
 
731
  return _bfd_elf_dynamic_symbol_p (h, info, 0);
732
}
733
 
734
 
735
static int
736
property_table_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
737
{
738
  const property_table_entry *a = (const property_table_entry *) ap;
739
  const property_table_entry *b = (const property_table_entry *) bp;
740
 
741
  if (a->address == b->address)
742
    {
743
      if (a->size != b->size)
744
        return (a->size - b->size);
745
 
746
      if ((a->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN) != (b->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN))
747
        return ((b->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN)
748
                - (a->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN));
749
 
750
      if ((a->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN)
751
          && (GET_XTENSA_PROP_ALIGNMENT (a->flags)
752
              != GET_XTENSA_PROP_ALIGNMENT (b->flags)))
753
        return (GET_XTENSA_PROP_ALIGNMENT (a->flags)
754
                - GET_XTENSA_PROP_ALIGNMENT (b->flags));
755
 
756
      if ((a->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE)
757
          != (b->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE))
758
        return ((b->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE)
759
                - (a->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE));
760
 
761
      return (a->flags - b->flags);
762
    }
763
 
764
  return (a->address - b->address);
765
}
766
 
767
 
768
static int
769
property_table_matches (const void *ap, const void *bp)
770
{
771
  const property_table_entry *a = (const property_table_entry *) ap;
772
  const property_table_entry *b = (const property_table_entry *) bp;
773
 
774
  /* Check if one entry overlaps with the other.  */
775
  if ((b->address >= a->address && b->address < (a->address + a->size))
776
      || (a->address >= b->address && a->address < (b->address + b->size)))
777
    return 0;
778
 
779
  return (a->address - b->address);
780
}
781
 
782
 
783
/* Get the literal table or property table entries for the given
784
   section.  Sets TABLE_P and returns the number of entries.  On
785
   error, returns a negative value.  */
786
 
787
static int
788
xtensa_read_table_entries (bfd *abfd,
789
                           asection *section,
790
                           property_table_entry **table_p,
791
                           const char *sec_name,
792
                           bfd_boolean output_addr)
793
{
794
  asection *table_section;
795
  bfd_size_type table_size = 0;
796
  bfd_byte *table_data;
797
  property_table_entry *blocks;
798
  int blk, block_count;
799
  bfd_size_type num_records;
800
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs, *irel, *rel_end;
801
  bfd_vma section_addr, off;
802
  flagword predef_flags;
803
  bfd_size_type table_entry_size, section_limit;
804
 
805
  if (!section
806
      || !(section->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
807
      || (section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
808
    {
809
      *table_p = NULL;
810
      return 0;
811
    }
812
 
813
  table_section = xtensa_get_property_section (section, sec_name);
814
  if (table_section)
815
    table_size = table_section->size;
816
 
817
  if (table_size == 0)
818
    {
819
      *table_p = NULL;
820
      return 0;
821
    }
822
 
823
  predef_flags = xtensa_get_property_predef_flags (table_section);
824
  table_entry_size = 12;
825
  if (predef_flags)
826
    table_entry_size -= 4;
827
 
828
  num_records = table_size / table_entry_size;
829
  table_data = retrieve_contents (abfd, table_section, TRUE);
830
  blocks = (property_table_entry *)
831
    bfd_malloc (num_records * sizeof (property_table_entry));
832
  block_count = 0;
833
 
834
  if (output_addr)
835
    section_addr = section->output_section->vma + section->output_offset;
836
  else
837
    section_addr = section->vma;
838
 
839
  internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, table_section, TRUE);
840
  if (internal_relocs && !table_section->reloc_done)
841
    {
842
      qsort (internal_relocs, table_section->reloc_count,
843
             sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela), internal_reloc_compare);
844
      irel = internal_relocs;
845
    }
846
  else
847
    irel = NULL;
848
 
849
  section_limit = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, section);
850
  rel_end = internal_relocs + table_section->reloc_count;
851
 
852
  for (off = 0; off < table_size; off += table_entry_size)
853
    {
854
      bfd_vma address = bfd_get_32 (abfd, table_data + off);
855
 
856
      /* Skip any relocations before the current offset.  This should help
857
         avoid confusion caused by unexpected relocations for the preceding
858
         table entry.  */
859
      while (irel &&
860
             (irel->r_offset < off
861
              || (irel->r_offset == off
862
                  && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) == R_XTENSA_NONE)))
863
        {
864
          irel += 1;
865
          if (irel >= rel_end)
866
            irel = 0;
867
        }
868
 
869
      if (irel && irel->r_offset == off)
870
        {
871
          bfd_vma sym_off;
872
          unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
873
          BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) == R_XTENSA_32);
874
 
875
          if (get_elf_r_symndx_section (abfd, r_symndx) != section)
876
            continue;
877
 
878
          sym_off = get_elf_r_symndx_offset (abfd, r_symndx);
879
          BFD_ASSERT (sym_off == 0);
880
          address += (section_addr + sym_off + irel->r_addend);
881
        }
882
      else
883
        {
884
          if (address < section_addr
885
              || address >= section_addr + section_limit)
886
            continue;
887
        }
888
 
889
      blocks[block_count].address = address;
890
      blocks[block_count].size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, table_data + off + 4);
891
      if (predef_flags)
892
        blocks[block_count].flags = predef_flags;
893
      else
894
        blocks[block_count].flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, table_data + off + 8);
895
      block_count++;
896
    }
897
 
898
  release_contents (table_section, table_data);
899
  release_internal_relocs (table_section, internal_relocs);
900
 
901
  if (block_count > 0)
902
    {
903
      /* Now sort them into address order for easy reference.  */
904
      qsort (blocks, block_count, sizeof (property_table_entry),
905
             property_table_compare);
906
 
907
      /* Check that the table contents are valid.  Problems may occur,
908
         for example, if an unrelocated object file is stripped.  */
909
      for (blk = 1; blk < block_count; blk++)
910
        {
911
          /* The only circumstance where two entries may legitimately
912
             have the same address is when one of them is a zero-size
913
             placeholder to mark a place where fill can be inserted.
914
             The zero-size entry should come first.  */
915
          if (blocks[blk - 1].address == blocks[blk].address &&
916
              blocks[blk - 1].size != 0)
917
            {
918
              (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B(%A): invalid property table"),
919
                                     abfd, section);
920
              bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
921
              free (blocks);
922
              return -1;
923
            }
924
        }
925
    }
926
 
927
  *table_p = blocks;
928
  return block_count;
929
}
930
 
931
 
932
static property_table_entry *
933
elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (property_table_entry *property_table,
934
                                int property_table_size,
935
                                bfd_vma addr)
936
{
937
  property_table_entry entry;
938
  property_table_entry *rv;
939
 
940
  if (property_table_size == 0)
941
    return NULL;
942
 
943
  entry.address = addr;
944
  entry.size = 1;
945
  entry.flags = 0;
946
 
947
  rv = bsearch (&entry, property_table, property_table_size,
948
                sizeof (property_table_entry), property_table_matches);
949
  return rv;
950
}
951
 
952
 
953
static bfd_boolean
954
elf_xtensa_in_literal_pool (property_table_entry *lit_table,
955
                            int lit_table_size,
956
                            bfd_vma addr)
957
{
958
  if (elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (lit_table, lit_table_size, addr))
959
    return TRUE;
960
 
961
  return FALSE;
962
}
963
 
964
 
965
/* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
966
   calculate needed space in the dynamic reloc sections.  */
967
 
968
static bfd_boolean
969
elf_xtensa_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
970
                         struct bfd_link_info *info,
971
                         asection *sec,
972
                         const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
973
{
974
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
975
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
976
  struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
977
  const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
978
  const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
979
 
980
  if (info->relocatable || (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
981
    return TRUE;
982
 
983
  BFD_ASSERT (is_xtensa_elf (abfd));
984
 
985
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
986
  if (htab == NULL)
987
    return FALSE;
988
 
989
  symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
990
  sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
991
 
992
  rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
993
  for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
994
    {
995
      unsigned int r_type;
996
      unsigned long r_symndx;
997
      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
998
      struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *eh;
999
      int tls_type, old_tls_type;
1000
      bfd_boolean is_got = FALSE;
1001
      bfd_boolean is_plt = FALSE;
1002
      bfd_boolean is_tlsfunc = FALSE;
1003
 
1004
      r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
1005
      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
1006
 
1007
      if (r_symndx >= NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr))
1008
        {
1009
          (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: bad symbol index: %d"),
1010
                                 abfd, r_symndx);
1011
          return FALSE;
1012
        }
1013
 
1014
      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
1015
        {
1016
          h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
1017
          while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
1018
                 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1019
            h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
1020
        }
1021
      eh = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (h);
1022
 
1023
      switch (r_type)
1024
        {
1025
        case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN:
1026
          if (info->shared)
1027
            {
1028
              tls_type = GOT_TLS_GD;
1029
              is_got = TRUE;
1030
              is_tlsfunc = TRUE;
1031
            }
1032
          else
1033
            tls_type = GOT_TLS_IE;
1034
          break;
1035
 
1036
        case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG:
1037
          if (info->shared)
1038
            {
1039
              tls_type = GOT_TLS_GD;
1040
              is_got = TRUE;
1041
            }
1042
          else
1043
            {
1044
              tls_type = GOT_TLS_IE;
1045
              if (h && elf_xtensa_hash_entry (h) != htab->tlsbase)
1046
                is_got = TRUE;
1047
            }
1048
          break;
1049
 
1050
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF:
1051
          if (info->shared)
1052
            tls_type = GOT_TLS_GD;
1053
          else
1054
            tls_type = GOT_TLS_IE;
1055
          break;
1056
 
1057
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF:
1058
          tls_type = GOT_TLS_IE;
1059
          if (info->shared)
1060
            info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
1061
          if (info->shared || h)
1062
            is_got = TRUE;
1063
          break;
1064
 
1065
        case R_XTENSA_32:
1066
          tls_type = GOT_NORMAL;
1067
          is_got = TRUE;
1068
          break;
1069
 
1070
        case R_XTENSA_PLT:
1071
          tls_type = GOT_NORMAL;
1072
          is_plt = TRUE;
1073
          break;
1074
 
1075
        case R_XTENSA_GNU_VTINHERIT:
1076
          /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
1077
             Reconstruct it for later use during GC.  */
1078
          if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
1079
            return FALSE;
1080
          continue;
1081
 
1082
        case R_XTENSA_GNU_VTENTRY:
1083
          /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
1084
             used.  Record for later use during GC.  */
1085
          BFD_ASSERT (h != NULL);
1086
          if (h != NULL
1087
              && !bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
1088
            return FALSE;
1089
          continue;
1090
 
1091
        default:
1092
          /* Nothing to do for any other relocations.  */
1093
          continue;
1094
        }
1095
 
1096
      if (h)
1097
        {
1098
          if (is_plt)
1099
            {
1100
              if (h->plt.refcount <= 0)
1101
                {
1102
                  h->needs_plt = 1;
1103
                  h->plt.refcount = 1;
1104
                }
1105
              else
1106
                h->plt.refcount += 1;
1107
 
1108
              /* Keep track of the total PLT relocation count even if we
1109
                 don't yet know whether the dynamic sections will be
1110
                 created.  */
1111
              htab->plt_reloc_count += 1;
1112
 
1113
              if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
1114
                {
1115
                  if (! add_extra_plt_sections (info, htab->plt_reloc_count))
1116
                    return FALSE;
1117
                }
1118
            }
1119
          else if (is_got)
1120
            {
1121
              if (h->got.refcount <= 0)
1122
                h->got.refcount = 1;
1123
              else
1124
                h->got.refcount += 1;
1125
            }
1126
 
1127
          if (is_tlsfunc)
1128
            eh->tlsfunc_refcount += 1;
1129
 
1130
          old_tls_type = eh->tls_type;
1131
        }
1132
      else
1133
        {
1134
          /* Allocate storage the first time.  */
1135
          if (elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) == NULL)
1136
            {
1137
              bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
1138
              void *mem;
1139
 
1140
              mem = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size * sizeof (bfd_signed_vma));
1141
              if (mem == NULL)
1142
                return FALSE;
1143
              elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = (bfd_signed_vma *) mem;
1144
 
1145
              mem = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
1146
              if (mem == NULL)
1147
                return FALSE;
1148
              elf_xtensa_local_got_tls_type (abfd) = (char *) mem;
1149
 
1150
              mem = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size * sizeof (bfd_signed_vma));
1151
              if (mem == NULL)
1152
                return FALSE;
1153
              elf_xtensa_local_tlsfunc_refcounts (abfd)
1154
                = (bfd_signed_vma *) mem;
1155
            }
1156
 
1157
          /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol.  */
1158
          if (is_got || is_plt)
1159
            elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) [r_symndx] += 1;
1160
 
1161
          if (is_tlsfunc)
1162
            elf_xtensa_local_tlsfunc_refcounts (abfd) [r_symndx] += 1;
1163
 
1164
          old_tls_type = elf_xtensa_local_got_tls_type (abfd) [r_symndx];
1165
        }
1166
 
1167
      if ((old_tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) && (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE))
1168
        tls_type |= old_tls_type;
1169
      /* If a TLS symbol is accessed using IE at least once,
1170
         there is no point to use a dynamic model for it.  */
1171
      else if (old_tls_type != tls_type && old_tls_type != GOT_UNKNOWN
1172
               && ((old_tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD) == 0
1173
                   || (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) == 0))
1174
        {
1175
          if ((old_tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) && (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD))
1176
            tls_type = old_tls_type;
1177
          else if ((old_tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD) && (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD))
1178
            tls_type |= old_tls_type;
1179
          else
1180
            {
1181
              (*_bfd_error_handler)
1182
                (_("%B: `%s' accessed both as normal and thread local symbol"),
1183
                 abfd,
1184
                 h ? h->root.root.string : "<local>");
1185
              return FALSE;
1186
            }
1187
        }
1188
 
1189
      if (old_tls_type != tls_type)
1190
        {
1191
          if (eh)
1192
            eh->tls_type = tls_type;
1193
          else
1194
            elf_xtensa_local_got_tls_type (abfd) [r_symndx] = tls_type;
1195
        }
1196
    }
1197
 
1198
  return TRUE;
1199
}
1200
 
1201
 
1202
static void
1203
elf_xtensa_make_sym_local (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1204
                           struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1205
{
1206
  if (info->shared)
1207
    {
1208
      if (h->plt.refcount > 0)
1209
        {
1210
          /* For shared objects, there's no need for PLT entries for local
1211
             symbols (use RELATIVE relocs instead of JMP_SLOT relocs).  */
1212
          if (h->got.refcount < 0)
1213
            h->got.refcount = 0;
1214
          h->got.refcount += h->plt.refcount;
1215
          h->plt.refcount = 0;
1216
        }
1217
    }
1218
  else
1219
    {
1220
      /* Don't need any dynamic relocations at all.  */
1221
      h->plt.refcount = 0;
1222
      h->got.refcount = 0;
1223
    }
1224
}
1225
 
1226
 
1227
static void
1228
elf_xtensa_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1229
                        struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1230
                        bfd_boolean force_local)
1231
{
1232
  /* For a shared link, move the plt refcount to the got refcount to leave
1233
     space for RELATIVE relocs.  */
1234
  elf_xtensa_make_sym_local (info, h);
1235
 
1236
  _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, h, force_local);
1237
}
1238
 
1239
 
1240
/* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
1241
   relocation.  */
1242
 
1243
static asection *
1244
elf_xtensa_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
1245
                         struct bfd_link_info *info,
1246
                         Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
1247
                         struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1248
                         Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
1249
{
1250
  /* Property sections are marked "KEEP" in the linker scripts, but they
1251
     should not cause other sections to be marked.  (This approach relies
1252
     on elf_xtensa_discard_info to remove property table entries that
1253
     describe discarded sections.  Alternatively, it might be more
1254
     efficient to avoid using "KEEP" in the linker scripts and instead use
1255
     the gc_mark_extra_sections hook to mark only the property sections
1256
     that describe marked sections.  That alternative does not work well
1257
     with the current property table sections, which do not correspond
1258
     one-to-one with the sections they describe, but that should be fixed
1259
     someday.) */
1260
  if (xtensa_is_property_section (sec))
1261
    return NULL;
1262
 
1263
  if (h != NULL)
1264
    switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
1265
      {
1266
      case R_XTENSA_GNU_VTINHERIT:
1267
      case R_XTENSA_GNU_VTENTRY:
1268
        return NULL;
1269
      }
1270
 
1271
  return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
1272
}
1273
 
1274
 
1275
/* Update the GOT & PLT entry reference counts
1276
   for the section being removed.  */
1277
 
1278
static bfd_boolean
1279
elf_xtensa_gc_sweep_hook (bfd *abfd,
1280
                          struct bfd_link_info *info,
1281
                          asection *sec,
1282
                          const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
1283
{
1284
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
1285
  struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
1286
  const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, *relend;
1287
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
1288
 
1289
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
1290
  if (htab == NULL)
1291
    return FALSE;
1292
 
1293
  if (info->relocatable)
1294
    return TRUE;
1295
 
1296
  if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
1297
    return TRUE;
1298
 
1299
  symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
1300
  sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
1301
 
1302
  relend = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
1303
  for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel++)
1304
    {
1305
      unsigned long r_symndx;
1306
      unsigned int r_type;
1307
      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
1308
      struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *eh;
1309
      bfd_boolean is_got = FALSE;
1310
      bfd_boolean is_plt = FALSE;
1311
      bfd_boolean is_tlsfunc = FALSE;
1312
 
1313
      r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
1314
      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
1315
        {
1316
          h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
1317
          while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
1318
                 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1319
            h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
1320
        }
1321
      eh = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (h);
1322
 
1323
      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
1324
      switch (r_type)
1325
        {
1326
        case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN:
1327
          if (info->shared)
1328
            {
1329
              is_got = TRUE;
1330
              is_tlsfunc = TRUE;
1331
            }
1332
          break;
1333
 
1334
        case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG:
1335
          if (info->shared)
1336
            is_got = TRUE;
1337
          else
1338
            {
1339
              if (h && elf_xtensa_hash_entry (h) != htab->tlsbase)
1340
                is_got = TRUE;
1341
            }
1342
          break;
1343
 
1344
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF:
1345
          if (info->shared || h)
1346
            is_got = TRUE;
1347
          break;
1348
 
1349
        case R_XTENSA_32:
1350
          is_got = TRUE;
1351
          break;
1352
 
1353
        case R_XTENSA_PLT:
1354
          is_plt = TRUE;
1355
          break;
1356
 
1357
        default:
1358
          continue;
1359
        }
1360
 
1361
      if (h)
1362
        {
1363
          if (is_plt)
1364
            {
1365
              if (h->plt.refcount > 0)
1366
                h->plt.refcount--;
1367
            }
1368
          else if (is_got)
1369
            {
1370
              if (h->got.refcount > 0)
1371
                h->got.refcount--;
1372
            }
1373
          if (is_tlsfunc)
1374
            {
1375
              if (eh->tlsfunc_refcount > 0)
1376
                eh->tlsfunc_refcount--;
1377
            }
1378
        }
1379
      else
1380
        {
1381
          if (is_got || is_plt)
1382
            {
1383
              bfd_signed_vma *got_refcount
1384
                = &elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) [r_symndx];
1385
              if (*got_refcount > 0)
1386
                *got_refcount -= 1;
1387
            }
1388
          if (is_tlsfunc)
1389
            {
1390
              bfd_signed_vma *tlsfunc_refcount
1391
                = &elf_xtensa_local_tlsfunc_refcounts (abfd) [r_symndx];
1392
              if (*tlsfunc_refcount > 0)
1393
                *tlsfunc_refcount -= 1;
1394
            }
1395
        }
1396
    }
1397
 
1398
  return TRUE;
1399
}
1400
 
1401
 
1402
/* Create all the dynamic sections.  */
1403
 
1404
static bfd_boolean
1405
elf_xtensa_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *dynobj, struct bfd_link_info *info)
1406
{
1407
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
1408
  flagword flags, noalloc_flags;
1409
 
1410
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
1411
  if (htab == NULL)
1412
    return FALSE;
1413
 
1414
  /* First do all the standard stuff.  */
1415
  if (! _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (dynobj, info))
1416
    return FALSE;
1417
  htab->splt = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".plt");
1418
  htab->srelplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rela.plt");
1419
  htab->sgot = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".got");
1420
  htab->sgotplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".got.plt");
1421
  htab->srelgot = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rela.got");
1422
 
1423
  /* Create any extra PLT sections in case check_relocs has already
1424
     been called on all the non-dynamic input files.  */
1425
  if (! add_extra_plt_sections (info, htab->plt_reloc_count))
1426
    return FALSE;
1427
 
1428
  noalloc_flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
1429
                   | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
1430
  flags = noalloc_flags | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD;
1431
 
1432
  /* Mark the ".got.plt" section READONLY.  */
1433
  if (htab->sgotplt == NULL
1434
      || ! bfd_set_section_flags (dynobj, htab->sgotplt, flags))
1435
    return FALSE;
1436
 
1437
  /* Create ".got.loc" (literal tables for use by dynamic linker).  */
1438
  htab->sgotloc = bfd_make_section_with_flags (dynobj, ".got.loc", flags);
1439
  if (htab->sgotloc == NULL
1440
      || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->sgotloc, 2))
1441
    return FALSE;
1442
 
1443
  /* Create ".xt.lit.plt" (literal table for ".got.plt*").  */
1444
  htab->spltlittbl = bfd_make_section_with_flags (dynobj, ".xt.lit.plt",
1445
                                                  noalloc_flags);
1446
  if (htab->spltlittbl == NULL
1447
      || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->spltlittbl, 2))
1448
    return FALSE;
1449
 
1450
  return TRUE;
1451
}
1452
 
1453
 
1454
static bfd_boolean
1455
add_extra_plt_sections (struct bfd_link_info *info, int count)
1456
{
1457
  bfd *dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
1458
  int chunk;
1459
 
1460
  /* Iterate over all chunks except 0 which uses the standard ".plt" and
1461
     ".got.plt" sections.  */
1462
  for (chunk = count / PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK; chunk > 0; chunk--)
1463
    {
1464
      char *sname;
1465
      flagword flags;
1466
      asection *s;
1467
 
1468
      /* Stop when we find a section has already been created.  */
1469
      if (elf_xtensa_get_plt_section (info, chunk))
1470
        break;
1471
 
1472
      flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
1473
               | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
1474
 
1475
      sname = (char *) bfd_malloc (10);
1476
      sprintf (sname, ".plt.%u", chunk);
1477
      s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (dynobj, sname, flags | SEC_CODE);
1478
      if (s == NULL
1479
          || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, s, 2))
1480
        return FALSE;
1481
 
1482
      sname = (char *) bfd_malloc (14);
1483
      sprintf (sname, ".got.plt.%u", chunk);
1484
      s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (dynobj, sname, flags);
1485
      if (s == NULL
1486
          || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, s, 2))
1487
        return FALSE;
1488
    }
1489
 
1490
  return TRUE;
1491
}
1492
 
1493
 
1494
/* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
1495
   regular object.  The current definition is in some section of the
1496
   dynamic object, but we're not including those sections.  We have to
1497
   change the definition to something the rest of the link can
1498
   understand.  */
1499
 
1500
static bfd_boolean
1501
elf_xtensa_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1502
                                  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1503
{
1504
  /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
1505
     processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
1506
     real definition first, and we can just use the same value.  */
1507
  if (h->u.weakdef)
1508
    {
1509
      BFD_ASSERT (h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
1510
                  || h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
1511
      h->root.u.def.section = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.section;
1512
      h->root.u.def.value = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.value;
1513
      return TRUE;
1514
    }
1515
 
1516
  /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object.  The
1517
     reference must go through the GOT, so there's no need for COPY relocs,
1518
     .dynbss, etc.  */
1519
 
1520
  return TRUE;
1521
}
1522
 
1523
 
1524
static bfd_boolean
1525
elf_xtensa_allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *arg)
1526
{
1527
  struct bfd_link_info *info;
1528
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
1529
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *eh = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (h);
1530
 
1531
  if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
1532
    return TRUE;
1533
 
1534
  if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1535
    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
1536
 
1537
  info = (struct bfd_link_info *) arg;
1538
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
1539
  if (htab == NULL)
1540
    return FALSE;
1541
 
1542
  /* If we saw any use of an IE model for this symbol, we can then optimize
1543
     away GOT entries for any TLSDESC_FN relocs.  */
1544
  if ((eh->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) != 0)
1545
    {
1546
      BFD_ASSERT (h->got.refcount >= eh->tlsfunc_refcount);
1547
      h->got.refcount -= eh->tlsfunc_refcount;
1548
    }
1549
 
1550
  if (! elf_xtensa_dynamic_symbol_p (h, info))
1551
    elf_xtensa_make_sym_local (info, h);
1552
 
1553
  if (h->plt.refcount > 0)
1554
    htab->srelplt->size += (h->plt.refcount * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
1555
 
1556
  if (h->got.refcount > 0)
1557
    htab->srelgot->size += (h->got.refcount * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
1558
 
1559
  return TRUE;
1560
}
1561
 
1562
 
1563
static void
1564
elf_xtensa_allocate_local_got_size (struct bfd_link_info *info)
1565
{
1566
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
1567
  bfd *i;
1568
 
1569
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
1570
  if (htab == NULL)
1571
    return;
1572
 
1573
  for (i = info->input_bfds; i; i = i->link_next)
1574
    {
1575
      bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts;
1576
      bfd_size_type j, cnt;
1577
      Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
1578
 
1579
      local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (i);
1580
      if (!local_got_refcounts)
1581
        continue;
1582
 
1583
      symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (i)->symtab_hdr;
1584
      cnt = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
1585
 
1586
      for (j = 0; j < cnt; ++j)
1587
        {
1588
          /* If we saw any use of an IE model for this symbol, we can
1589
             then optimize away GOT entries for any TLSDESC_FN relocs.  */
1590
          if ((elf_xtensa_local_got_tls_type (i) [j] & GOT_TLS_IE) != 0)
1591
            {
1592
              bfd_signed_vma *tlsfunc_refcount
1593
                = &elf_xtensa_local_tlsfunc_refcounts (i) [j];
1594
              BFD_ASSERT (local_got_refcounts[j] >= *tlsfunc_refcount);
1595
              local_got_refcounts[j] -= *tlsfunc_refcount;
1596
            }
1597
 
1598
          if (local_got_refcounts[j] > 0)
1599
            htab->srelgot->size += (local_got_refcounts[j]
1600
                                    * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
1601
        }
1602
    }
1603
}
1604
 
1605
 
1606
/* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections.  */
1607
 
1608
static bfd_boolean
1609
elf_xtensa_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1610
                                  struct bfd_link_info *info)
1611
{
1612
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
1613
  bfd *dynobj, *abfd;
1614
  asection *s, *srelplt, *splt, *sgotplt, *srelgot, *spltlittbl, *sgotloc;
1615
  bfd_boolean relplt, relgot;
1616
  int plt_entries, plt_chunks, chunk;
1617
 
1618
  plt_entries = 0;
1619
  plt_chunks = 0;
1620
 
1621
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
1622
  if (htab == NULL)
1623
    return FALSE;
1624
 
1625
  dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
1626
  if (dynobj == NULL)
1627
    abort ();
1628
  srelgot = htab->srelgot;
1629
  srelplt = htab->srelplt;
1630
 
1631
  if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
1632
    {
1633
      BFD_ASSERT (htab->srelgot != NULL
1634
                  && htab->srelplt != NULL
1635
                  && htab->sgot != NULL
1636
                  && htab->spltlittbl != NULL
1637
                  && htab->sgotloc != NULL);
1638
 
1639
      /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter.  */
1640
      if (info->executable)
1641
        {
1642
          s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".interp");
1643
          if (s == NULL)
1644
            abort ();
1645
          s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
1646
          s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
1647
        }
1648
 
1649
      /* Allocate room for one word in ".got".  */
1650
      htab->sgot->size = 4;
1651
 
1652
      /* Allocate space in ".rela.got" for literals that reference global
1653
         symbols and space in ".rela.plt" for literals that have PLT
1654
         entries.  */
1655
      elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
1656
                              elf_xtensa_allocate_dynrelocs,
1657
                              (void *) info);
1658
 
1659
      /* If we are generating a shared object, we also need space in
1660
         ".rela.got" for R_XTENSA_RELATIVE relocs for literals that
1661
         reference local symbols.  */
1662
      if (info->shared)
1663
        elf_xtensa_allocate_local_got_size (info);
1664
 
1665
      /* Allocate space in ".plt" to match the size of ".rela.plt".  For
1666
         each PLT entry, we need the PLT code plus a 4-byte literal.
1667
         For each chunk of ".plt", we also need two more 4-byte
1668
         literals, two corresponding entries in ".rela.got", and an
1669
         8-byte entry in ".xt.lit.plt".  */
1670
      spltlittbl = htab->spltlittbl;
1671
      plt_entries = srelplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1672
      plt_chunks =
1673
        (plt_entries + PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK - 1) / PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK;
1674
 
1675
      /* Iterate over all the PLT chunks, including any extra sections
1676
         created earlier because the initial count of PLT relocations
1677
         was an overestimate.  */
1678
      for (chunk = 0;
1679
           (splt = elf_xtensa_get_plt_section (info, chunk)) != NULL;
1680
           chunk++)
1681
        {
1682
          int chunk_entries;
1683
 
1684
          sgotplt = elf_xtensa_get_gotplt_section (info, chunk);
1685
          BFD_ASSERT (sgotplt != NULL);
1686
 
1687
          if (chunk < plt_chunks - 1)
1688
            chunk_entries = PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK;
1689
          else if (chunk == plt_chunks - 1)
1690
            chunk_entries = plt_entries - (chunk * PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK);
1691
          else
1692
            chunk_entries = 0;
1693
 
1694
          if (chunk_entries != 0)
1695
            {
1696
              sgotplt->size = 4 * (chunk_entries + 2);
1697
              splt->size = PLT_ENTRY_SIZE * chunk_entries;
1698
              srelgot->size += 2 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1699
              spltlittbl->size += 8;
1700
            }
1701
          else
1702
            {
1703
              sgotplt->size = 0;
1704
              splt->size = 0;
1705
            }
1706
        }
1707
 
1708
      /* Allocate space in ".got.loc" to match the total size of all the
1709
         literal tables.  */
1710
      sgotloc = htab->sgotloc;
1711
      sgotloc->size = spltlittbl->size;
1712
      for (abfd = info->input_bfds; abfd != NULL; abfd = abfd->link_next)
1713
        {
1714
          if (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC)
1715
            continue;
1716
          for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1717
            {
1718
              if (! elf_discarded_section (s)
1719
                  && xtensa_is_littable_section (s)
1720
                  && s != spltlittbl)
1721
                sgotloc->size += s->size;
1722
            }
1723
        }
1724
    }
1725
 
1726
  /* Allocate memory for dynamic sections.  */
1727
  relplt = FALSE;
1728
  relgot = FALSE;
1729
  for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1730
    {
1731
      const char *name;
1732
 
1733
      if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
1734
        continue;
1735
 
1736
      /* It's OK to base decisions on the section name, because none
1737
         of the dynobj section names depend upon the input files.  */
1738
      name = bfd_get_section_name (dynobj, s);
1739
 
1740
      if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rela"))
1741
        {
1742
          if (s->size != 0)
1743
            {
1744
              if (strcmp (name, ".rela.plt") == 0)
1745
                relplt = TRUE;
1746
              else if (strcmp (name, ".rela.got") == 0)
1747
                relgot = TRUE;
1748
 
1749
              /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
1750
                 to copy relocs into the output file.  */
1751
              s->reloc_count = 0;
1752
            }
1753
        }
1754
      else if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".plt.")
1755
               && ! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".got.plt.")
1756
               && strcmp (name, ".got") != 0
1757
               && strcmp (name, ".plt") != 0
1758
               && strcmp (name, ".got.plt") != 0
1759
               && strcmp (name, ".xt.lit.plt") != 0
1760
               && strcmp (name, ".got.loc") != 0)
1761
        {
1762
          /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space.  */
1763
          continue;
1764
        }
1765
 
1766
      if (s->size == 0)
1767
        {
1768
          /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the output
1769
             file.  We must create the ".plt*" and ".got.plt*"
1770
             sections in create_dynamic_sections and/or check_relocs
1771
             based on a conservative estimate of the PLT relocation
1772
             count, because the sections must be created before the
1773
             linker maps input sections to output sections.  The
1774
             linker does that before size_dynamic_sections, where we
1775
             compute the exact size of the PLT, so there may be more
1776
             of these sections than are actually needed.  */
1777
          s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1778
        }
1779
      else if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0)
1780
        {
1781
          /* Allocate memory for the section contents.  */
1782
          s->contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
1783
          if (s->contents == NULL)
1784
            return FALSE;
1785
        }
1786
    }
1787
 
1788
  if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
1789
    {
1790
      /* Add the special XTENSA_RTLD relocations now.  The offsets won't be
1791
         known until finish_dynamic_sections, but we need to get the relocs
1792
         in place before they are sorted.  */
1793
      for (chunk = 0; chunk < plt_chunks; chunk++)
1794
        {
1795
          Elf_Internal_Rela irela;
1796
          bfd_byte *loc;
1797
 
1798
          irela.r_offset = 0;
1799
          irela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_RTLD);
1800
          irela.r_addend = 0;
1801
 
1802
          loc = (srelgot->contents
1803
                 + srelgot->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
1804
          bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &irela, loc);
1805
          bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &irela,
1806
                                     loc + sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
1807
          srelgot->reloc_count += 2;
1808
        }
1809
 
1810
      /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section.  We fill in the
1811
         values later, in elf_xtensa_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
1812
         must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
1813
         the .dynamic section.  The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
1814
         dynamic linker and used by the debugger.  */
1815
#define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
1816
  _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
1817
 
1818
      if (info->executable)
1819
        {
1820
          if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
1821
            return FALSE;
1822
        }
1823
 
1824
      if (relplt)
1825
        {
1826
          if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
1827
              || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL, DT_RELA)
1828
              || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0))
1829
            return FALSE;
1830
        }
1831
 
1832
      if (relgot)
1833
        {
1834
          if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
1835
              || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
1836
              || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)))
1837
            return FALSE;
1838
        }
1839
 
1840
      if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0)
1841
          || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_XTENSA_GOT_LOC_OFF, 0)
1842
          || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_XTENSA_GOT_LOC_SZ, 0))
1843
        return FALSE;
1844
    }
1845
#undef add_dynamic_entry
1846
 
1847
  return TRUE;
1848
}
1849
 
1850
static bfd_boolean
1851
elf_xtensa_always_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
1852
                                 struct bfd_link_info *info)
1853
{
1854
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
1855
  asection *tls_sec;
1856
 
1857
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
1858
  if (htab == NULL)
1859
    return FALSE;
1860
 
1861
  tls_sec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
1862
 
1863
  if (tls_sec && (htab->tlsbase->tls_type & GOT_TLS_ANY) != 0)
1864
    {
1865
      struct elf_link_hash_entry *tlsbase = &htab->tlsbase->elf;
1866
      struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh = &tlsbase->root;
1867
      const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
1868
 
1869
      tlsbase->type = STT_TLS;
1870
      if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
1871
            (info, output_bfd, "_TLS_MODULE_BASE_", BSF_LOCAL,
1872
             tls_sec, 0, NULL, FALSE,
1873
             bed->collect, &bh)))
1874
        return FALSE;
1875
      tlsbase->def_regular = 1;
1876
      tlsbase->other = STV_HIDDEN;
1877
      (*bed->elf_backend_hide_symbol) (info, tlsbase, TRUE);
1878
    }
1879
 
1880
  return TRUE;
1881
}
1882
 
1883
 
1884
/* Return the base VMA address which should be subtracted from real addresses
1885
   when resolving @dtpoff relocation.
1886
   This is PT_TLS segment p_vaddr.  */
1887
 
1888
static bfd_vma
1889
dtpoff_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
1890
{
1891
  /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already.  */
1892
  if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
1893
    return 0;
1894
  return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma;
1895
}
1896
 
1897
/* Return the relocation value for @tpoff relocation
1898
   if STT_TLS virtual address is ADDRESS.  */
1899
 
1900
static bfd_vma
1901
tpoff (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd_vma address)
1902
{
1903
  struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
1904
  bfd_vma base;
1905
 
1906
  /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already.  */
1907
  if (htab->tls_sec == NULL)
1908
    return 0;
1909
  base = align_power ((bfd_vma) TCB_SIZE, htab->tls_sec->alignment_power);
1910
  return address - htab->tls_sec->vma + base;
1911
}
1912
 
1913
/* Perform the specified relocation.  The instruction at (contents + address)
1914
   is modified to set one operand to represent the value in "relocation".  The
1915
   operand position is determined by the relocation type recorded in the
1916
   howto.  */
1917
 
1918
#define CALL_SEGMENT_BITS (30)
1919
#define CALL_SEGMENT_SIZE (1 << CALL_SEGMENT_BITS)
1920
 
1921
static bfd_reloc_status_type
1922
elf_xtensa_do_reloc (reloc_howto_type *howto,
1923
                     bfd *abfd,
1924
                     asection *input_section,
1925
                     bfd_vma relocation,
1926
                     bfd_byte *contents,
1927
                     bfd_vma address,
1928
                     bfd_boolean is_weak_undef,
1929
                     char **error_message)
1930
{
1931
  xtensa_format fmt;
1932
  xtensa_opcode opcode;
1933
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
1934
  static xtensa_insnbuf ibuff = NULL;
1935
  static xtensa_insnbuf sbuff = NULL;
1936
  bfd_vma self_address;
1937
  bfd_size_type input_size;
1938
  int opnd, slot;
1939
  uint32 newval;
1940
 
1941
  if (!ibuff)
1942
    {
1943
      ibuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
1944
      sbuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
1945
    }
1946
 
1947
  input_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section);
1948
 
1949
  /* Calculate the PC address for this instruction.  */
1950
  self_address = (input_section->output_section->vma
1951
                  + input_section->output_offset
1952
                  + address);
1953
 
1954
  switch (howto->type)
1955
    {
1956
    case R_XTENSA_NONE:
1957
    case R_XTENSA_DIFF8:
1958
    case R_XTENSA_DIFF16:
1959
    case R_XTENSA_DIFF32:
1960
    case R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC:
1961
    case R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG:
1962
    case R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL:
1963
      return bfd_reloc_ok;
1964
 
1965
    case R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND:
1966
      if (!is_weak_undef)
1967
        {
1968
          /* Check for windowed CALL across a 1GB boundary.  */
1969
          opcode = get_expanded_call_opcode (contents + address,
1970
                                             input_size - address, 0);
1971
          if (is_windowed_call_opcode (opcode))
1972
            {
1973
              if ((self_address >> CALL_SEGMENT_BITS)
1974
                  != (relocation >> CALL_SEGMENT_BITS))
1975
                {
1976
                  *error_message = "windowed longcall crosses 1GB boundary; "
1977
                    "return may fail";
1978
                  return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
1979
                }
1980
            }
1981
        }
1982
      return bfd_reloc_ok;
1983
 
1984
    case R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY:
1985
      {
1986
        /* Convert the L32R/CALLX to CALL.  */
1987
        bfd_reloc_status_type retval =
1988
          elf_xtensa_do_asm_simplify (contents, address, input_size,
1989
                                      error_message);
1990
        if (retval != bfd_reloc_ok)
1991
          return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
1992
 
1993
        /* The CALL needs to be relocated.  Continue below for that part.  */
1994
        address += 3;
1995
        self_address += 3;
1996
        howto = &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP ];
1997
      }
1998
      break;
1999
 
2000
    case R_XTENSA_32:
2001
      {
2002
        bfd_vma x;
2003
        x = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + address);
2004
        x = x + relocation;
2005
        bfd_put_32 (abfd, x, contents + address);
2006
      }
2007
      return bfd_reloc_ok;
2008
 
2009
    case R_XTENSA_32_PCREL:
2010
      bfd_put_32 (abfd, relocation - self_address, contents + address);
2011
      return bfd_reloc_ok;
2012
 
2013
    case R_XTENSA_PLT:
2014
    case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN:
2015
    case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG:
2016
    case R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF:
2017
    case R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF:
2018
      bfd_put_32 (abfd, relocation, contents + address);
2019
      return bfd_reloc_ok;
2020
    }
2021
 
2022
  /* Only instruction slot-specific relocations handled below.... */
2023
  slot = get_relocation_slot (howto->type);
2024
  if (slot == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
2025
    {
2026
      *error_message = "unexpected relocation";
2027
      return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2028
    }
2029
 
2030
  /* Read the instruction into a buffer and decode the opcode.  */
2031
  xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, ibuff, contents + address,
2032
                             input_size - address);
2033
  fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, ibuff);
2034
  if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
2035
    {
2036
      *error_message = "cannot decode instruction format";
2037
      return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2038
    }
2039
 
2040
  xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, slot, ibuff, sbuff);
2041
 
2042
  opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, slot, sbuff);
2043
  if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
2044
    {
2045
      *error_message = "cannot decode instruction opcode";
2046
      return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2047
    }
2048
 
2049
  /* Check for opcode-specific "alternate" relocations.  */
2050
  if (is_alt_relocation (howto->type))
2051
    {
2052
      if (opcode == get_l32r_opcode ())
2053
        {
2054
          /* Handle the special-case of non-PC-relative L32R instructions.  */
2055
          bfd *output_bfd = input_section->output_section->owner;
2056
          asection *lit4_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".lit4");
2057
          if (!lit4_sec)
2058
            {
2059
              *error_message = "relocation references missing .lit4 section";
2060
              return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2061
            }
2062
          self_address = ((lit4_sec->vma & ~0xfff)
2063
                          + 0x40000 - 3); /* -3 to compensate for do_reloc */
2064
          newval = relocation;
2065
          opnd = 1;
2066
        }
2067
      else if (opcode == get_const16_opcode ())
2068
        {
2069
          /* ALT used for high 16 bits.  */
2070
          newval = relocation >> 16;
2071
          opnd = 1;
2072
        }
2073
      else
2074
        {
2075
          /* No other "alternate" relocations currently defined.  */
2076
          *error_message = "unexpected relocation";
2077
          return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2078
        }
2079
    }
2080
  else /* Not an "alternate" relocation.... */
2081
    {
2082
      if (opcode == get_const16_opcode ())
2083
        {
2084
          newval = relocation & 0xffff;
2085
          opnd = 1;
2086
        }
2087
      else
2088
        {
2089
          /* ...normal PC-relative relocation.... */
2090
 
2091
          /* Determine which operand is being relocated.  */
2092
          opnd = get_relocation_opnd (opcode, howto->type);
2093
          if (opnd == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
2094
            {
2095
              *error_message = "unexpected relocation";
2096
              return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2097
            }
2098
 
2099
          if (!howto->pc_relative)
2100
            {
2101
              *error_message = "expected PC-relative relocation";
2102
              return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2103
            }
2104
 
2105
          newval = relocation;
2106
        }
2107
    }
2108
 
2109
  /* Apply the relocation.  */
2110
  if (xtensa_operand_do_reloc (isa, opcode, opnd, &newval, self_address)
2111
      || xtensa_operand_encode (isa, opcode, opnd, &newval)
2112
      || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, opcode, opnd, fmt, slot,
2113
                                   sbuff, newval))
2114
    {
2115
      const char *opname = xtensa_opcode_name (isa, opcode);
2116
      const char *msg;
2117
 
2118
      msg = "cannot encode";
2119
      if (is_direct_call_opcode (opcode))
2120
        {
2121
          if ((relocation & 0x3) != 0)
2122
            msg = "misaligned call target";
2123
          else
2124
            msg = "call target out of range";
2125
        }
2126
      else if (opcode == get_l32r_opcode ())
2127
        {
2128
          if ((relocation & 0x3) != 0)
2129
            msg = "misaligned literal target";
2130
          else if (is_alt_relocation (howto->type))
2131
            msg = "literal target out of range (too many literals)";
2132
          else if (self_address > relocation)
2133
            msg = "literal target out of range (try using text-section-literals)";
2134
          else
2135
            msg = "literal placed after use";
2136
        }
2137
 
2138
      *error_message = vsprint_msg (opname, ": %s", strlen (msg) + 2, msg);
2139
      return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2140
    }
2141
 
2142
  /* Check for calls across 1GB boundaries.  */
2143
  if (is_direct_call_opcode (opcode)
2144
      && is_windowed_call_opcode (opcode))
2145
    {
2146
      if ((self_address >> CALL_SEGMENT_BITS)
2147
          != (relocation >> CALL_SEGMENT_BITS))
2148
        {
2149
          *error_message =
2150
            "windowed call crosses 1GB boundary; return may fail";
2151
          return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2152
        }
2153
    }
2154
 
2155
  /* Write the modified instruction back out of the buffer.  */
2156
  xtensa_format_set_slot (isa, fmt, slot, ibuff, sbuff);
2157
  xtensa_insnbuf_to_chars (isa, ibuff, contents + address,
2158
                           input_size - address);
2159
  return bfd_reloc_ok;
2160
}
2161
 
2162
 
2163
static char *
2164
vsprint_msg (const char *origmsg, const char *fmt, int arglen, ...)
2165
{
2166
  /* To reduce the size of the memory leak,
2167
     we only use a single message buffer.  */
2168
  static bfd_size_type alloc_size = 0;
2169
  static char *message = NULL;
2170
  bfd_size_type orig_len, len = 0;
2171
  bfd_boolean is_append;
2172
 
2173
  VA_OPEN (ap, arglen);
2174
  VA_FIXEDARG (ap, const char *, origmsg);
2175
 
2176
  is_append = (origmsg == message);
2177
 
2178
  orig_len = strlen (origmsg);
2179
  len = orig_len + strlen (fmt) + arglen + 20;
2180
  if (len > alloc_size)
2181
    {
2182
      message = (char *) bfd_realloc_or_free (message, len);
2183
      alloc_size = len;
2184
    }
2185
  if (message != NULL)
2186
    {
2187
      if (!is_append)
2188
        memcpy (message, origmsg, orig_len);
2189
      vsprintf (message + orig_len, fmt, ap);
2190
    }
2191
  VA_CLOSE (ap);
2192
  return message;
2193
}
2194
 
2195
 
2196
/* This function is registered as the "special_function" in the
2197
   Xtensa howto for handling simplify operations.
2198
   bfd_perform_relocation / bfd_install_relocation use it to
2199
   perform (install) the specified relocation.  Since this replaces the code
2200
   in bfd_perform_relocation, it is basically an Xtensa-specific,
2201
   stripped-down version of bfd_perform_relocation.  */
2202
 
2203
static bfd_reloc_status_type
2204
bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc (bfd *abfd,
2205
                      arelent *reloc_entry,
2206
                      asymbol *symbol,
2207
                      void *data,
2208
                      asection *input_section,
2209
                      bfd *output_bfd,
2210
                      char **error_message)
2211
{
2212
  bfd_vma relocation;
2213
  bfd_reloc_status_type flag;
2214
  bfd_size_type octets = reloc_entry->address * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd);
2215
  bfd_vma output_base = 0;
2216
  reloc_howto_type *howto = reloc_entry->howto;
2217
  asection *reloc_target_output_section;
2218
  bfd_boolean is_weak_undef;
2219
 
2220
  if (!xtensa_default_isa)
2221
    xtensa_default_isa = xtensa_isa_init (0, 0);
2222
 
2223
  /* ELF relocs are against symbols.  If we are producing relocatable
2224
     output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, the resulting
2225
     reloc will also be against the same symbol.  In such a case, we
2226
     don't want to change anything about the way the reloc is handled,
2227
     since it will all be done at final link time.  This test is similar
2228
     to what bfd_elf_generic_reloc does except that it lets relocs with
2229
     howto->partial_inplace go through even if the addend is non-zero.
2230
     (The real problem is that partial_inplace is set for XTENSA_32
2231
     relocs to begin with, but that's a long story and there's little we
2232
     can do about it now....)  */
2233
 
2234
  if (output_bfd && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
2235
    {
2236
      reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2237
      return bfd_reloc_ok;
2238
    }
2239
 
2240
  /* Is the address of the relocation really within the section?  */
2241
  if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
2242
    return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2243
 
2244
  /* Work out which section the relocation is targeted at and the
2245
     initial relocation command value.  */
2246
 
2247
  /* Get symbol value.  (Common symbols are special.)  */
2248
  if (bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
2249
    relocation = 0;
2250
  else
2251
    relocation = symbol->value;
2252
 
2253
  reloc_target_output_section = symbol->section->output_section;
2254
 
2255
  /* Convert input-section-relative symbol value to absolute.  */
2256
  if ((output_bfd && !howto->partial_inplace)
2257
      || reloc_target_output_section == NULL)
2258
    output_base = 0;
2259
  else
2260
    output_base = reloc_target_output_section->vma;
2261
 
2262
  relocation += output_base + symbol->section->output_offset;
2263
 
2264
  /* Add in supplied addend.  */
2265
  relocation += reloc_entry->addend;
2266
 
2267
  /* Here the variable relocation holds the final address of the
2268
     symbol we are relocating against, plus any addend.  */
2269
  if (output_bfd)
2270
    {
2271
      if (!howto->partial_inplace)
2272
        {
2273
          /* This is a partial relocation, and we want to apply the relocation
2274
             to the reloc entry rather than the raw data.  Everything except
2275
             relocations against section symbols has already been handled
2276
             above.  */
2277
 
2278
          BFD_ASSERT (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM);
2279
          reloc_entry->addend = relocation;
2280
          reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2281
          return bfd_reloc_ok;
2282
        }
2283
      else
2284
        {
2285
          reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2286
          reloc_entry->addend = 0;
2287
        }
2288
    }
2289
 
2290
  is_weak_undef = (bfd_is_und_section (symbol->section)
2291
                   && (symbol->flags & BSF_WEAK) != 0);
2292
  flag = elf_xtensa_do_reloc (howto, abfd, input_section, relocation,
2293
                              (bfd_byte *) data, (bfd_vma) octets,
2294
                              is_weak_undef, error_message);
2295
 
2296
  if (flag == bfd_reloc_dangerous)
2297
    {
2298
      /* Add the symbol name to the error message.  */
2299
      if (! *error_message)
2300
        *error_message = "";
2301
      *error_message = vsprint_msg (*error_message, ": (%s + 0x%lx)",
2302
                                    strlen (symbol->name) + 17,
2303
                                    symbol->name,
2304
                                    (unsigned long) reloc_entry->addend);
2305
    }
2306
 
2307
  return flag;
2308
}
2309
 
2310
 
2311
/* Set up an entry in the procedure linkage table.  */
2312
 
2313
static bfd_vma
2314
elf_xtensa_create_plt_entry (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2315
                             bfd *output_bfd,
2316
                             unsigned reloc_index)
2317
{
2318
  asection *splt, *sgotplt;
2319
  bfd_vma plt_base, got_base;
2320
  bfd_vma code_offset, lit_offset;
2321
  int chunk;
2322
 
2323
  chunk = reloc_index / PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK;
2324
  splt = elf_xtensa_get_plt_section (info, chunk);
2325
  sgotplt = elf_xtensa_get_gotplt_section (info, chunk);
2326
  BFD_ASSERT (splt != NULL && sgotplt != NULL);
2327
 
2328
  plt_base = splt->output_section->vma + splt->output_offset;
2329
  got_base = sgotplt->output_section->vma + sgotplt->output_offset;
2330
 
2331
  lit_offset = 8 + (reloc_index % PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK) * 4;
2332
  code_offset = (reloc_index % PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK) * PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
2333
 
2334
  /* Fill in the literal entry.  This is the offset of the dynamic
2335
     relocation entry.  */
2336
  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, reloc_index * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela),
2337
              sgotplt->contents + lit_offset);
2338
 
2339
  /* Fill in the entry in the procedure linkage table.  */
2340
  memcpy (splt->contents + code_offset,
2341
          (bfd_big_endian (output_bfd)
2342
           ? elf_xtensa_be_plt_entry
2343
           : elf_xtensa_le_plt_entry),
2344
          PLT_ENTRY_SIZE);
2345
  bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, l32r_offset (got_base + 0,
2346
                                       plt_base + code_offset + 3),
2347
              splt->contents + code_offset + 4);
2348
  bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, l32r_offset (got_base + 4,
2349
                                       plt_base + code_offset + 6),
2350
              splt->contents + code_offset + 7);
2351
  bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, l32r_offset (got_base + lit_offset,
2352
                                       plt_base + code_offset + 9),
2353
              splt->contents + code_offset + 10);
2354
 
2355
  return plt_base + code_offset;
2356
}
2357
 
2358
 
2359
static bfd_boolean get_indirect_call_dest_reg (xtensa_opcode, unsigned *);
2360
 
2361
static bfd_boolean
2362
replace_tls_insn (Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
2363
                  bfd *abfd,
2364
                  asection *input_section,
2365
                  bfd_byte *contents,
2366
                  bfd_boolean is_ld_model,
2367
                  char **error_message)
2368
{
2369
  static xtensa_insnbuf ibuff = NULL;
2370
  static xtensa_insnbuf sbuff = NULL;
2371
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
2372
  xtensa_format fmt;
2373
  xtensa_opcode old_op, new_op;
2374
  bfd_size_type input_size;
2375
  int r_type;
2376
  unsigned dest_reg, src_reg;
2377
 
2378
  if (ibuff == NULL)
2379
    {
2380
      ibuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
2381
      sbuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
2382
    }
2383
 
2384
  input_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section);
2385
 
2386
  /* Read the instruction into a buffer and decode the opcode.  */
2387
  xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, ibuff, contents + rel->r_offset,
2388
                             input_size - rel->r_offset);
2389
  fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, ibuff);
2390
  if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
2391
    {
2392
      *error_message = "cannot decode instruction format";
2393
      return FALSE;
2394
    }
2395
 
2396
  BFD_ASSERT (xtensa_format_num_slots (isa, fmt) == 1);
2397
  xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, ibuff, sbuff);
2398
 
2399
  old_op = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, sbuff);
2400
  if (old_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
2401
    {
2402
      *error_message = "cannot decode instruction opcode";
2403
      return FALSE;
2404
    }
2405
 
2406
  r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2407
  switch (r_type)
2408
    {
2409
    case R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC:
2410
    case R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG:
2411
      if (old_op != get_l32r_opcode ()
2412
          || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, old_op, 0, fmt, 0,
2413
                                       sbuff, &dest_reg) != 0)
2414
        {
2415
          *error_message = "cannot extract L32R destination for TLS access";
2416
          return FALSE;
2417
        }
2418
      break;
2419
 
2420
    case R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL:
2421
      if (! get_indirect_call_dest_reg (old_op, &dest_reg)
2422
          || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, old_op, 0, fmt, 0,
2423
                                       sbuff, &src_reg) != 0)
2424
        {
2425
          *error_message = "cannot extract CALLXn operands for TLS access";
2426
          return FALSE;
2427
        }
2428
      break;
2429
 
2430
    default:
2431
      abort ();
2432
    }
2433
 
2434
  if (is_ld_model)
2435
    {
2436
      switch (r_type)
2437
        {
2438
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC:
2439
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG:
2440
          /* Change the instruction to a NOP (or "OR a1, a1, a1" for older
2441
             versions of Xtensa).  */
2442
          new_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, "nop");
2443
          if (new_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
2444
            {
2445
              new_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, "or");
2446
              if (new_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
2447
                  || xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, fmt, 0, sbuff, new_op) != 0
2448
                  || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 0, fmt, 0,
2449
                                               sbuff, 1) != 0
2450
                  || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 1, fmt, 0,
2451
                                               sbuff, 1) != 0
2452
                  || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 2, fmt, 0,
2453
                                               sbuff, 1) != 0)
2454
                {
2455
                  *error_message = "cannot encode OR for TLS access";
2456
                  return FALSE;
2457
                }
2458
            }
2459
          else
2460
            {
2461
              if (xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, fmt, 0, sbuff, new_op) != 0)
2462
                {
2463
                  *error_message = "cannot encode NOP for TLS access";
2464
                  return FALSE;
2465
                }
2466
            }
2467
          break;
2468
 
2469
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL:
2470
          /* Read THREADPTR into the CALLX's return value register.  */
2471
          new_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, "rur.threadptr");
2472
          if (new_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
2473
              || xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, fmt, 0, sbuff, new_op) != 0
2474
              || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 0, fmt, 0,
2475
                                           sbuff, dest_reg + 2) != 0)
2476
            {
2477
              *error_message = "cannot encode RUR.THREADPTR for TLS access";
2478
              return FALSE;
2479
            }
2480
          break;
2481
        }
2482
    }
2483
  else
2484
    {
2485
      switch (r_type)
2486
        {
2487
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC:
2488
          new_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, "rur.threadptr");
2489
          if (new_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
2490
              || xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, fmt, 0, sbuff, new_op) != 0
2491
              || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 0, fmt, 0,
2492
                                           sbuff, dest_reg) != 0)
2493
            {
2494
              *error_message = "cannot encode RUR.THREADPTR for TLS access";
2495
              return FALSE;
2496
            }
2497
          break;
2498
 
2499
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG:
2500
          /* Nothing to do.  Keep the original L32R instruction.  */
2501
          return TRUE;
2502
 
2503
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL:
2504
          /* Add the CALLX's src register (holding the THREADPTR value)
2505
             to the first argument register (holding the offset) and put
2506
             the result in the CALLX's return value register.  */
2507
          new_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, "add");
2508
          if (new_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
2509
              || xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, fmt, 0, sbuff, new_op) != 0
2510
              || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 0, fmt, 0,
2511
                                           sbuff, dest_reg + 2) != 0
2512
              || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 1, fmt, 0,
2513
                                           sbuff, dest_reg + 2) != 0
2514
              || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 2, fmt, 0,
2515
                                           sbuff, src_reg) != 0)
2516
            {
2517
              *error_message = "cannot encode ADD for TLS access";
2518
              return FALSE;
2519
            }
2520
          break;
2521
        }
2522
    }
2523
 
2524
  xtensa_format_set_slot (isa, fmt, 0, ibuff, sbuff);
2525
  xtensa_insnbuf_to_chars (isa, ibuff, contents + rel->r_offset,
2526
                           input_size - rel->r_offset);
2527
 
2528
  return TRUE;
2529
}
2530
 
2531
 
2532
#define IS_XTENSA_TLS_RELOC(R_TYPE) \
2533
  ((R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN \
2534
   || (R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG \
2535
   || (R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF \
2536
   || (R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF \
2537
   || (R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC \
2538
   || (R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG \
2539
   || (R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL)
2540
 
2541
/* Relocate an Xtensa ELF section.  This is invoked by the linker for
2542
   both relocatable and final links.  */
2543
 
2544
static bfd_boolean
2545
elf_xtensa_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
2546
                             struct bfd_link_info *info,
2547
                             bfd *input_bfd,
2548
                             asection *input_section,
2549
                             bfd_byte *contents,
2550
                             Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
2551
                             Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
2552
                             asection **local_sections)
2553
{
2554
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
2555
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2556
  Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2557
  Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
2558
  struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2559
  property_table_entry *lit_table = 0;
2560
  int ltblsize = 0;
2561
  char *local_got_tls_types;
2562
  char *error_message = NULL;
2563
  bfd_size_type input_size;
2564
  int tls_type;
2565
 
2566
  if (!xtensa_default_isa)
2567
    xtensa_default_isa = xtensa_isa_init (0, 0);
2568
 
2569
  BFD_ASSERT (is_xtensa_elf (input_bfd));
2570
 
2571
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
2572
  if (htab == NULL)
2573
    return FALSE;
2574
 
2575
  symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
2576
  sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
2577
  local_got_tls_types = elf_xtensa_local_got_tls_type (input_bfd);
2578
 
2579
  if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
2580
    {
2581
      ltblsize = xtensa_read_table_entries (input_bfd, input_section,
2582
                                            &lit_table, XTENSA_LIT_SEC_NAME,
2583
                                            TRUE);
2584
      if (ltblsize < 0)
2585
        return FALSE;
2586
    }
2587
 
2588
  input_size = bfd_get_section_limit (input_bfd, input_section);
2589
 
2590
  rel = relocs;
2591
  relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
2592
  for (; rel < relend; rel++)
2593
    {
2594
      int r_type;
2595
      reloc_howto_type *howto;
2596
      unsigned long r_symndx;
2597
      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2598
      Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
2599
      char sym_type;
2600
      const char *name;
2601
      asection *sec;
2602
      bfd_vma relocation;
2603
      bfd_reloc_status_type r;
2604
      bfd_boolean is_weak_undef;
2605
      bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc;
2606
      bfd_boolean warned;
2607
      bfd_boolean dynamic_symbol;
2608
 
2609
      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2610
      if (r_type == (int) R_XTENSA_GNU_VTINHERIT
2611
          || r_type == (int) R_XTENSA_GNU_VTENTRY)
2612
        continue;
2613
 
2614
      if (r_type < 0 || r_type >= (int) R_XTENSA_max)
2615
        {
2616
          bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2617
          return FALSE;
2618
        }
2619
      howto = &elf_howto_table[r_type];
2620
 
2621
      r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2622
 
2623
      h = NULL;
2624
      sym = NULL;
2625
      sec = NULL;
2626
      is_weak_undef = FALSE;
2627
      unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
2628
      warned = FALSE;
2629
 
2630
      if (howto->partial_inplace && !info->relocatable)
2631
        {
2632
          /* Because R_XTENSA_32 was made partial_inplace to fix some
2633
             problems with DWARF info in partial links, there may be
2634
             an addend stored in the contents.  Take it out of there
2635
             and move it back into the addend field of the reloc.  */
2636
          rel->r_addend += bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
2637
          bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, 0, contents + rel->r_offset);
2638
        }
2639
 
2640
      if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2641
        {
2642
          sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
2643
          sym_type = ELF32_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info);
2644
          sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
2645
          relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
2646
        }
2647
      else
2648
        {
2649
          RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
2650
                                   r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
2651
                                   h, sec, relocation,
2652
                                   unresolved_reloc, warned);
2653
 
2654
          if (relocation == 0
2655
              && !unresolved_reloc
2656
              && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
2657
            is_weak_undef = TRUE;
2658
 
2659
          sym_type = h->type;
2660
        }
2661
 
2662
      if (sec != NULL && elf_discarded_section (sec))
2663
        {
2664
          /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
2665
             or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
2666
             section contents zeroed.  Avoid any special processing.  */
2667
          _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
2668
          rel->r_info = 0;
2669
          rel->r_addend = 0;
2670
          continue;
2671
        }
2672
 
2673
      if (info->relocatable)
2674
        {
2675
          /* This is a relocatable link.
2676
             1) If the reloc is against a section symbol, adjust
2677
             according to the output section.
2678
             2) If there is a new target for this relocation,
2679
             the new target will be in the same output section.
2680
             We adjust the relocation by the output section
2681
             difference.  */
2682
 
2683
          if (relaxing_section)
2684
            {
2685
              /* Check if this references a section in another input file.  */
2686
              if (!do_fix_for_relocatable_link (rel, input_bfd, input_section,
2687
                                                contents))
2688
                return FALSE;
2689
            }
2690
 
2691
          if (r_type == R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY)
2692
            {
2693
              error_message = NULL;
2694
              /* Convert ASM_SIMPLIFY into the simpler relocation
2695
                 so that they never escape a relaxing link.  */
2696
              r = contract_asm_expansion (contents, input_size, rel,
2697
                                          &error_message);
2698
              if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
2699
                {
2700
                  if (!((*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
2701
                        (info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
2702
                         rel->r_offset)))
2703
                    return FALSE;
2704
                }
2705
              r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2706
            }
2707
 
2708
          /* This is a relocatable link, so we don't have to change
2709
             anything unless the reloc is against a section symbol,
2710
             in which case we have to adjust according to where the
2711
             section symbol winds up in the output section.  */
2712
          if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2713
            {
2714
              sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
2715
              if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
2716
                {
2717
                  sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
2718
                  rel->r_addend += sec->output_offset + sym->st_value;
2719
                }
2720
            }
2721
 
2722
          /* If there is an addend with a partial_inplace howto,
2723
             then move the addend to the contents.  This is a hack
2724
             to work around problems with DWARF in relocatable links
2725
             with some previous version of BFD.  Now we can't easily get
2726
             rid of the hack without breaking backward compatibility.... */
2727
          if (rel->r_addend)
2728
            {
2729
              howto = &elf_howto_table[r_type];
2730
              if (howto->partial_inplace)
2731
                {
2732
                  r = elf_xtensa_do_reloc (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
2733
                                           rel->r_addend, contents,
2734
                                           rel->r_offset, FALSE,
2735
                                           &error_message);
2736
                  if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
2737
                    {
2738
                      if (!((*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
2739
                            (info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
2740
                             rel->r_offset)))
2741
                        return FALSE;
2742
                    }
2743
                  rel->r_addend = 0;
2744
                }
2745
            }
2746
 
2747
          /* Done with work for relocatable link; continue with next reloc.  */
2748
          continue;
2749
        }
2750
 
2751
      /* This is a final link.  */
2752
 
2753
      if (relaxing_section)
2754
        {
2755
          /* Check if this references a section in another input file.  */
2756
          do_fix_for_final_link (rel, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
2757
                                 &relocation);
2758
        }
2759
 
2760
      /* Sanity check the address.  */
2761
      if (rel->r_offset >= input_size
2762
          && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_NONE)
2763
        {
2764
          (*_bfd_error_handler)
2765
            (_("%B(%A+0x%lx): relocation offset out of range (size=0x%x)"),
2766
             input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, input_size);
2767
          bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2768
          return FALSE;
2769
        }
2770
 
2771
      if (h != NULL)
2772
        name = h->root.root.string;
2773
      else
2774
        {
2775
          name = (bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section
2776
                  (input_bfd, symtab_hdr->sh_link, sym->st_name));
2777
          if (name == NULL || *name == '\0')
2778
            name = bfd_section_name (input_bfd, sec);
2779
        }
2780
 
2781
      if (r_symndx != 0
2782
          && r_type != R_XTENSA_NONE
2783
          && (h == NULL
2784
              || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2785
              || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2786
          && IS_XTENSA_TLS_RELOC (r_type) != (sym_type == STT_TLS))
2787
        {
2788
          (*_bfd_error_handler)
2789
            ((sym_type == STT_TLS
2790
              ? _("%B(%A+0x%lx): %s used with TLS symbol %s")
2791
              : _("%B(%A+0x%lx): %s used with non-TLS symbol %s")),
2792
             input_bfd,
2793
             input_section,
2794
             (long) rel->r_offset,
2795
             howto->name,
2796
             name);
2797
        }
2798
 
2799
      dynamic_symbol = elf_xtensa_dynamic_symbol_p (h, info);
2800
 
2801
      tls_type = GOT_UNKNOWN;
2802
      if (h)
2803
        tls_type = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (h)->tls_type;
2804
      else if (local_got_tls_types)
2805
        tls_type = local_got_tls_types [r_symndx];
2806
 
2807
      switch (r_type)
2808
        {
2809
        case R_XTENSA_32:
2810
        case R_XTENSA_PLT:
2811
          if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
2812
              && (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
2813
              && (dynamic_symbol || info->shared))
2814
            {
2815
              Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
2816
              bfd_byte *loc;
2817
              asection *srel;
2818
 
2819
              if (dynamic_symbol && r_type == R_XTENSA_PLT)
2820
                srel = htab->srelplt;
2821
              else
2822
                srel = htab->srelgot;
2823
 
2824
              BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
2825
 
2826
              outrel.r_offset =
2827
                _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
2828
                                         input_section, rel->r_offset);
2829
 
2830
              if ((outrel.r_offset | 1) == (bfd_vma) -1)
2831
                memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
2832
              else
2833
                {
2834
                  outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
2835
                                      + input_section->output_offset);
2836
 
2837
                  /* Complain if the relocation is in a read-only section
2838
                     and not in a literal pool.  */
2839
                  if ((input_section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
2840
                      && !elf_xtensa_in_literal_pool (lit_table, ltblsize,
2841
                                                      outrel.r_offset))
2842
                    {
2843
                      error_message =
2844
                        _("dynamic relocation in read-only section");
2845
                      if (!((*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
2846
                            (info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
2847
                             rel->r_offset)))
2848
                        return FALSE;
2849
                    }
2850
 
2851
                  if (dynamic_symbol)
2852
                    {
2853
                      outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
2854
                      rel->r_addend = 0;
2855
 
2856
                      if (r_type == R_XTENSA_32)
2857
                        {
2858
                          outrel.r_info =
2859
                            ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_XTENSA_GLOB_DAT);
2860
                          relocation = 0;
2861
                        }
2862
                      else /* r_type == R_XTENSA_PLT */
2863
                        {
2864
                          outrel.r_info =
2865
                            ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT);
2866
 
2867
                          /* Create the PLT entry and set the initial
2868
                             contents of the literal entry to the address of
2869
                             the PLT entry.  */
2870
                          relocation =
2871
                            elf_xtensa_create_plt_entry (info, output_bfd,
2872
                                                         srel->reloc_count);
2873
                        }
2874
                      unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
2875
                    }
2876
                  else
2877
                    {
2878
                      /* Generate a RELATIVE relocation.  */
2879
                      outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_RELATIVE);
2880
                      outrel.r_addend = 0;
2881
                    }
2882
                }
2883
 
2884
              loc = (srel->contents
2885
                     + srel->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
2886
              bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
2887
              BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) * srel->reloc_count
2888
                          <= srel->size);
2889
            }
2890
          else if (r_type == R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND && dynamic_symbol)
2891
            {
2892
              /* This should only happen for non-PIC code, which is not
2893
                 supposed to be used on systems with dynamic linking.
2894
                 Just ignore these relocations.  */
2895
              continue;
2896
            }
2897
          break;
2898
 
2899
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF:
2900
          /* Switch to LE model for local symbols in an executable.  */
2901
          if (! info->shared && ! dynamic_symbol)
2902
            {
2903
              relocation = tpoff (info, relocation);
2904
              break;
2905
            }
2906
          /* fall through */
2907
 
2908
        case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN:
2909
        case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG:
2910
          {
2911
            if (r_type == R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN)
2912
              {
2913
                if (! info->shared || (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) != 0)
2914
                  r_type = R_XTENSA_NONE;
2915
              }
2916
            else if (r_type == R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG)
2917
              {
2918
                if (info->shared)
2919
                  {
2920
                    if ((tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) != 0)
2921
                      r_type = R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF;
2922
                  }
2923
                else
2924
                  {
2925
                    r_type = R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF;
2926
                    if (! dynamic_symbol)
2927
                      {
2928
                        relocation = tpoff (info, relocation);
2929
                        break;
2930
                      }
2931
                  }
2932
              }
2933
 
2934
            if (r_type == R_XTENSA_NONE)
2935
              /* Nothing to do here; skip to the next reloc.  */
2936
              continue;
2937
 
2938
            if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
2939
              {
2940
                error_message =
2941
                  _("TLS relocation invalid without dynamic sections");
2942
                if (!((*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
2943
                      (info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
2944
                       rel->r_offset)))
2945
                  return FALSE;
2946
              }
2947
            else
2948
              {
2949
                Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
2950
                bfd_byte *loc;
2951
                asection *srel = htab->srelgot;
2952
                int indx;
2953
 
2954
                outrel.r_offset = (input_section->output_section->vma
2955
                                   + input_section->output_offset
2956
                                   + rel->r_offset);
2957
 
2958
                /* Complain if the relocation is in a read-only section
2959
                   and not in a literal pool.  */
2960
                if ((input_section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
2961
                    && ! elf_xtensa_in_literal_pool (lit_table, ltblsize,
2962
                                                     outrel.r_offset))
2963
                  {
2964
                    error_message =
2965
                      _("dynamic relocation in read-only section");
2966
                    if (!((*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
2967
                          (info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
2968
                           rel->r_offset)))
2969
                      return FALSE;
2970
                  }
2971
 
2972
                indx = h && h->dynindx != -1 ? h->dynindx : 0;
2973
                if (indx == 0)
2974
                  outrel.r_addend = relocation - dtpoff_base (info);
2975
                else
2976
                  outrel.r_addend = 0;
2977
                rel->r_addend = 0;
2978
 
2979
                outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
2980
                relocation = 0;
2981
                unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
2982
 
2983
                BFD_ASSERT (srel);
2984
                loc = (srel->contents
2985
                       + srel->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
2986
                bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
2987
                BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) * srel->reloc_count
2988
                            <= srel->size);
2989
              }
2990
          }
2991
          break;
2992
 
2993
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF:
2994
          if (! info->shared)
2995
            /* Switch from LD model to LE model.  */
2996
            relocation = tpoff (info, relocation);
2997
          else
2998
            relocation -= dtpoff_base (info);
2999
          break;
3000
 
3001
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC:
3002
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG:
3003
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL:
3004
          /* Check if optimizing to IE or LE model.  */
3005
          if ((tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) != 0)
3006
            {
3007
              bfd_boolean is_ld_model =
3008
                (h && elf_xtensa_hash_entry (h) == htab->tlsbase);
3009
              if (! replace_tls_insn (rel, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
3010
                                      is_ld_model, &error_message))
3011
                {
3012
                  if (!((*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
3013
                        (info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
3014
                         rel->r_offset)))
3015
                    return FALSE;
3016
                }
3017
 
3018
              if (r_type != R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG || is_ld_model)
3019
                {
3020
                  /* Skip subsequent relocations on the same instruction.  */
3021
                  while (rel + 1 < relend && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset)
3022
                    rel++;
3023
                }
3024
            }
3025
          continue;
3026
 
3027
        default:
3028
          if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
3029
              && dynamic_symbol && (is_operand_relocation (r_type)
3030
                                    || r_type == R_XTENSA_32_PCREL))
3031
            {
3032
              error_message =
3033
                vsprint_msg ("invalid relocation for dynamic symbol", ": %s",
3034
                             strlen (name) + 2, name);
3035
              if (!((*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
3036
                    (info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
3037
                     rel->r_offset)))
3038
                return FALSE;
3039
              continue;
3040
            }
3041
          break;
3042
        }
3043
 
3044
      /* Dynamic relocs are not propagated for SEC_DEBUGGING sections
3045
         because such sections are not SEC_ALLOC and thus ld.so will
3046
         not process them.  */
3047
      if (unresolved_reloc
3048
          && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
3049
               && h->def_dynamic))
3050
        {
3051
          (*_bfd_error_handler)
3052
            (_("%B(%A+0x%lx): unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'"),
3053
             input_bfd,
3054
             input_section,
3055
             (long) rel->r_offset,
3056
             howto->name,
3057
             name);
3058
          return FALSE;
3059
        }
3060
 
3061
      /* TLS optimizations may have changed r_type; update "howto".  */
3062
      howto = &elf_howto_table[r_type];
3063
 
3064
      /* There's no point in calling bfd_perform_relocation here.
3065
         Just go directly to our "special function".  */
3066
      r = elf_xtensa_do_reloc (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
3067
                               relocation + rel->r_addend,
3068
                               contents, rel->r_offset, is_weak_undef,
3069
                               &error_message);
3070
 
3071
      if (r != bfd_reloc_ok && !warned)
3072
        {
3073
          BFD_ASSERT (r == bfd_reloc_dangerous || r == bfd_reloc_other);
3074
          BFD_ASSERT (error_message != NULL);
3075
 
3076
          if (rel->r_addend == 0)
3077
            error_message = vsprint_msg (error_message, ": %s",
3078
                                         strlen (name) + 2, name);
3079
          else
3080
            error_message = vsprint_msg (error_message, ": (%s+0x%x)",
3081
                                         strlen (name) + 22,
3082
                                         name, (int) rel->r_addend);
3083
 
3084
          if (!((*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
3085
                (info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
3086
                 rel->r_offset)))
3087
            return FALSE;
3088
        }
3089
    }
3090
 
3091
  if (lit_table)
3092
    free (lit_table);
3093
 
3094
  input_section->reloc_done = TRUE;
3095
 
3096
  return TRUE;
3097
}
3098
 
3099
 
3100
/* Finish up dynamic symbol handling.  There's not much to do here since
3101
   the PLT and GOT entries are all set up by relocate_section.  */
3102
 
3103
static bfd_boolean
3104
elf_xtensa_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3105
                                  struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3106
                                  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
3107
                                  Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
3108
{
3109
  if (h->needs_plt && !h->def_regular)
3110
    {
3111
      /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as defined in
3112
         the .plt section.  Leave the value alone.  */
3113
      sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
3114
      /* If the symbol is weak, we do need to clear the value.
3115
         Otherwise, the PLT entry would provide a definition for
3116
         the symbol even if the symbol wasn't defined anywhere,
3117
         and so the symbol would never be NULL.  */
3118
      if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
3119
        sym->st_value = 0;
3120
    }
3121
 
3122
  /* Mark _DYNAMIC and _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ as absolute.  */
3123
  if (strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_DYNAMIC") == 0
3124
      || h == elf_hash_table (info)->hgot)
3125
    sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
3126
 
3127
  return TRUE;
3128
}
3129
 
3130
 
3131
/* Combine adjacent literal table entries in the output.  Adjacent
3132
   entries within each input section may have been removed during
3133
   relaxation, but we repeat the process here, even though it's too late
3134
   to shrink the output section, because it's important to minimize the
3135
   number of literal table entries to reduce the start-up work for the
3136
   runtime linker.  Returns the number of remaining table entries or -1
3137
   on error.  */
3138
 
3139
static int
3140
elf_xtensa_combine_prop_entries (bfd *output_bfd,
3141
                                 asection *sxtlit,
3142
                                 asection *sgotloc)
3143
{
3144
  bfd_byte *contents;
3145
  property_table_entry *table;
3146
  bfd_size_type section_size, sgotloc_size;
3147
  bfd_vma offset;
3148
  int n, m, num;
3149
 
3150
  section_size = sxtlit->size;
3151
  BFD_ASSERT (section_size % 8 == 0);
3152
  num = section_size / 8;
3153
 
3154
  sgotloc_size = sgotloc->size;
3155
  if (sgotloc_size != section_size)
3156
    {
3157
      (*_bfd_error_handler)
3158
        (_("internal inconsistency in size of .got.loc section"));
3159
      return -1;
3160
    }
3161
 
3162
  table = bfd_malloc (num * sizeof (property_table_entry));
3163
  if (table == 0)
3164
    return -1;
3165
 
3166
  /* The ".xt.lit.plt" section has the SEC_IN_MEMORY flag set and this
3167
     propagates to the output section, where it doesn't really apply and
3168
     where it breaks the following call to bfd_malloc_and_get_section.  */
3169
  sxtlit->flags &= ~SEC_IN_MEMORY;
3170
 
3171
  if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (output_bfd, sxtlit, &contents))
3172
    {
3173
      if (contents != 0)
3174
        free (contents);
3175
      free (table);
3176
      return -1;
3177
    }
3178
 
3179
  /* There should never be any relocations left at this point, so this
3180
     is quite a bit easier than what is done during relaxation.  */
3181
 
3182
  /* Copy the raw contents into a property table array and sort it.  */
3183
  offset = 0;
3184
  for (n = 0; n < num; n++)
3185
    {
3186
      table[n].address = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, &contents[offset]);
3187
      table[n].size = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, &contents[offset + 4]);
3188
      offset += 8;
3189
    }
3190
  qsort (table, num, sizeof (property_table_entry), property_table_compare);
3191
 
3192
  for (n = 0; n < num; n++)
3193
    {
3194
      bfd_boolean remove_entry = FALSE;
3195
 
3196
      if (table[n].size == 0)
3197
        remove_entry = TRUE;
3198
      else if (n > 0
3199
               && (table[n-1].address + table[n-1].size == table[n].address))
3200
        {
3201
          table[n-1].size += table[n].size;
3202
          remove_entry = TRUE;
3203
        }
3204
 
3205
      if (remove_entry)
3206
        {
3207
          for (m = n; m < num - 1; m++)
3208
            {
3209
              table[m].address = table[m+1].address;
3210
              table[m].size = table[m+1].size;
3211
            }
3212
 
3213
          n--;
3214
          num--;
3215
        }
3216
    }
3217
 
3218
  /* Copy the data back to the raw contents.  */
3219
  offset = 0;
3220
  for (n = 0; n < num; n++)
3221
    {
3222
      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, table[n].address, &contents[offset]);
3223
      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, table[n].size, &contents[offset + 4]);
3224
      offset += 8;
3225
    }
3226
 
3227
  /* Clear the removed bytes.  */
3228
  if ((bfd_size_type) (num * 8) < section_size)
3229
    memset (&contents[num * 8], 0, section_size - num * 8);
3230
 
3231
  if (! bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, sxtlit, contents, 0,
3232
                                  section_size))
3233
    return -1;
3234
 
3235
  /* Copy the contents to ".got.loc".  */
3236
  memcpy (sgotloc->contents, contents, section_size);
3237
 
3238
  free (contents);
3239
  free (table);
3240
  return num;
3241
}
3242
 
3243
 
3244
/* Finish up the dynamic sections.  */
3245
 
3246
static bfd_boolean
3247
elf_xtensa_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
3248
                                    struct bfd_link_info *info)
3249
{
3250
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
3251
  bfd *dynobj;
3252
  asection *sdyn, *srelplt, *sgot, *sxtlit, *sgotloc;
3253
  Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
3254
  int num_xtlit_entries = 0;
3255
 
3256
  if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
3257
    return TRUE;
3258
 
3259
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
3260
  if (htab == NULL)
3261
    return FALSE;
3262
 
3263
  dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
3264
  sdyn = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".dynamic");
3265
  BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
3266
 
3267
  /* Set the first entry in the global offset table to the address of
3268
     the dynamic section.  */
3269
  sgot = htab->sgot;
3270
  if (sgot)
3271
    {
3272
      BFD_ASSERT (sgot->size == 4);
3273
      if (sdyn == NULL)
3274
        bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents);
3275
      else
3276
        bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
3277
                    sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset,
3278
                    sgot->contents);
3279
    }
3280
 
3281
  srelplt = htab->srelplt;
3282
  if (srelplt && srelplt->size != 0)
3283
    {
3284
      asection *sgotplt, *srelgot, *spltlittbl;
3285
      int chunk, plt_chunks, plt_entries;
3286
      Elf_Internal_Rela irela;
3287
      bfd_byte *loc;
3288
      unsigned rtld_reloc;
3289
 
3290
      srelgot = htab->srelgot;
3291
      spltlittbl = htab->spltlittbl;
3292
      BFD_ASSERT (srelgot != NULL && spltlittbl != NULL);
3293
 
3294
      /* Find the first XTENSA_RTLD relocation.  Presumably the rest
3295
         of them follow immediately after....  */
3296
      for (rtld_reloc = 0; rtld_reloc < srelgot->reloc_count; rtld_reloc++)
3297
        {
3298
          loc = srelgot->contents + rtld_reloc * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
3299
          bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &irela);
3300
          if (ELF32_R_TYPE (irela.r_info) == R_XTENSA_RTLD)
3301
            break;
3302
        }
3303
      BFD_ASSERT (rtld_reloc < srelgot->reloc_count);
3304
 
3305
      plt_entries = srelplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
3306
      plt_chunks =
3307
        (plt_entries + PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK - 1) / PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK;
3308
 
3309
      for (chunk = 0; chunk < plt_chunks; chunk++)
3310
        {
3311
          int chunk_entries = 0;
3312
 
3313
          sgotplt = elf_xtensa_get_gotplt_section (info, chunk);
3314
          BFD_ASSERT (sgotplt != NULL);
3315
 
3316
          /* Emit special RTLD relocations for the first two entries in
3317
             each chunk of the .got.plt section.  */
3318
 
3319
          loc = srelgot->contents + rtld_reloc * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
3320
          bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &irela);
3321
          BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (irela.r_info) == R_XTENSA_RTLD);
3322
          irela.r_offset = (sgotplt->output_section->vma
3323
                            + sgotplt->output_offset);
3324
          irela.r_addend = 1; /* tell rtld to set value to resolver function */
3325
          bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &irela, loc);
3326
          rtld_reloc += 1;
3327
          BFD_ASSERT (rtld_reloc <= srelgot->reloc_count);
3328
 
3329
          /* Next literal immediately follows the first.  */
3330
          loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
3331
          bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &irela);
3332
          BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (irela.r_info) == R_XTENSA_RTLD);
3333
          irela.r_offset = (sgotplt->output_section->vma
3334
                            + sgotplt->output_offset + 4);
3335
          /* Tell rtld to set value to object's link map.  */
3336
          irela.r_addend = 2;
3337
          bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &irela, loc);
3338
          rtld_reloc += 1;
3339
          BFD_ASSERT (rtld_reloc <= srelgot->reloc_count);
3340
 
3341
          /* Fill in the literal table.  */
3342
          if (chunk < plt_chunks - 1)
3343
            chunk_entries = PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK;
3344
          else
3345
            chunk_entries = plt_entries - (chunk * PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK);
3346
 
3347
          BFD_ASSERT ((unsigned) (chunk + 1) * 8 <= spltlittbl->size);
3348
          bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
3349
                      sgotplt->output_section->vma + sgotplt->output_offset,
3350
                      spltlittbl->contents + (chunk * 8) + 0);
3351
          bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
3352
                      8 + (chunk_entries * 4),
3353
                      spltlittbl->contents + (chunk * 8) + 4);
3354
        }
3355
 
3356
      /* All the dynamic relocations have been emitted at this point.
3357
         Make sure the relocation sections are the correct size.  */
3358
      if (srelgot->size != (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
3359
                            * srelgot->reloc_count)
3360
          || srelplt->size != (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
3361
                               * srelplt->reloc_count))
3362
        abort ();
3363
 
3364
     /* The .xt.lit.plt section has just been modified.  This must
3365
        happen before the code below which combines adjacent literal
3366
        table entries, and the .xt.lit.plt contents have to be forced to
3367
        the output here.  */
3368
      if (! bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd,
3369
                                      spltlittbl->output_section,
3370
                                      spltlittbl->contents,
3371
                                      spltlittbl->output_offset,
3372
                                      spltlittbl->size))
3373
        return FALSE;
3374
      /* Clear SEC_HAS_CONTENTS so the contents won't be output again.  */
3375
      spltlittbl->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
3376
    }
3377
 
3378
  /* Combine adjacent literal table entries.  */
3379
  BFD_ASSERT (! info->relocatable);
3380
  sxtlit = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".xt.lit");
3381
  sgotloc = htab->sgotloc;
3382
  BFD_ASSERT (sgotloc);
3383
  if (sxtlit)
3384
    {
3385
      num_xtlit_entries =
3386
        elf_xtensa_combine_prop_entries (output_bfd, sxtlit, sgotloc);
3387
      if (num_xtlit_entries < 0)
3388
        return FALSE;
3389
    }
3390
 
3391
  dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
3392
  dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
3393
  for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
3394
    {
3395
      Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
3396
 
3397
      bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
3398
 
3399
      switch (dyn.d_tag)
3400
        {
3401
        default:
3402
          break;
3403
 
3404
        case DT_XTENSA_GOT_LOC_SZ:
3405
          dyn.d_un.d_val = num_xtlit_entries;
3406
          break;
3407
 
3408
        case DT_XTENSA_GOT_LOC_OFF:
3409
          dyn.d_un.d_ptr = htab->sgotloc->output_section->vma;
3410
          break;
3411
 
3412
        case DT_PLTGOT:
3413
          dyn.d_un.d_ptr = htab->sgot->output_section->vma;
3414
          break;
3415
 
3416
        case DT_JMPREL:
3417
          dyn.d_un.d_ptr = htab->srelplt->output_section->vma;
3418
          break;
3419
 
3420
        case DT_PLTRELSZ:
3421
          dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->srelplt->output_section->size;
3422
          break;
3423
 
3424
        case DT_RELASZ:
3425
          /* Adjust RELASZ to not include JMPREL.  This matches what
3426
             glibc expects and what is done for several other ELF
3427
             targets (e.g., i386, alpha), but the "correct" behavior
3428
             seems to be unresolved.  Since the linker script arranges
3429
             for .rela.plt to follow all other relocation sections, we
3430
             don't have to worry about changing the DT_RELA entry.  */
3431
          if (htab->srelplt)
3432
            dyn.d_un.d_val -= htab->srelplt->output_section->size;
3433
          break;
3434
        }
3435
 
3436
      bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
3437
    }
3438
 
3439
  return TRUE;
3440
}
3441
 
3442
 
3443
/* Functions for dealing with the e_flags field.  */
3444
 
3445
/* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
3446
   object file when linking.  */
3447
 
3448
static bfd_boolean
3449
elf_xtensa_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
3450
{
3451
  unsigned out_mach, in_mach;
3452
  flagword out_flag, in_flag;
3453
 
3454
  /* Check if we have the same endianess.  */
3455
  if (!_bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, obfd))
3456
    return FALSE;
3457
 
3458
  /* Don't even pretend to support mixed-format linking.  */
3459
  if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
3460
      || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
3461
    return FALSE;
3462
 
3463
  out_flag = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
3464
  in_flag = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
3465
 
3466
  out_mach = out_flag & EF_XTENSA_MACH;
3467
  in_mach = in_flag & EF_XTENSA_MACH;
3468
  if (out_mach != in_mach)
3469
    {
3470
      (*_bfd_error_handler)
3471
        (_("%B: incompatible machine type. Output is 0x%x. Input is 0x%x"),
3472
         ibfd, out_mach, in_mach);
3473
      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
3474
      return FALSE;
3475
    }
3476
 
3477
  if (! elf_flags_init (obfd))
3478
    {
3479
      elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
3480
      elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = in_flag;
3481
 
3482
      if (bfd_get_arch (obfd) == bfd_get_arch (ibfd)
3483
          && bfd_get_arch_info (obfd)->the_default)
3484
        return bfd_set_arch_mach (obfd, bfd_get_arch (ibfd),
3485
                                  bfd_get_mach (ibfd));
3486
 
3487
      return TRUE;
3488
    }
3489
 
3490
  if ((out_flag & EF_XTENSA_XT_INSN) != (in_flag & EF_XTENSA_XT_INSN))
3491
    elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= (~ EF_XTENSA_XT_INSN);
3492
 
3493
  if ((out_flag & EF_XTENSA_XT_LIT) != (in_flag & EF_XTENSA_XT_LIT))
3494
    elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= (~ EF_XTENSA_XT_LIT);
3495
 
3496
  return TRUE;
3497
}
3498
 
3499
 
3500
static bfd_boolean
3501
elf_xtensa_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
3502
{
3503
  BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
3504
              || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
3505
 
3506
  elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= flags;
3507
  elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
3508
 
3509
  return TRUE;
3510
}
3511
 
3512
 
3513
static bfd_boolean
3514
elf_xtensa_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
3515
{
3516
  FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
3517
  flagword e_flags = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags;
3518
 
3519
  fprintf (f, "\nXtensa header:\n");
3520
  if ((e_flags & EF_XTENSA_MACH) == E_XTENSA_MACH)
3521
    fprintf (f, "\nMachine     = Base\n");
3522
  else
3523
    fprintf (f, "\nMachine Id  = 0x%x\n", e_flags & EF_XTENSA_MACH);
3524
 
3525
  fprintf (f, "Insn tables = %s\n",
3526
           (e_flags & EF_XTENSA_XT_INSN) ? "true" : "false");
3527
 
3528
  fprintf (f, "Literal tables = %s\n",
3529
           (e_flags & EF_XTENSA_XT_LIT) ? "true" : "false");
3530
 
3531
  return _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, farg);
3532
}
3533
 
3534
 
3535
/* Set the right machine number for an Xtensa ELF file.  */
3536
 
3537
static bfd_boolean
3538
elf_xtensa_object_p (bfd *abfd)
3539
{
3540
  int mach;
3541
  unsigned long arch = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_XTENSA_MACH;
3542
 
3543
  switch (arch)
3544
    {
3545
    case E_XTENSA_MACH:
3546
      mach = bfd_mach_xtensa;
3547
      break;
3548
    default:
3549
      return FALSE;
3550
    }
3551
 
3552
  (void) bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, bfd_arch_xtensa, mach);
3553
  return TRUE;
3554
}
3555
 
3556
 
3557
/* The final processing done just before writing out an Xtensa ELF object
3558
   file.  This gets the Xtensa architecture right based on the machine
3559
   number.  */
3560
 
3561
static void
3562
elf_xtensa_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd,
3563
                                   bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3564
{
3565
  int mach;
3566
  unsigned long val;
3567
 
3568
  switch (mach = bfd_get_mach (abfd))
3569
    {
3570
    case bfd_mach_xtensa:
3571
      val = E_XTENSA_MACH;
3572
      break;
3573
    default:
3574
      return;
3575
    }
3576
 
3577
  elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &=  (~ EF_XTENSA_MACH);
3578
  elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= val;
3579
}
3580
 
3581
 
3582
static enum elf_reloc_type_class
3583
elf_xtensa_reloc_type_class (const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
3584
{
3585
  switch ((int) ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
3586
    {
3587
    case R_XTENSA_RELATIVE:
3588
      return reloc_class_relative;
3589
    case R_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT:
3590
      return reloc_class_plt;
3591
    default:
3592
      return reloc_class_normal;
3593
    }
3594
}
3595
 
3596
 
3597
static bfd_boolean
3598
elf_xtensa_discard_info_for_section (bfd *abfd,
3599
                                     struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie,
3600
                                     struct bfd_link_info *info,
3601
                                     asection *sec)
3602
{
3603
  bfd_byte *contents;
3604
  bfd_vma offset, actual_offset;
3605
  bfd_size_type removed_bytes = 0;
3606
  bfd_size_type entry_size;
3607
 
3608
  if (sec->output_section
3609
      && bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
3610
    return FALSE;
3611
 
3612
  if (xtensa_is_proptable_section (sec))
3613
    entry_size = 12;
3614
  else
3615
    entry_size = 8;
3616
 
3617
  if (sec->size == 0 || sec->size % entry_size != 0)
3618
    return FALSE;
3619
 
3620
  contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, info->keep_memory);
3621
  if (!contents)
3622
    return FALSE;
3623
 
3624
  cookie->rels = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec, info->keep_memory);
3625
  if (!cookie->rels)
3626
    {
3627
      release_contents (sec, contents);
3628
      return FALSE;
3629
    }
3630
 
3631
  /* Sort the relocations.  They should already be in order when
3632
     relaxation is enabled, but it might not be.  */
3633
  qsort (cookie->rels, sec->reloc_count, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela),
3634
         internal_reloc_compare);
3635
 
3636
  cookie->rel = cookie->rels;
3637
  cookie->relend = cookie->rels + sec->reloc_count;
3638
 
3639
  for (offset = 0; offset < sec->size; offset += entry_size)
3640
    {
3641
      actual_offset = offset - removed_bytes;
3642
 
3643
      /* The ...symbol_deleted_p function will skip over relocs but it
3644
         won't adjust their offsets, so do that here.  */
3645
      while (cookie->rel < cookie->relend
3646
             && cookie->rel->r_offset < offset)
3647
        {
3648
          cookie->rel->r_offset -= removed_bytes;
3649
          cookie->rel++;
3650
        }
3651
 
3652
      while (cookie->rel < cookie->relend
3653
             && cookie->rel->r_offset == offset)
3654
        {
3655
          if (bfd_elf_reloc_symbol_deleted_p (offset, cookie))
3656
            {
3657
              /* Remove the table entry.  (If the reloc type is NONE, then
3658
                 the entry has already been merged with another and deleted
3659
                 during relaxation.)  */
3660
              if (ELF32_R_TYPE (cookie->rel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_NONE)
3661
                {
3662
                  /* Shift the contents up.  */
3663
                  if (offset + entry_size < sec->size)
3664
                    memmove (&contents[actual_offset],
3665
                             &contents[actual_offset + entry_size],
3666
                             sec->size - offset - entry_size);
3667
                  removed_bytes += entry_size;
3668
                }
3669
 
3670
              /* Remove this relocation.  */
3671
              cookie->rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_NONE);
3672
            }
3673
 
3674
          /* Adjust the relocation offset for previous removals.  This
3675
             should not be done before calling ...symbol_deleted_p
3676
             because it might mess up the offset comparisons there.
3677
             Make sure the offset doesn't underflow in the case where
3678
             the first entry is removed.  */
3679
          if (cookie->rel->r_offset >= removed_bytes)
3680
            cookie->rel->r_offset -= removed_bytes;
3681
          else
3682
            cookie->rel->r_offset = 0;
3683
 
3684
          cookie->rel++;
3685
        }
3686
    }
3687
 
3688
  if (removed_bytes != 0)
3689
    {
3690
      /* Adjust any remaining relocs (shouldn't be any).  */
3691
      for (; cookie->rel < cookie->relend; cookie->rel++)
3692
        {
3693
          if (cookie->rel->r_offset >= removed_bytes)
3694
            cookie->rel->r_offset -= removed_bytes;
3695
          else
3696
            cookie->rel->r_offset = 0;
3697
        }
3698
 
3699
      /* Clear the removed bytes.  */
3700
      memset (&contents[sec->size - removed_bytes], 0, removed_bytes);
3701
 
3702
      pin_contents (sec, contents);
3703
      pin_internal_relocs (sec, cookie->rels);
3704
 
3705
      /* Shrink size.  */
3706
      if (sec->rawsize == 0)
3707
        sec->rawsize = sec->size;
3708
      sec->size -= removed_bytes;
3709
 
3710
      if (xtensa_is_littable_section (sec))
3711
        {
3712
          asection *sgotloc = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info)->sgotloc;
3713
          if (sgotloc)
3714
            sgotloc->size -= removed_bytes;
3715
        }
3716
    }
3717
  else
3718
    {
3719
      release_contents (sec, contents);
3720
      release_internal_relocs (sec, cookie->rels);
3721
    }
3722
 
3723
  return (removed_bytes != 0);
3724
}
3725
 
3726
 
3727
static bfd_boolean
3728
elf_xtensa_discard_info (bfd *abfd,
3729
                         struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie,
3730
                         struct bfd_link_info *info)
3731
{
3732
  asection *sec;
3733
  bfd_boolean changed = FALSE;
3734
 
3735
  for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
3736
    {
3737
      if (xtensa_is_property_section (sec))
3738
        {
3739
          if (elf_xtensa_discard_info_for_section (abfd, cookie, info, sec))
3740
            changed = TRUE;
3741
        }
3742
    }
3743
 
3744
  return changed;
3745
}
3746
 
3747
 
3748
static bfd_boolean
3749
elf_xtensa_ignore_discarded_relocs (asection *sec)
3750
{
3751
  return xtensa_is_property_section (sec);
3752
}
3753
 
3754
 
3755
static unsigned int
3756
elf_xtensa_action_discarded (asection *sec)
3757
{
3758
  if (strcmp (".xt_except_table", sec->name) == 0)
3759
    return 0;
3760
 
3761
  if (strcmp (".xt_except_desc", sec->name) == 0)
3762
    return 0;
3763
 
3764
  return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
3765
}
3766
 
3767
 
3768
/* Support for core dump NOTE sections.  */
3769
 
3770
static bfd_boolean
3771
elf_xtensa_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
3772
{
3773
  int offset;
3774
  unsigned int size;
3775
 
3776
  /* The size for Xtensa is variable, so don't try to recognize the format
3777
     based on the size.  Just assume this is GNU/Linux.  */
3778
 
3779
  /* pr_cursig */
3780
  elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
3781
 
3782
  /* pr_pid */
3783
  elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
3784
 
3785
  /* pr_reg */
3786
  offset = 72;
3787
  size = note->descsz - offset - 4;
3788
 
3789
  /* Make a ".reg/999" section.  */
3790
  return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
3791
                                          size, note->descpos + offset);
3792
}
3793
 
3794
 
3795
static bfd_boolean
3796
elf_xtensa_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
3797
{
3798
  switch (note->descsz)
3799
    {
3800
      default:
3801
        return FALSE;
3802
 
3803
      case 128:         /* GNU/Linux elf_prpsinfo */
3804
        elf_tdata (abfd)->core_program
3805
         = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
3806
        elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command
3807
         = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
3808
    }
3809
 
3810
  /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
3811
     onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
3812
     implementations, so strip it off if it exists.  */
3813
 
3814
  {
3815
    char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command;
3816
    int n = strlen (command);
3817
 
3818
    if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
3819
      command[n - 1] = '\0';
3820
  }
3821
 
3822
  return TRUE;
3823
}
3824
 
3825
 
3826
/* Generic Xtensa configurability stuff.  */
3827
 
3828
static xtensa_opcode callx0_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3829
static xtensa_opcode callx4_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3830
static xtensa_opcode callx8_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3831
static xtensa_opcode callx12_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3832
static xtensa_opcode call0_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3833
static xtensa_opcode call4_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3834
static xtensa_opcode call8_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3835
static xtensa_opcode call12_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3836
 
3837
static void
3838
init_call_opcodes (void)
3839
{
3840
  if (callx0_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
3841
    {
3842
      callx0_op  = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "callx0");
3843
      callx4_op  = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "callx4");
3844
      callx8_op  = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "callx8");
3845
      callx12_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "callx12");
3846
      call0_op   = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "call0");
3847
      call4_op   = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "call4");
3848
      call8_op   = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "call8");
3849
      call12_op  = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "call12");
3850
    }
3851
}
3852
 
3853
 
3854
static bfd_boolean
3855
is_indirect_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode opcode)
3856
{
3857
  init_call_opcodes ();
3858
  return (opcode == callx0_op
3859
          || opcode == callx4_op
3860
          || opcode == callx8_op
3861
          || opcode == callx12_op);
3862
}
3863
 
3864
 
3865
static bfd_boolean
3866
is_direct_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode opcode)
3867
{
3868
  init_call_opcodes ();
3869
  return (opcode == call0_op
3870
          || opcode == call4_op
3871
          || opcode == call8_op
3872
          || opcode == call12_op);
3873
}
3874
 
3875
 
3876
static bfd_boolean
3877
is_windowed_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode opcode)
3878
{
3879
  init_call_opcodes ();
3880
  return (opcode == call4_op
3881
          || opcode == call8_op
3882
          || opcode == call12_op
3883
          || opcode == callx4_op
3884
          || opcode == callx8_op
3885
          || opcode == callx12_op);
3886
}
3887
 
3888
 
3889
static bfd_boolean
3890
get_indirect_call_dest_reg (xtensa_opcode opcode, unsigned *pdst)
3891
{
3892
  unsigned dst = (unsigned) -1;
3893
 
3894
  init_call_opcodes ();
3895
  if (opcode == callx0_op)
3896
    dst = 0;
3897
  else if (opcode == callx4_op)
3898
    dst = 4;
3899
  else if (opcode == callx8_op)
3900
    dst = 8;
3901
  else if (opcode == callx12_op)
3902
    dst = 12;
3903
 
3904
  if (dst == (unsigned) -1)
3905
    return FALSE;
3906
 
3907
  *pdst = dst;
3908
  return TRUE;
3909
}
3910
 
3911
 
3912
static xtensa_opcode
3913
get_const16_opcode (void)
3914
{
3915
  static bfd_boolean done_lookup = FALSE;
3916
  static xtensa_opcode const16_opcode = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3917
  if (!done_lookup)
3918
    {
3919
      const16_opcode = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "const16");
3920
      done_lookup = TRUE;
3921
    }
3922
  return const16_opcode;
3923
}
3924
 
3925
 
3926
static xtensa_opcode
3927
get_l32r_opcode (void)
3928
{
3929
  static xtensa_opcode l32r_opcode = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3930
  static bfd_boolean done_lookup = FALSE;
3931
 
3932
  if (!done_lookup)
3933
    {
3934
      l32r_opcode = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "l32r");
3935
      done_lookup = TRUE;
3936
    }
3937
  return l32r_opcode;
3938
}
3939
 
3940
 
3941
static bfd_vma
3942
l32r_offset (bfd_vma addr, bfd_vma pc)
3943
{
3944
  bfd_vma offset;
3945
 
3946
  offset = addr - ((pc+3) & -4);
3947
  BFD_ASSERT ((offset & ((1 << 2) - 1)) == 0);
3948
  offset = (signed int) offset >> 2;
3949
  BFD_ASSERT ((signed int) offset >> 16 == -1);
3950
  return offset;
3951
}
3952
 
3953
 
3954
static int
3955
get_relocation_opnd (xtensa_opcode opcode, int r_type)
3956
{
3957
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
3958
  int last_immed, last_opnd, opi;
3959
 
3960
  if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
3961
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3962
 
3963
  /* Find the last visible PC-relative immediate operand for the opcode.
3964
     If there are no PC-relative immediates, then choose the last visible
3965
     immediate; otherwise, fail and return XTENSA_UNDEFINED.  */
3966
  last_immed = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3967
  last_opnd = xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, opcode);
3968
  for (opi = last_opnd - 1; opi >= 0; opi--)
3969
    {
3970
      if (xtensa_operand_is_visible (isa, opcode, opi) == 0)
3971
        continue;
3972
      if (xtensa_operand_is_PCrelative (isa, opcode, opi) == 1)
3973
        {
3974
          last_immed = opi;
3975
          break;
3976
        }
3977
      if (last_immed == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
3978
          && xtensa_operand_is_register (isa, opcode, opi) == 0)
3979
        last_immed = opi;
3980
    }
3981
  if (last_immed < 0)
3982
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3983
 
3984
  /* If the operand number was specified in an old-style relocation,
3985
     check for consistency with the operand computed above.  */
3986
  if (r_type >= R_XTENSA_OP0 && r_type <= R_XTENSA_OP2)
3987
    {
3988
      int reloc_opnd = r_type - R_XTENSA_OP0;
3989
      if (reloc_opnd != last_immed)
3990
        return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3991
    }
3992
 
3993
  return last_immed;
3994
}
3995
 
3996
 
3997
int
3998
get_relocation_slot (int r_type)
3999
{
4000
  switch (r_type)
4001
    {
4002
    case R_XTENSA_OP0:
4003
    case R_XTENSA_OP1:
4004
    case R_XTENSA_OP2:
4005
      return 0;
4006
 
4007
    default:
4008
      if (r_type >= R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP && r_type <= R_XTENSA_SLOT14_OP)
4009
        return r_type - R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP;
4010
      if (r_type >= R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT && r_type <= R_XTENSA_SLOT14_ALT)
4011
        return r_type - R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT;
4012
      break;
4013
    }
4014
 
4015
  return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4016
}
4017
 
4018
 
4019
/* Get the opcode for a relocation.  */
4020
 
4021
static xtensa_opcode
4022
get_relocation_opcode (bfd *abfd,
4023
                       asection *sec,
4024
                       bfd_byte *contents,
4025
                       Elf_Internal_Rela *irel)
4026
{
4027
  static xtensa_insnbuf ibuff = NULL;
4028
  static xtensa_insnbuf sbuff = NULL;
4029
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4030
  xtensa_format fmt;
4031
  int slot;
4032
 
4033
  if (contents == NULL)
4034
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4035
 
4036
  if (bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec) <= irel->r_offset)
4037
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4038
 
4039
  if (ibuff == NULL)
4040
    {
4041
      ibuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4042
      sbuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4043
    }
4044
 
4045
  /* Decode the instruction.  */
4046
  xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, ibuff, &contents[irel->r_offset],
4047
                             sec->size - irel->r_offset);
4048
  fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, ibuff);
4049
  slot = get_relocation_slot (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info));
4050
  if (slot == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4051
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4052
  xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, slot, ibuff, sbuff);
4053
  return xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, slot, sbuff);
4054
}
4055
 
4056
 
4057
bfd_boolean
4058
is_l32r_relocation (bfd *abfd,
4059
                    asection *sec,
4060
                    bfd_byte *contents,
4061
                    Elf_Internal_Rela *irel)
4062
{
4063
  xtensa_opcode opcode;
4064
  if (!is_operand_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info)))
4065
    return FALSE;
4066
  opcode = get_relocation_opcode (abfd, sec, contents, irel);
4067
  return (opcode == get_l32r_opcode ());
4068
}
4069
 
4070
 
4071
static bfd_size_type
4072
get_asm_simplify_size (bfd_byte *contents,
4073
                       bfd_size_type content_len,
4074
                       bfd_size_type offset)
4075
{
4076
  bfd_size_type insnlen, size = 0;
4077
 
4078
  /* Decode the size of the next two instructions.  */
4079
  insnlen = insn_decode_len (contents, content_len, offset);
4080
  if (insnlen == 0)
4081
    return 0;
4082
 
4083
  size += insnlen;
4084
 
4085
  insnlen = insn_decode_len (contents, content_len, offset + size);
4086
  if (insnlen == 0)
4087
    return 0;
4088
 
4089
  size += insnlen;
4090
  return size;
4091
}
4092
 
4093
 
4094
bfd_boolean
4095
is_alt_relocation (int r_type)
4096
{
4097
  return (r_type >= R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT
4098
          && r_type <= R_XTENSA_SLOT14_ALT);
4099
}
4100
 
4101
 
4102
bfd_boolean
4103
is_operand_relocation (int r_type)
4104
{
4105
  switch (r_type)
4106
    {
4107
    case R_XTENSA_OP0:
4108
    case R_XTENSA_OP1:
4109
    case R_XTENSA_OP2:
4110
      return TRUE;
4111
 
4112
    default:
4113
      if (r_type >= R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP && r_type <= R_XTENSA_SLOT14_OP)
4114
        return TRUE;
4115
      if (r_type >= R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT && r_type <= R_XTENSA_SLOT14_ALT)
4116
        return TRUE;
4117
      break;
4118
    }
4119
 
4120
  return FALSE;
4121
}
4122
 
4123
 
4124
#define MIN_INSN_LENGTH 2
4125
 
4126
/* Return 0 if it fails to decode.  */
4127
 
4128
bfd_size_type
4129
insn_decode_len (bfd_byte *contents,
4130
                 bfd_size_type content_len,
4131
                 bfd_size_type offset)
4132
{
4133
  int insn_len;
4134
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4135
  xtensa_format fmt;
4136
  static xtensa_insnbuf ibuff = NULL;
4137
 
4138
  if (offset + MIN_INSN_LENGTH > content_len)
4139
    return 0;
4140
 
4141
  if (ibuff == NULL)
4142
    ibuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4143
  xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, ibuff, &contents[offset],
4144
                             content_len - offset);
4145
  fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, ibuff);
4146
  if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4147
    return 0;
4148
  insn_len = xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
4149
  if (insn_len ==  XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4150
    return 0;
4151
  return insn_len;
4152
}
4153
 
4154
 
4155
/* Decode the opcode for a single slot instruction.
4156
   Return 0 if it fails to decode or the instruction is multi-slot.  */
4157
 
4158
xtensa_opcode
4159
insn_decode_opcode (bfd_byte *contents,
4160
                    bfd_size_type content_len,
4161
                    bfd_size_type offset,
4162
                    int slot)
4163
{
4164
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4165
  xtensa_format fmt;
4166
  static xtensa_insnbuf insnbuf = NULL;
4167
  static xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf = NULL;
4168
 
4169
  if (offset + MIN_INSN_LENGTH > content_len)
4170
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4171
 
4172
  if (insnbuf == NULL)
4173
    {
4174
      insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4175
      slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4176
    }
4177
 
4178
  xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, &contents[offset],
4179
                             content_len - offset);
4180
  fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
4181
  if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4182
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4183
 
4184
  if (slot >= xtensa_format_num_slots (isa, fmt))
4185
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4186
 
4187
  xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, slot, insnbuf, slotbuf);
4188
  return xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, slot, slotbuf);
4189
}
4190
 
4191
 
4192
/* The offset is the offset in the contents.
4193
   The address is the address of that offset.  */
4194
 
4195
static bfd_boolean
4196
check_branch_target_aligned (bfd_byte *contents,
4197
                             bfd_size_type content_length,
4198
                             bfd_vma offset,
4199
                             bfd_vma address)
4200
{
4201
  bfd_size_type insn_len = insn_decode_len (contents, content_length, offset);
4202
  if (insn_len == 0)
4203
    return FALSE;
4204
  return check_branch_target_aligned_address (address, insn_len);
4205
}
4206
 
4207
 
4208
static bfd_boolean
4209
check_loop_aligned (bfd_byte *contents,
4210
                    bfd_size_type content_length,
4211
                    bfd_vma offset,
4212
                    bfd_vma address)
4213
{
4214
  bfd_size_type loop_len, insn_len;
4215
  xtensa_opcode opcode;
4216
 
4217
  opcode = insn_decode_opcode (contents, content_length, offset, 0);
4218
  if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
4219
      || xtensa_opcode_is_loop (xtensa_default_isa, opcode) != 1)
4220
    {
4221
      BFD_ASSERT (FALSE);
4222
      return FALSE;
4223
    }
4224
 
4225
  loop_len = insn_decode_len (contents, content_length, offset);
4226
  insn_len = insn_decode_len (contents, content_length, offset + loop_len);
4227
  if (loop_len == 0 || insn_len == 0)
4228
    {
4229
      BFD_ASSERT (FALSE);
4230
      return FALSE;
4231
    }
4232
 
4233
  return check_branch_target_aligned_address (address + loop_len, insn_len);
4234
}
4235
 
4236
 
4237
static bfd_boolean
4238
check_branch_target_aligned_address (bfd_vma addr, int len)
4239
{
4240
  if (len == 8)
4241
    return (addr % 8 == 0);
4242
  return ((addr >> 2) == ((addr + len - 1) >> 2));
4243
}
4244
 
4245
 
4246
/* Instruction widening and narrowing.  */
4247
 
4248
/* When FLIX is available we need to access certain instructions only
4249
   when they are 16-bit or 24-bit instructions.  This table caches
4250
   information about such instructions by walking through all the
4251
   opcodes and finding the smallest single-slot format into which each
4252
   can be encoded.  */
4253
 
4254
static xtensa_format *op_single_fmt_table = NULL;
4255
 
4256
 
4257
static void
4258
init_op_single_format_table (void)
4259
{
4260
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4261
  xtensa_insnbuf ibuf;
4262
  xtensa_opcode opcode;
4263
  xtensa_format fmt;
4264
  int num_opcodes;
4265
 
4266
  if (op_single_fmt_table)
4267
    return;
4268
 
4269
  ibuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4270
  num_opcodes = xtensa_isa_num_opcodes (isa);
4271
 
4272
  op_single_fmt_table = (xtensa_format *)
4273
    bfd_malloc (sizeof (xtensa_format) * num_opcodes);
4274
  for (opcode = 0; opcode < num_opcodes; opcode++)
4275
    {
4276
      op_single_fmt_table[opcode] = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4277
      for (fmt = 0; fmt < xtensa_isa_num_formats (isa); fmt++)
4278
        {
4279
          if (xtensa_format_num_slots (isa, fmt) == 1
4280
              && xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, fmt, 0, ibuf, opcode) == 0)
4281
            {
4282
              xtensa_opcode old_fmt = op_single_fmt_table[opcode];
4283
              int fmt_length = xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
4284
              if (old_fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
4285
                  || fmt_length < xtensa_format_length (isa, old_fmt))
4286
                op_single_fmt_table[opcode] = fmt;
4287
            }
4288
        }
4289
    }
4290
  xtensa_insnbuf_free (isa, ibuf);
4291
}
4292
 
4293
 
4294
static xtensa_format
4295
get_single_format (xtensa_opcode opcode)
4296
{
4297
  init_op_single_format_table ();
4298
  return op_single_fmt_table[opcode];
4299
}
4300
 
4301
 
4302
/* For the set of narrowable instructions we do NOT include the
4303
   narrowings beqz -> beqz.n or bnez -> bnez.n because of complexities
4304
   involved during linker relaxation that may require these to
4305
   re-expand in some conditions.  Also, the narrowing "or" -> mov.n
4306
   requires special case code to ensure it only works when op1 == op2.  */
4307
 
4308
struct string_pair
4309
{
4310
  const char *wide;
4311
  const char *narrow;
4312
};
4313
 
4314
struct string_pair narrowable[] =
4315
{
4316
  { "add", "add.n" },
4317
  { "addi", "addi.n" },
4318
  { "addmi", "addi.n" },
4319
  { "l32i", "l32i.n" },
4320
  { "movi", "movi.n" },
4321
  { "ret", "ret.n" },
4322
  { "retw", "retw.n" },
4323
  { "s32i", "s32i.n" },
4324
  { "or", "mov.n" } /* special case only when op1 == op2 */
4325
};
4326
 
4327
struct string_pair widenable[] =
4328
{
4329
  { "add", "add.n" },
4330
  { "addi", "addi.n" },
4331
  { "addmi", "addi.n" },
4332
  { "beqz", "beqz.n" },
4333
  { "bnez", "bnez.n" },
4334
  { "l32i", "l32i.n" },
4335
  { "movi", "movi.n" },
4336
  { "ret", "ret.n" },
4337
  { "retw", "retw.n" },
4338
  { "s32i", "s32i.n" },
4339
  { "or", "mov.n" } /* special case only when op1 == op2 */
4340
};
4341
 
4342
 
4343
/* Check if an instruction can be "narrowed", i.e., changed from a standard
4344
   3-byte instruction to a 2-byte "density" instruction.  If it is valid,
4345
   return the instruction buffer holding the narrow instruction.  Otherwise,
4346
   return 0.  The set of valid narrowing are specified by a string table
4347
   but require some special case operand checks in some cases.  */
4348
 
4349
static xtensa_insnbuf
4350
can_narrow_instruction (xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf,
4351
                        xtensa_format fmt,
4352
                        xtensa_opcode opcode)
4353
{
4354
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4355
  xtensa_format o_fmt;
4356
  unsigned opi;
4357
 
4358
  static xtensa_insnbuf o_insnbuf = NULL;
4359
  static xtensa_insnbuf o_slotbuf = NULL;
4360
 
4361
  if (o_insnbuf == NULL)
4362
    {
4363
      o_insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4364
      o_slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4365
    }
4366
 
4367
  for (opi = 0; opi < (sizeof (narrowable)/sizeof (struct string_pair)); opi++)
4368
    {
4369
      bfd_boolean is_or = (strcmp ("or", narrowable[opi].wide) == 0);
4370
 
4371
      if (opcode == xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, narrowable[opi].wide))
4372
        {
4373
          uint32 value, newval;
4374
          int i, operand_count, o_operand_count;
4375
          xtensa_opcode o_opcode;
4376
 
4377
          /* Address does not matter in this case.  We might need to
4378
             fix it to handle branches/jumps.  */
4379
          bfd_vma self_address = 0;
4380
 
4381
          o_opcode = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, narrowable[opi].narrow);
4382
          if (o_opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4383
            return 0;
4384
          o_fmt = get_single_format (o_opcode);
4385
          if (o_fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4386
            return 0;
4387
 
4388
          if (xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt) != 3
4389
              || xtensa_format_length (isa, o_fmt) != 2)
4390
            return 0;
4391
 
4392
          xtensa_format_encode (isa, o_fmt, o_insnbuf);
4393
          operand_count = xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, opcode);
4394
          o_operand_count = xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, o_opcode);
4395
 
4396
          if (xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, o_fmt, 0, o_slotbuf, o_opcode) != 0)
4397
            return 0;
4398
 
4399
          if (!is_or)
4400
            {
4401
              if (xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, o_opcode) != operand_count)
4402
                return 0;
4403
            }
4404
          else
4405
            {
4406
              uint32 rawval0, rawval1, rawval2;
4407
 
4408
              if (o_operand_count + 1 != operand_count
4409
                  || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, 0,
4410
                                               fmt, 0, slotbuf, &rawval0) != 0
4411
                  || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, 1,
4412
                                               fmt, 0, slotbuf, &rawval1) != 0
4413
                  || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, 2,
4414
                                               fmt, 0, slotbuf, &rawval2) != 0
4415
                  || rawval1 != rawval2
4416
                  || rawval0 == rawval1 /* it is a nop */)
4417
                return 0;
4418
            }
4419
 
4420
          for (i = 0; i < o_operand_count; ++i)
4421
            {
4422
              if (xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, i, fmt, 0,
4423
                                            slotbuf, &value)
4424
                  || xtensa_operand_decode (isa, opcode, i, &value))
4425
                return 0;
4426
 
4427
              /* PC-relative branches need adjustment, but
4428
                 the PC-rel operand will always have a relocation.  */
4429
              newval = value;
4430
              if (xtensa_operand_do_reloc (isa, o_opcode, i, &newval,
4431
                                           self_address)
4432
                  || xtensa_operand_encode (isa, o_opcode, i, &newval)
4433
                  || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, o_opcode, i, o_fmt, 0,
4434
                                               o_slotbuf, newval))
4435
                return 0;
4436
            }
4437
 
4438
          if (xtensa_format_set_slot (isa, o_fmt, 0, o_insnbuf, o_slotbuf))
4439
            return 0;
4440
 
4441
          return o_insnbuf;
4442
        }
4443
    }
4444
  return 0;
4445
}
4446
 
4447
 
4448
/* Attempt to narrow an instruction.  If the narrowing is valid, perform
4449
   the action in-place directly into the contents and return TRUE.  Otherwise,
4450
   the return value is FALSE and the contents are not modified.  */
4451
 
4452
static bfd_boolean
4453
narrow_instruction (bfd_byte *contents,
4454
                    bfd_size_type content_length,
4455
                    bfd_size_type offset)
4456
{
4457
  xtensa_opcode opcode;
4458
  bfd_size_type insn_len;
4459
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4460
  xtensa_format fmt;
4461
  xtensa_insnbuf o_insnbuf;
4462
 
4463
  static xtensa_insnbuf insnbuf = NULL;
4464
  static xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf = NULL;
4465
 
4466
  if (insnbuf == NULL)
4467
    {
4468
      insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4469
      slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4470
    }
4471
 
4472
  BFD_ASSERT (offset < content_length);
4473
 
4474
  if (content_length < 2)
4475
    return FALSE;
4476
 
4477
  /* We will hand-code a few of these for a little while.
4478
     These have all been specified in the assembler aleady.  */
4479
  xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, &contents[offset],
4480
                             content_length - offset);
4481
  fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
4482
  if (xtensa_format_num_slots (isa, fmt) != 1)
4483
    return FALSE;
4484
 
4485
  if (xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf) != 0)
4486
    return FALSE;
4487
 
4488
  opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, slotbuf);
4489
  if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4490
    return FALSE;
4491
  insn_len = xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
4492
  if (insn_len > content_length)
4493
    return FALSE;
4494
 
4495
  o_insnbuf = can_narrow_instruction (slotbuf, fmt, opcode);
4496
  if (o_insnbuf)
4497
    {
4498
      xtensa_insnbuf_to_chars (isa, o_insnbuf, contents + offset,
4499
                               content_length - offset);
4500
      return TRUE;
4501
    }
4502
 
4503
  return FALSE;
4504
}
4505
 
4506
 
4507
/* Check if an instruction can be "widened", i.e., changed from a 2-byte
4508
   "density" instruction to a standard 3-byte instruction.  If it is valid,
4509
   return the instruction buffer holding the wide instruction.  Otherwise,
4510
   return 0.  The set of valid widenings are specified by a string table
4511
   but require some special case operand checks in some cases.  */
4512
 
4513
static xtensa_insnbuf
4514
can_widen_instruction (xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf,
4515
                       xtensa_format fmt,
4516
                       xtensa_opcode opcode)
4517
{
4518
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4519
  xtensa_format o_fmt;
4520
  unsigned opi;
4521
 
4522
  static xtensa_insnbuf o_insnbuf = NULL;
4523
  static xtensa_insnbuf o_slotbuf = NULL;
4524
 
4525
  if (o_insnbuf == NULL)
4526
    {
4527
      o_insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4528
      o_slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4529
    }
4530
 
4531
  for (opi = 0; opi < (sizeof (widenable)/sizeof (struct string_pair)); opi++)
4532
    {
4533
      bfd_boolean is_or = (strcmp ("or", widenable[opi].wide) == 0);
4534
      bfd_boolean is_branch = (strcmp ("beqz", widenable[opi].wide) == 0
4535
                               || strcmp ("bnez", widenable[opi].wide) == 0);
4536
 
4537
      if (opcode == xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, widenable[opi].narrow))
4538
        {
4539
          uint32 value, newval;
4540
          int i, operand_count, o_operand_count, check_operand_count;
4541
          xtensa_opcode o_opcode;
4542
 
4543
          /* Address does not matter in this case.  We might need to fix it
4544
             to handle branches/jumps.  */
4545
          bfd_vma self_address = 0;
4546
 
4547
          o_opcode = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, widenable[opi].wide);
4548
          if (o_opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4549
            return 0;
4550
          o_fmt = get_single_format (o_opcode);
4551
          if (o_fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4552
            return 0;
4553
 
4554
          if (xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt) != 2
4555
              || xtensa_format_length (isa, o_fmt) != 3)
4556
            return 0;
4557
 
4558
          xtensa_format_encode (isa, o_fmt, o_insnbuf);
4559
          operand_count = xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, opcode);
4560
          o_operand_count = xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, o_opcode);
4561
          check_operand_count = o_operand_count;
4562
 
4563
          if (xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, o_fmt, 0, o_slotbuf, o_opcode) != 0)
4564
            return 0;
4565
 
4566
          if (!is_or)
4567
            {
4568
              if (xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, o_opcode) != operand_count)
4569
                return 0;
4570
            }
4571
          else
4572
            {
4573
              uint32 rawval0, rawval1;
4574
 
4575
              if (o_operand_count != operand_count + 1
4576
                  || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, 0,
4577
                                               fmt, 0, slotbuf, &rawval0) != 0
4578
                  || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, 1,
4579
                                               fmt, 0, slotbuf, &rawval1) != 0
4580
                  || rawval0 == rawval1 /* it is a nop */)
4581
                return 0;
4582
            }
4583
          if (is_branch)
4584
            check_operand_count--;
4585
 
4586
          for (i = 0; i < check_operand_count; i++)
4587
            {
4588
              int new_i = i;
4589
              if (is_or && i == o_operand_count - 1)
4590
                new_i = i - 1;
4591
              if (xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, new_i, fmt, 0,
4592
                                            slotbuf, &value)
4593
                  || xtensa_operand_decode (isa, opcode, new_i, &value))
4594
                return 0;
4595
 
4596
              /* PC-relative branches need adjustment, but
4597
                 the PC-rel operand will always have a relocation.  */
4598
              newval = value;
4599
              if (xtensa_operand_do_reloc (isa, o_opcode, i, &newval,
4600
                                           self_address)
4601
                  || xtensa_operand_encode (isa, o_opcode, i, &newval)
4602
                  || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, o_opcode, i, o_fmt, 0,
4603
                                               o_slotbuf, newval))
4604
                return 0;
4605
            }
4606
 
4607
          if (xtensa_format_set_slot (isa, o_fmt, 0, o_insnbuf, o_slotbuf))
4608
            return 0;
4609
 
4610
          return o_insnbuf;
4611
        }
4612
    }
4613
  return 0;
4614
}
4615
 
4616
 
4617
/* Attempt to widen an instruction.  If the widening is valid, perform
4618
   the action in-place directly into the contents and return TRUE.  Otherwise,
4619
   the return value is FALSE and the contents are not modified.  */
4620
 
4621
static bfd_boolean
4622
widen_instruction (bfd_byte *contents,
4623
                   bfd_size_type content_length,
4624
                   bfd_size_type offset)
4625
{
4626
  xtensa_opcode opcode;
4627
  bfd_size_type insn_len;
4628
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4629
  xtensa_format fmt;
4630
  xtensa_insnbuf o_insnbuf;
4631
 
4632
  static xtensa_insnbuf insnbuf = NULL;
4633
  static xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf = NULL;
4634
 
4635
  if (insnbuf == NULL)
4636
    {
4637
      insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4638
      slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4639
    }
4640
 
4641
  BFD_ASSERT (offset < content_length);
4642
 
4643
  if (content_length < 2)
4644
    return FALSE;
4645
 
4646
  /* We will hand-code a few of these for a little while.
4647
     These have all been specified in the assembler aleady.  */
4648
  xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, &contents[offset],
4649
                             content_length - offset);
4650
  fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
4651
  if (xtensa_format_num_slots (isa, fmt) != 1)
4652
    return FALSE;
4653
 
4654
  if (xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf) != 0)
4655
    return FALSE;
4656
 
4657
  opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, slotbuf);
4658
  if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4659
    return FALSE;
4660
  insn_len = xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
4661
  if (insn_len > content_length)
4662
    return FALSE;
4663
 
4664
  o_insnbuf = can_widen_instruction (slotbuf, fmt, opcode);
4665
  if (o_insnbuf)
4666
    {
4667
      xtensa_insnbuf_to_chars (isa, o_insnbuf, contents + offset,
4668
                               content_length - offset);
4669
      return TRUE;
4670
    }
4671
  return FALSE;
4672
}
4673
 
4674
 
4675
/* Code for transforming CALLs at link-time.  */
4676
 
4677
static bfd_reloc_status_type
4678
elf_xtensa_do_asm_simplify (bfd_byte *contents,
4679
                            bfd_vma address,
4680
                            bfd_vma content_length,
4681
                            char **error_message)
4682
{
4683
  static xtensa_insnbuf insnbuf = NULL;
4684
  static xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf = NULL;
4685
  xtensa_format core_format = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4686
  xtensa_opcode opcode;
4687
  xtensa_opcode direct_call_opcode;
4688
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4689
  bfd_byte *chbuf = contents + address;
4690
  int opn;
4691
 
4692
  if (insnbuf == NULL)
4693
    {
4694
      insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4695
      slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4696
    }
4697
 
4698
  if (content_length < address)
4699
    {
4700
      *error_message = _("Attempt to convert L32R/CALLX to CALL failed");
4701
      return bfd_reloc_other;
4702
    }
4703
 
4704
  opcode = get_expanded_call_opcode (chbuf, content_length - address, 0);
4705
  direct_call_opcode = swap_callx_for_call_opcode (opcode);
4706
  if (direct_call_opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4707
    {
4708
      *error_message = _("Attempt to convert L32R/CALLX to CALL failed");
4709
      return bfd_reloc_other;
4710
    }
4711
 
4712
  /* Assemble a NOP ("or a1, a1, a1") into the 0 byte offset.  */
4713
  core_format = xtensa_format_lookup (isa, "x24");
4714
  opcode = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, "or");
4715
  xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, core_format, 0, slotbuf, opcode);
4716
  for (opn = 0; opn < 3; opn++)
4717
    {
4718
      uint32 regno = 1;
4719
      xtensa_operand_encode (isa, opcode, opn, &regno);
4720
      xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, opcode, opn, core_format, 0,
4721
                                slotbuf, regno);
4722
    }
4723
  xtensa_format_encode (isa, core_format, insnbuf);
4724
  xtensa_format_set_slot (isa, core_format, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf);
4725
  xtensa_insnbuf_to_chars (isa, insnbuf, chbuf, content_length - address);
4726
 
4727
  /* Assemble a CALL ("callN 0") into the 3 byte offset.  */
4728
  xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, core_format, 0, slotbuf, direct_call_opcode);
4729
  xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, opcode, 0, core_format, 0, slotbuf, 0);
4730
 
4731
  xtensa_format_encode (isa, core_format, insnbuf);
4732
  xtensa_format_set_slot (isa, core_format, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf);
4733
  xtensa_insnbuf_to_chars (isa, insnbuf, chbuf + 3,
4734
                           content_length - address - 3);
4735
 
4736
  return bfd_reloc_ok;
4737
}
4738
 
4739
 
4740
static bfd_reloc_status_type
4741
contract_asm_expansion (bfd_byte *contents,
4742
                        bfd_vma content_length,
4743
                        Elf_Internal_Rela *irel,
4744
                        char **error_message)
4745
{
4746
  bfd_reloc_status_type retval =
4747
    elf_xtensa_do_asm_simplify (contents, irel->r_offset, content_length,
4748
                                error_message);
4749
 
4750
  if (retval != bfd_reloc_ok)
4751
    return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
4752
 
4753
  /* Update the irel->r_offset field so that the right immediate and
4754
     the right instruction are modified during the relocation.  */
4755
  irel->r_offset += 3;
4756
  irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP);
4757
  return bfd_reloc_ok;
4758
}
4759
 
4760
 
4761
static xtensa_opcode
4762
swap_callx_for_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode opcode)
4763
{
4764
  init_call_opcodes ();
4765
 
4766
  if (opcode == callx0_op) return call0_op;
4767
  if (opcode == callx4_op) return call4_op;
4768
  if (opcode == callx8_op) return call8_op;
4769
  if (opcode == callx12_op) return call12_op;
4770
 
4771
  /* Return XTENSA_UNDEFINED if the opcode is not an indirect call.  */
4772
  return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4773
}
4774
 
4775
 
4776
/* Check if "buf" is pointing to a "L32R aN; CALLX aN" or "CONST16 aN;
4777
   CONST16 aN; CALLX aN" sequence, and if so, return the CALLX opcode.
4778
   If not, return XTENSA_UNDEFINED.  */
4779
 
4780
#define L32R_TARGET_REG_OPERAND 0
4781
#define CONST16_TARGET_REG_OPERAND 0
4782
#define CALLN_SOURCE_OPERAND 0
4783
 
4784
static xtensa_opcode
4785
get_expanded_call_opcode (bfd_byte *buf, int bufsize, bfd_boolean *p_uses_l32r)
4786
{
4787
  static xtensa_insnbuf insnbuf = NULL;
4788
  static xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf = NULL;
4789
  xtensa_format fmt;
4790
  xtensa_opcode opcode;
4791
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4792
  uint32 regno, const16_regno, call_regno;
4793
  int offset = 0;
4794
 
4795
  if (insnbuf == NULL)
4796
    {
4797
      insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4798
      slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4799
    }
4800
 
4801
  xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, buf, bufsize);
4802
  fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
4803
  if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
4804
      || xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf))
4805
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4806
 
4807
  opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, slotbuf);
4808
  if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4809
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4810
 
4811
  if (opcode == get_l32r_opcode ())
4812
    {
4813
      if (p_uses_l32r)
4814
        *p_uses_l32r = TRUE;
4815
      if (xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, L32R_TARGET_REG_OPERAND,
4816
                                    fmt, 0, slotbuf, &regno)
4817
          || xtensa_operand_decode (isa, opcode, L32R_TARGET_REG_OPERAND,
4818
                                    &regno))
4819
        return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4820
    }
4821
  else if (opcode == get_const16_opcode ())
4822
    {
4823
      if (p_uses_l32r)
4824
        *p_uses_l32r = FALSE;
4825
      if (xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, CONST16_TARGET_REG_OPERAND,
4826
                                    fmt, 0, slotbuf, &regno)
4827
          || xtensa_operand_decode (isa, opcode, CONST16_TARGET_REG_OPERAND,
4828
                                    &regno))
4829
        return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4830
 
4831
      /* Check that the next instruction is also CONST16.  */
4832
      offset += xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
4833
      xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, buf + offset, bufsize - offset);
4834
      fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
4835
      if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
4836
          || xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf))
4837
        return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4838
      opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, slotbuf);
4839
      if (opcode != get_const16_opcode ())
4840
        return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4841
 
4842
      if (xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, CONST16_TARGET_REG_OPERAND,
4843
                                    fmt, 0, slotbuf, &const16_regno)
4844
          || xtensa_operand_decode (isa, opcode, CONST16_TARGET_REG_OPERAND,
4845
                                    &const16_regno)
4846
          || const16_regno != regno)
4847
        return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4848
    }
4849
  else
4850
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4851
 
4852
  /* Next instruction should be an CALLXn with operand 0 == regno.  */
4853
  offset += xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
4854
  xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, buf + offset, bufsize - offset);
4855
  fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
4856
  if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
4857
      || xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf))
4858
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4859
  opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, slotbuf);
4860
  if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
4861
      || !is_indirect_call_opcode (opcode))
4862
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4863
 
4864
  if (xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, CALLN_SOURCE_OPERAND,
4865
                                fmt, 0, slotbuf, &call_regno)
4866
      || xtensa_operand_decode (isa, opcode, CALLN_SOURCE_OPERAND,
4867
                                &call_regno))
4868
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4869
 
4870
  if (call_regno != regno)
4871
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4872
 
4873
  return opcode;
4874
}
4875
 
4876
 
4877
/* Data structures used during relaxation.  */
4878
 
4879
/* r_reloc: relocation values.  */
4880
 
4881
/* Through the relaxation process, we need to keep track of the values
4882
   that will result from evaluating relocations.  The standard ELF
4883
   relocation structure is not sufficient for this purpose because we're
4884
   operating on multiple input files at once, so we need to know which
4885
   input file a relocation refers to.  The r_reloc structure thus
4886
   records both the input file (bfd) and ELF relocation.
4887
 
4888
   For efficiency, an r_reloc also contains a "target_offset" field to
4889
   cache the target-section-relative offset value that is represented by
4890
   the relocation.
4891
 
4892
   The r_reloc also contains a virtual offset that allows multiple
4893
   inserted literals to be placed at the same "address" with
4894
   different offsets.  */
4895
 
4896
typedef struct r_reloc_struct r_reloc;
4897
 
4898
struct r_reloc_struct
4899
{
4900
  bfd *abfd;
4901
  Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
4902
  bfd_vma target_offset;
4903
  bfd_vma virtual_offset;
4904
};
4905
 
4906
 
4907
/* The r_reloc structure is included by value in literal_value, but not
4908
   every literal_value has an associated relocation -- some are simple
4909
   constants.  In such cases, we set all the fields in the r_reloc
4910
   struct to zero.  The r_reloc_is_const function should be used to
4911
   detect this case.  */
4912
 
4913
static bfd_boolean
4914
r_reloc_is_const (const r_reloc *r_rel)
4915
{
4916
  return (r_rel->abfd == NULL);
4917
}
4918
 
4919
 
4920
static bfd_vma
4921
r_reloc_get_target_offset (const r_reloc *r_rel)
4922
{
4923
  bfd_vma target_offset;
4924
  unsigned long r_symndx;
4925
 
4926
  BFD_ASSERT (!r_reloc_is_const (r_rel));
4927
  r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (r_rel->rela.r_info);
4928
  target_offset = get_elf_r_symndx_offset (r_rel->abfd, r_symndx);
4929
  return (target_offset + r_rel->rela.r_addend);
4930
}
4931
 
4932
 
4933
static struct elf_link_hash_entry *
4934
r_reloc_get_hash_entry (const r_reloc *r_rel)
4935
{
4936
  unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (r_rel->rela.r_info);
4937
  return get_elf_r_symndx_hash_entry (r_rel->abfd, r_symndx);
4938
}
4939
 
4940
 
4941
static asection *
4942
r_reloc_get_section (const r_reloc *r_rel)
4943
{
4944
  unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (r_rel->rela.r_info);
4945
  return get_elf_r_symndx_section (r_rel->abfd, r_symndx);
4946
}
4947
 
4948
 
4949
static bfd_boolean
4950
r_reloc_is_defined (const r_reloc *r_rel)
4951
{
4952
  asection *sec;
4953
  if (r_rel == NULL)
4954
    return FALSE;
4955
 
4956
  sec = r_reloc_get_section (r_rel);
4957
  if (sec == bfd_abs_section_ptr
4958
      || sec == bfd_com_section_ptr
4959
      || sec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
4960
    return FALSE;
4961
  return TRUE;
4962
}
4963
 
4964
 
4965
static void
4966
r_reloc_init (r_reloc *r_rel,
4967
              bfd *abfd,
4968
              Elf_Internal_Rela *irel,
4969
              bfd_byte *contents,
4970
              bfd_size_type content_length)
4971
{
4972
  int r_type;
4973
  reloc_howto_type *howto;
4974
 
4975
  if (irel)
4976
    {
4977
      r_rel->rela = *irel;
4978
      r_rel->abfd = abfd;
4979
      r_rel->target_offset = r_reloc_get_target_offset (r_rel);
4980
      r_rel->virtual_offset = 0;
4981
      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (r_rel->rela.r_info);
4982
      howto = &elf_howto_table[r_type];
4983
      if (howto->partial_inplace)
4984
        {
4985
          bfd_vma inplace_val;
4986
          BFD_ASSERT (r_rel->rela.r_offset < content_length);
4987
 
4988
          inplace_val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[r_rel->rela.r_offset]);
4989
          r_rel->target_offset += inplace_val;
4990
        }
4991
    }
4992
  else
4993
    memset (r_rel, 0, sizeof (r_reloc));
4994
}
4995
 
4996
 
4997
#if DEBUG
4998
 
4999
static void
5000
print_r_reloc (FILE *fp, const r_reloc *r_rel)
5001
{
5002
  if (r_reloc_is_defined (r_rel))
5003
    {
5004
      asection *sec = r_reloc_get_section (r_rel);
5005
      fprintf (fp, " %s(%s + ", sec->owner->filename, sec->name);
5006
    }
5007
  else if (r_reloc_get_hash_entry (r_rel))
5008
    fprintf (fp, " %s + ", r_reloc_get_hash_entry (r_rel)->root.root.string);
5009
  else
5010
    fprintf (fp, " ?? + ");
5011
 
5012
  fprintf_vma (fp, r_rel->target_offset);
5013
  if (r_rel->virtual_offset)
5014
    {
5015
      fprintf (fp, " + ");
5016
      fprintf_vma (fp, r_rel->virtual_offset);
5017
    }
5018
 
5019
  fprintf (fp, ")");
5020
}
5021
 
5022
#endif /* DEBUG */
5023
 
5024
 
5025
/* source_reloc: relocations that reference literals.  */
5026
 
5027
/* To determine whether literals can be coalesced, we need to first
5028
   record all the relocations that reference the literals.  The
5029
   source_reloc structure below is used for this purpose.  The
5030
   source_reloc entries are kept in a per-literal-section array, sorted
5031
   by offset within the literal section (i.e., target offset).
5032
 
5033
   The source_sec and r_rel.rela.r_offset fields identify the source of
5034
   the relocation.  The r_rel field records the relocation value, i.e.,
5035
   the offset of the literal being referenced.  The opnd field is needed
5036
   to determine the range of the immediate field to which the relocation
5037
   applies, so we can determine whether another literal with the same
5038
   value is within range.  The is_null field is true when the relocation
5039
   is being removed (e.g., when an L32R is being removed due to a CALLX
5040
   that is converted to a direct CALL).  */
5041
 
5042
typedef struct source_reloc_struct source_reloc;
5043
 
5044
struct source_reloc_struct
5045
{
5046
  asection *source_sec;
5047
  r_reloc r_rel;
5048
  xtensa_opcode opcode;
5049
  int opnd;
5050
  bfd_boolean is_null;
5051
  bfd_boolean is_abs_literal;
5052
};
5053
 
5054
 
5055
static void
5056
init_source_reloc (source_reloc *reloc,
5057
                   asection *source_sec,
5058
                   const r_reloc *r_rel,
5059
                   xtensa_opcode opcode,
5060
                   int opnd,
5061
                   bfd_boolean is_abs_literal)
5062
{
5063
  reloc->source_sec = source_sec;
5064
  reloc->r_rel = *r_rel;
5065
  reloc->opcode = opcode;
5066
  reloc->opnd = opnd;
5067
  reloc->is_null = FALSE;
5068
  reloc->is_abs_literal = is_abs_literal;
5069
}
5070
 
5071
 
5072
/* Find the source_reloc for a particular source offset and relocation
5073
   type.  Note that the array is sorted by _target_ offset, so this is
5074
   just a linear search.  */
5075
 
5076
static source_reloc *
5077
find_source_reloc (source_reloc *src_relocs,
5078
                   int src_count,
5079
                   asection *sec,
5080
                   Elf_Internal_Rela *irel)
5081
{
5082
  int i;
5083
 
5084
  for (i = 0; i < src_count; i++)
5085
    {
5086
      if (src_relocs[i].source_sec == sec
5087
          && src_relocs[i].r_rel.rela.r_offset == irel->r_offset
5088
          && (ELF32_R_TYPE (src_relocs[i].r_rel.rela.r_info)
5089
              == ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info)))
5090
        return &src_relocs[i];
5091
    }
5092
 
5093
  return NULL;
5094
}
5095
 
5096
 
5097
static int
5098
source_reloc_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
5099
{
5100
  const source_reloc *a = (const source_reloc *) ap;
5101
  const source_reloc *b = (const source_reloc *) bp;
5102
 
5103
  if (a->r_rel.target_offset != b->r_rel.target_offset)
5104
    return (a->r_rel.target_offset - b->r_rel.target_offset);
5105
 
5106
  /* We don't need to sort on these criteria for correctness,
5107
     but enforcing a more strict ordering prevents unstable qsort
5108
     from behaving differently with different implementations.
5109
     Without the code below we get correct but different results
5110
     on Solaris 2.7 and 2.8.  We would like to always produce the
5111
     same results no matter the host. */
5112
 
5113
  if ((!a->is_null) - (!b->is_null))
5114
    return ((!a->is_null) - (!b->is_null));
5115
  return internal_reloc_compare (&a->r_rel.rela, &b->r_rel.rela);
5116
}
5117
 
5118
 
5119
/* Literal values and value hash tables.  */
5120
 
5121
/* Literals with the same value can be coalesced.  The literal_value
5122
   structure records the value of a literal: the "r_rel" field holds the
5123
   information from the relocation on the literal (if there is one) and
5124
   the "value" field holds the contents of the literal word itself.
5125
 
5126
   The value_map structure records a literal value along with the
5127
   location of a literal holding that value.  The value_map hash table
5128
   is indexed by the literal value, so that we can quickly check if a
5129
   particular literal value has been seen before and is thus a candidate
5130
   for coalescing.  */
5131
 
5132
typedef struct literal_value_struct literal_value;
5133
typedef struct value_map_struct value_map;
5134
typedef struct value_map_hash_table_struct value_map_hash_table;
5135
 
5136
struct literal_value_struct
5137
{
5138
  r_reloc r_rel;
5139
  unsigned long value;
5140
  bfd_boolean is_abs_literal;
5141
};
5142
 
5143
struct value_map_struct
5144
{
5145
  literal_value val;                    /* The literal value.  */
5146
  r_reloc loc;                          /* Location of the literal.  */
5147
  value_map *next;
5148
};
5149
 
5150
struct value_map_hash_table_struct
5151
{
5152
  unsigned bucket_count;
5153
  value_map **buckets;
5154
  unsigned count;
5155
  bfd_boolean has_last_loc;
5156
  r_reloc last_loc;
5157
};
5158
 
5159
 
5160
static void
5161
init_literal_value (literal_value *lit,
5162
                    const r_reloc *r_rel,
5163
                    unsigned long value,
5164
                    bfd_boolean is_abs_literal)
5165
{
5166
  lit->r_rel = *r_rel;
5167
  lit->value = value;
5168
  lit->is_abs_literal = is_abs_literal;
5169
}
5170
 
5171
 
5172
static bfd_boolean
5173
literal_value_equal (const literal_value *src1,
5174
                     const literal_value *src2,
5175
                     bfd_boolean final_static_link)
5176
{
5177
  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h1, *h2;
5178
 
5179
  if (r_reloc_is_const (&src1->r_rel) != r_reloc_is_const (&src2->r_rel))
5180
    return FALSE;
5181
 
5182
  if (r_reloc_is_const (&src1->r_rel))
5183
    return (src1->value == src2->value);
5184
 
5185
  if (ELF32_R_TYPE (src1->r_rel.rela.r_info)
5186
      != ELF32_R_TYPE (src2->r_rel.rela.r_info))
5187
    return FALSE;
5188
 
5189
  if (src1->r_rel.target_offset != src2->r_rel.target_offset)
5190
    return FALSE;
5191
 
5192
  if (src1->r_rel.virtual_offset != src2->r_rel.virtual_offset)
5193
    return FALSE;
5194
 
5195
  if (src1->value != src2->value)
5196
    return FALSE;
5197
 
5198
  /* Now check for the same section (if defined) or the same elf_hash
5199
     (if undefined or weak).  */
5200
  h1 = r_reloc_get_hash_entry (&src1->r_rel);
5201
  h2 = r_reloc_get_hash_entry (&src2->r_rel);
5202
  if (r_reloc_is_defined (&src1->r_rel)
5203
      && (final_static_link
5204
          || ((!h1 || h1->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5205
              && (!h2 || h2->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak))))
5206
    {
5207
      if (r_reloc_get_section (&src1->r_rel)
5208
          != r_reloc_get_section (&src2->r_rel))
5209
        return FALSE;
5210
    }
5211
  else
5212
    {
5213
      /* Require that the hash entries (i.e., symbols) be identical.  */
5214
      if (h1 != h2 || h1 == 0)
5215
        return FALSE;
5216
    }
5217
 
5218
  if (src1->is_abs_literal != src2->is_abs_literal)
5219
    return FALSE;
5220
 
5221
  return TRUE;
5222
}
5223
 
5224
 
5225
/* Must be power of 2.  */
5226
#define INITIAL_HASH_RELOC_BUCKET_COUNT 1024
5227
 
5228
static value_map_hash_table *
5229
value_map_hash_table_init (void)
5230
{
5231
  value_map_hash_table *values;
5232
 
5233
  values = (value_map_hash_table *)
5234
    bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (value_map_hash_table));
5235
  values->bucket_count = INITIAL_HASH_RELOC_BUCKET_COUNT;
5236
  values->count = 0;
5237
  values->buckets = (value_map **)
5238
    bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (value_map *) * values->bucket_count);
5239
  if (values->buckets == NULL)
5240
    {
5241
      free (values);
5242
      return NULL;
5243
    }
5244
  values->has_last_loc = FALSE;
5245
 
5246
  return values;
5247
}
5248
 
5249
 
5250
static void
5251
value_map_hash_table_delete (value_map_hash_table *table)
5252
{
5253
  free (table->buckets);
5254
  free (table);
5255
}
5256
 
5257
 
5258
static unsigned
5259
hash_bfd_vma (bfd_vma val)
5260
{
5261
  return (val >> 2) + (val >> 10);
5262
}
5263
 
5264
 
5265
static unsigned
5266
literal_value_hash (const literal_value *src)
5267
{
5268
  unsigned hash_val;
5269
 
5270
  hash_val = hash_bfd_vma (src->value);
5271
  if (!r_reloc_is_const (&src->r_rel))
5272
    {
5273
      void *sec_or_hash;
5274
 
5275
      hash_val += hash_bfd_vma (src->is_abs_literal * 1000);
5276
      hash_val += hash_bfd_vma (src->r_rel.target_offset);
5277
      hash_val += hash_bfd_vma (src->r_rel.virtual_offset);
5278
 
5279
      /* Now check for the same section and the same elf_hash.  */
5280
      if (r_reloc_is_defined (&src->r_rel))
5281
        sec_or_hash = r_reloc_get_section (&src->r_rel);
5282
      else
5283
        sec_or_hash = r_reloc_get_hash_entry (&src->r_rel);
5284
      hash_val += hash_bfd_vma ((bfd_vma) (size_t) sec_or_hash);
5285
    }
5286
  return hash_val;
5287
}
5288
 
5289
 
5290
/* Check if the specified literal_value has been seen before.  */
5291
 
5292
static value_map *
5293
value_map_get_cached_value (value_map_hash_table *map,
5294
                            const literal_value *val,
5295
                            bfd_boolean final_static_link)
5296
{
5297
  value_map *map_e;
5298
  value_map *bucket;
5299
  unsigned idx;
5300
 
5301
  idx = literal_value_hash (val);
5302
  idx = idx & (map->bucket_count - 1);
5303
  bucket = map->buckets[idx];
5304
  for (map_e = bucket; map_e; map_e = map_e->next)
5305
    {
5306
      if (literal_value_equal (&map_e->val, val, final_static_link))
5307
        return map_e;
5308
    }
5309
  return NULL;
5310
}
5311
 
5312
 
5313
/* Record a new literal value.  It is illegal to call this if VALUE
5314
   already has an entry here.  */
5315
 
5316
static value_map *
5317
add_value_map (value_map_hash_table *map,
5318
               const literal_value *val,
5319
               const r_reloc *loc,
5320
               bfd_boolean final_static_link)
5321
{
5322
  value_map **bucket_p;
5323
  unsigned idx;
5324
 
5325
  value_map *val_e = (value_map *) bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (value_map));
5326
  if (val_e == NULL)
5327
    {
5328
      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
5329
      return NULL;
5330
    }
5331
 
5332
  BFD_ASSERT (!value_map_get_cached_value (map, val, final_static_link));
5333
  val_e->val = *val;
5334
  val_e->loc = *loc;
5335
 
5336
  idx = literal_value_hash (val);
5337
  idx = idx & (map->bucket_count - 1);
5338
  bucket_p = &map->buckets[idx];
5339
 
5340
  val_e->next = *bucket_p;
5341
  *bucket_p = val_e;
5342
  map->count++;
5343
  /* FIXME: Consider resizing the hash table if we get too many entries.  */
5344
 
5345
  return val_e;
5346
}
5347
 
5348
 
5349
/* Lists of text actions (ta_) for narrowing, widening, longcall
5350
   conversion, space fill, code & literal removal, etc.  */
5351
 
5352
/* The following text actions are generated:
5353
 
5354
   "ta_remove_insn"         remove an instruction or instructions
5355
   "ta_remove_longcall"     convert longcall to call
5356
   "ta_convert_longcall"    convert longcall to nop/call
5357
   "ta_narrow_insn"         narrow a wide instruction
5358
   "ta_widen"               widen a narrow instruction
5359
   "ta_fill"                add fill or remove fill
5360
      removed < 0 is a fill; branches to the fill address will be
5361
        changed to address + fill size (e.g., address - removed)
5362
      removed >= 0 branches to the fill address will stay unchanged
5363
   "ta_remove_literal"      remove a literal; this action is
5364
                            indicated when a literal is removed
5365
                            or replaced.
5366
   "ta_add_literal"         insert a new literal; this action is
5367
                            indicated when a literal has been moved.
5368
                            It may use a virtual_offset because
5369
                            multiple literals can be placed at the
5370
                            same location.
5371
 
5372
   For each of these text actions, we also record the number of bytes
5373
   removed by performing the text action.  In the case of a "ta_widen"
5374
   or a "ta_fill" that adds space, the removed_bytes will be negative.  */
5375
 
5376
typedef struct text_action_struct text_action;
5377
typedef struct text_action_list_struct text_action_list;
5378
typedef enum text_action_enum_t text_action_t;
5379
 
5380
enum text_action_enum_t
5381
{
5382
  ta_none,
5383
  ta_remove_insn,        /* removed = -size */
5384
  ta_remove_longcall,    /* removed = -size */
5385
  ta_convert_longcall,   /* removed = 0 */
5386
  ta_narrow_insn,        /* removed = -1 */
5387
  ta_widen_insn,         /* removed = +1 */
5388
  ta_fill,               /* removed = +size */
5389
  ta_remove_literal,
5390
  ta_add_literal
5391
};
5392
 
5393
 
5394
/* Structure for a text action record.  */
5395
struct text_action_struct
5396
{
5397
  text_action_t action;
5398
  asection *sec;        /* Optional */
5399
  bfd_vma offset;
5400
  bfd_vma virtual_offset;  /* Zero except for adding literals.  */
5401
  int removed_bytes;
5402
  literal_value value;  /* Only valid when adding literals.  */
5403
 
5404
  text_action *next;
5405
};
5406
 
5407
 
5408
/* List of all of the actions taken on a text section.  */
5409
struct text_action_list_struct
5410
{
5411
  text_action *head;
5412
};
5413
 
5414
 
5415
static text_action *
5416
find_fill_action (text_action_list *l, asection *sec, bfd_vma offset)
5417
{
5418
  text_action **m_p;
5419
 
5420
  /* It is not necessary to fill at the end of a section.  */
5421
  if (sec->size == offset)
5422
    return NULL;
5423
 
5424
  for (m_p = &l->head; *m_p && (*m_p)->offset <= offset; m_p = &(*m_p)->next)
5425
    {
5426
      text_action *t = *m_p;
5427
      /* When the action is another fill at the same address,
5428
         just increase the size.  */
5429
      if (t->offset == offset && t->action == ta_fill)
5430
        return t;
5431
    }
5432
  return NULL;
5433
}
5434
 
5435
 
5436
static int
5437
compute_removed_action_diff (const text_action *ta,
5438
                             asection *sec,
5439
                             bfd_vma offset,
5440
                             int removed,
5441
                             int removable_space)
5442
{
5443
  int new_removed;
5444
  int current_removed = 0;
5445
 
5446
  if (ta)
5447
    current_removed = ta->removed_bytes;
5448
 
5449
  BFD_ASSERT (ta == NULL || ta->offset == offset);
5450
  BFD_ASSERT (ta == NULL || ta->action == ta_fill);
5451
 
5452
  /* It is not necessary to fill at the end of a section.  Clean this up.  */
5453
  if (sec->size == offset)
5454
    new_removed = removable_space - 0;
5455
  else
5456
    {
5457
      int space;
5458
      int added = -removed - current_removed;
5459
      /* Ignore multiples of the section alignment.  */
5460
      added = ((1 << sec->alignment_power) - 1) & added;
5461
      new_removed = (-added);
5462
 
5463
      /* Modify for removable.  */
5464
      space = removable_space - new_removed;
5465
      new_removed = (removable_space
5466
                     - (((1 << sec->alignment_power) - 1) & space));
5467
    }
5468
  return (new_removed - current_removed);
5469
}
5470
 
5471
 
5472
static void
5473
adjust_fill_action (text_action *ta, int fill_diff)
5474
{
5475
  ta->removed_bytes += fill_diff;
5476
}
5477
 
5478
 
5479
/* Add a modification action to the text.  For the case of adding or
5480
   removing space, modify any current fill and assume that
5481
   "unreachable_space" bytes can be freely contracted.  Note that a
5482
   negative removed value is a fill.  */
5483
 
5484
static void
5485
text_action_add (text_action_list *l,
5486
                 text_action_t action,
5487
                 asection *sec,
5488
                 bfd_vma offset,
5489
                 int removed)
5490
{
5491
  text_action **m_p;
5492
  text_action *ta;
5493
 
5494
  /* It is not necessary to fill at the end of a section.  */
5495
  if (action == ta_fill && sec->size == offset)
5496
    return;
5497
 
5498
  /* It is not necessary to fill 0 bytes.  */
5499
  if (action == ta_fill && removed == 0)
5500
    return;
5501
 
5502
  for (m_p = &l->head; *m_p && (*m_p)->offset <= offset; m_p = &(*m_p)->next)
5503
    {
5504
      text_action *t = *m_p;
5505
 
5506
      if (action == ta_fill)
5507
        {
5508
          /* When the action is another fill at the same address,
5509
             just increase the size.  */
5510
          if (t->offset == offset && t->action == ta_fill)
5511
            {
5512
              t->removed_bytes += removed;
5513
              return;
5514
            }
5515
          /* Fills need to happen before widens so that we don't
5516
             insert fill bytes into the instruction stream.  */
5517
          if (t->offset == offset && t->action == ta_widen_insn)
5518
            break;
5519
        }
5520
    }
5521
 
5522
  /* Create a new record and fill it up.  */
5523
  ta = (text_action *) bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (text_action));
5524
  ta->action = action;
5525
  ta->sec = sec;
5526
  ta->offset = offset;
5527
  ta->removed_bytes = removed;
5528
  ta->next = (*m_p);
5529
  *m_p = ta;
5530
}
5531
 
5532
 
5533
static void
5534
text_action_add_literal (text_action_list *l,
5535
                         text_action_t action,
5536
                         const r_reloc *loc,
5537
                         const literal_value *value,
5538
                         int removed)
5539
{
5540
  text_action **m_p;
5541
  text_action *ta;
5542
  asection *sec = r_reloc_get_section (loc);
5543
  bfd_vma offset = loc->target_offset;
5544
  bfd_vma virtual_offset = loc->virtual_offset;
5545
 
5546
  BFD_ASSERT (action == ta_add_literal);
5547
 
5548
  for (m_p = &l->head; *m_p != NULL; m_p = &(*m_p)->next)
5549
    {
5550
      if ((*m_p)->offset > offset
5551
          && ((*m_p)->offset != offset
5552
              || (*m_p)->virtual_offset > virtual_offset))
5553
        break;
5554
    }
5555
 
5556
  /* Create a new record and fill it up.  */
5557
  ta = (text_action *) bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (text_action));
5558
  ta->action = action;
5559
  ta->sec = sec;
5560
  ta->offset = offset;
5561
  ta->virtual_offset = virtual_offset;
5562
  ta->value = *value;
5563
  ta->removed_bytes = removed;
5564
  ta->next = (*m_p);
5565
  *m_p = ta;
5566
}
5567
 
5568
 
5569
/* Find the total offset adjustment for the relaxations specified by
5570
   text_actions, beginning from a particular starting action.  This is
5571
   typically used from offset_with_removed_text to search an entire list of
5572
   actions, but it may also be called directly when adjusting adjacent offsets
5573
   so that each search may begin where the previous one left off.  */
5574
 
5575
static int
5576
removed_by_actions (text_action **p_start_action,
5577
                    bfd_vma offset,
5578
                    bfd_boolean before_fill)
5579
{
5580
  text_action *r;
5581
  int removed = 0;
5582
 
5583
  r = *p_start_action;
5584
  while (r)
5585
    {
5586
      if (r->offset > offset)
5587
        break;
5588
 
5589
      if (r->offset == offset
5590
          && (before_fill || r->action != ta_fill || r->removed_bytes >= 0))
5591
        break;
5592
 
5593
      removed += r->removed_bytes;
5594
 
5595
      r = r->next;
5596
    }
5597
 
5598
  *p_start_action = r;
5599
  return removed;
5600
}
5601
 
5602
 
5603
static bfd_vma
5604
offset_with_removed_text (text_action_list *action_list, bfd_vma offset)
5605
{
5606
  text_action *r = action_list->head;
5607
  return offset - removed_by_actions (&r, offset, FALSE);
5608
}
5609
 
5610
 
5611
static unsigned
5612
action_list_count (text_action_list *action_list)
5613
{
5614
  text_action *r = action_list->head;
5615
  unsigned count = 0;
5616
  for (r = action_list->head; r != NULL; r = r->next)
5617
    {
5618
      count++;
5619
    }
5620
  return count;
5621
}
5622
 
5623
 
5624
/* The find_insn_action routine will only find non-fill actions.  */
5625
 
5626
static text_action *
5627
find_insn_action (text_action_list *action_list, bfd_vma offset)
5628
{
5629
  text_action *t;
5630
  for (t = action_list->head; t; t = t->next)
5631
    {
5632
      if (t->offset == offset)
5633
        {
5634
          switch (t->action)
5635
            {
5636
            case ta_none:
5637
            case ta_fill:
5638
              break;
5639
            case ta_remove_insn:
5640
            case ta_remove_longcall:
5641
            case ta_convert_longcall:
5642
            case ta_narrow_insn:
5643
            case ta_widen_insn:
5644
              return t;
5645
            case ta_remove_literal:
5646
            case ta_add_literal:
5647
              BFD_ASSERT (0);
5648
              break;
5649
            }
5650
        }
5651
    }
5652
  return NULL;
5653
}
5654
 
5655
 
5656
#if DEBUG
5657
 
5658
static void
5659
print_action_list (FILE *fp, text_action_list *action_list)
5660
{
5661
  text_action *r;
5662
 
5663
  fprintf (fp, "Text Action\n");
5664
  for (r = action_list->head; r != NULL; r = r->next)
5665
    {
5666
      const char *t = "unknown";
5667
      switch (r->action)
5668
        {
5669
        case ta_remove_insn:
5670
          t = "remove_insn"; break;
5671
        case ta_remove_longcall:
5672
          t = "remove_longcall"; break;
5673
        case ta_convert_longcall:
5674
          t = "convert_longcall"; break;
5675
        case ta_narrow_insn:
5676
          t = "narrow_insn"; break;
5677
        case ta_widen_insn:
5678
          t = "widen_insn"; break;
5679
        case ta_fill:
5680
          t = "fill"; break;
5681
        case ta_none:
5682
          t = "none"; break;
5683
        case ta_remove_literal:
5684
          t = "remove_literal"; break;
5685
        case ta_add_literal:
5686
          t = "add_literal"; break;
5687
        }
5688
 
5689
      fprintf (fp, "%s: %s[0x%lx] \"%s\" %d\n",
5690
               r->sec->owner->filename,
5691
               r->sec->name, r->offset, t, r->removed_bytes);
5692
    }
5693
}
5694
 
5695
#endif /* DEBUG */
5696
 
5697
 
5698
/* Lists of literals being coalesced or removed.  */
5699
 
5700
/* In the usual case, the literal identified by "from" is being
5701
   coalesced with another literal identified by "to".  If the literal is
5702
   unused and is being removed altogether, "to.abfd" will be NULL.
5703
   The removed_literal entries are kept on a per-section list, sorted
5704
   by the "from" offset field.  */
5705
 
5706
typedef struct removed_literal_struct removed_literal;
5707
typedef struct removed_literal_list_struct removed_literal_list;
5708
 
5709
struct removed_literal_struct
5710
{
5711
  r_reloc from;
5712
  r_reloc to;
5713
  removed_literal *next;
5714
};
5715
 
5716
struct removed_literal_list_struct
5717
{
5718
  removed_literal *head;
5719
  removed_literal *tail;
5720
};
5721
 
5722
 
5723
/* Record that the literal at "from" is being removed.  If "to" is not
5724
   NULL, the "from" literal is being coalesced with the "to" literal.  */
5725
 
5726
static void
5727
add_removed_literal (removed_literal_list *removed_list,
5728
                     const r_reloc *from,
5729
                     const r_reloc *to)
5730
{
5731
  removed_literal *r, *new_r, *next_r;
5732
 
5733
  new_r = (removed_literal *) bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (removed_literal));
5734
 
5735
  new_r->from = *from;
5736
  if (to)
5737
    new_r->to = *to;
5738
  else
5739
    new_r->to.abfd = NULL;
5740
  new_r->next = NULL;
5741
 
5742
  r = removed_list->head;
5743
  if (r == NULL)
5744
    {
5745
      removed_list->head = new_r;
5746
      removed_list->tail = new_r;
5747
    }
5748
  /* Special check for common case of append.  */
5749
  else if (removed_list->tail->from.target_offset < from->target_offset)
5750
    {
5751
      removed_list->tail->next = new_r;
5752
      removed_list->tail = new_r;
5753
    }
5754
  else
5755
    {
5756
      while (r->from.target_offset < from->target_offset && r->next)
5757
        {
5758
          r = r->next;
5759
        }
5760
      next_r = r->next;
5761
      r->next = new_r;
5762
      new_r->next = next_r;
5763
      if (next_r == NULL)
5764
        removed_list->tail = new_r;
5765
    }
5766
}
5767
 
5768
 
5769
/* Check if the list of removed literals contains an entry for the
5770
   given address.  Return the entry if found.  */
5771
 
5772
static removed_literal *
5773
find_removed_literal (removed_literal_list *removed_list, bfd_vma addr)
5774
{
5775
  removed_literal *r = removed_list->head;
5776
  while (r && r->from.target_offset < addr)
5777
    r = r->next;
5778
  if (r && r->from.target_offset == addr)
5779
    return r;
5780
  return NULL;
5781
}
5782
 
5783
 
5784
#if DEBUG
5785
 
5786
static void
5787
print_removed_literals (FILE *fp, removed_literal_list *removed_list)
5788
{
5789
  removed_literal *r;
5790
  r = removed_list->head;
5791
  if (r)
5792
    fprintf (fp, "Removed Literals\n");
5793
  for (; r != NULL; r = r->next)
5794
    {
5795
      print_r_reloc (fp, &r->from);
5796
      fprintf (fp, " => ");
5797
      if (r->to.abfd == NULL)
5798
        fprintf (fp, "REMOVED");
5799
      else
5800
        print_r_reloc (fp, &r->to);
5801
      fprintf (fp, "\n");
5802
    }
5803
}
5804
 
5805
#endif /* DEBUG */
5806
 
5807
 
5808
/* Per-section data for relaxation.  */
5809
 
5810
typedef struct reloc_bfd_fix_struct reloc_bfd_fix;
5811
 
5812
struct xtensa_relax_info_struct
5813
{
5814
  bfd_boolean is_relaxable_literal_section;
5815
  bfd_boolean is_relaxable_asm_section;
5816
  int visited;                          /* Number of times visited.  */
5817
 
5818
  source_reloc *src_relocs;             /* Array[src_count].  */
5819
  int src_count;
5820
  int src_next;                         /* Next src_relocs entry to assign.  */
5821
 
5822
  removed_literal_list removed_list;
5823
  text_action_list action_list;
5824
 
5825
  reloc_bfd_fix *fix_list;
5826
  reloc_bfd_fix *fix_array;
5827
  unsigned fix_array_count;
5828
 
5829
  /* Support for expanding the reloc array that is stored
5830
     in the section structure.  If the relocations have been
5831
     reallocated, the newly allocated relocations will be referenced
5832
     here along with the actual size allocated.  The relocation
5833
     count will always be found in the section structure.  */
5834
  Elf_Internal_Rela *allocated_relocs;
5835
  unsigned relocs_count;
5836
  unsigned allocated_relocs_count;
5837
};
5838
 
5839
struct elf_xtensa_section_data
5840
{
5841
  struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
5842
  xtensa_relax_info relax_info;
5843
};
5844
 
5845
 
5846
static bfd_boolean
5847
elf_xtensa_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
5848
{
5849
  if (!sec->used_by_bfd)
5850
    {
5851
      struct elf_xtensa_section_data *sdata;
5852
      bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata);
5853
 
5854
      sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5855
      if (sdata == NULL)
5856
        return FALSE;
5857
      sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
5858
    }
5859
 
5860
  return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
5861
}
5862
 
5863
 
5864
static xtensa_relax_info *
5865
get_xtensa_relax_info (asection *sec)
5866
{
5867
  struct elf_xtensa_section_data *section_data;
5868
 
5869
  /* No info available if no section or if it is an output section.  */
5870
  if (!sec || sec == sec->output_section)
5871
    return NULL;
5872
 
5873
  section_data = (struct elf_xtensa_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec);
5874
  return &section_data->relax_info;
5875
}
5876
 
5877
 
5878
static void
5879
init_xtensa_relax_info (asection *sec)
5880
{
5881
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
5882
 
5883
  relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section = FALSE;
5884
  relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section = FALSE;
5885
  relax_info->visited = 0;
5886
 
5887
  relax_info->src_relocs = NULL;
5888
  relax_info->src_count = 0;
5889
  relax_info->src_next = 0;
5890
 
5891
  relax_info->removed_list.head = NULL;
5892
  relax_info->removed_list.tail = NULL;
5893
 
5894
  relax_info->action_list.head = NULL;
5895
 
5896
  relax_info->fix_list = NULL;
5897
  relax_info->fix_array = NULL;
5898
  relax_info->fix_array_count = 0;
5899
 
5900
  relax_info->allocated_relocs = NULL;
5901
  relax_info->relocs_count = 0;
5902
  relax_info->allocated_relocs_count = 0;
5903
}
5904
 
5905
 
5906
/* Coalescing literals may require a relocation to refer to a section in
5907
   a different input file, but the standard relocation information
5908
   cannot express that.  Instead, the reloc_bfd_fix structures are used
5909
   to "fix" the relocations that refer to sections in other input files.
5910
   These structures are kept on per-section lists.  The "src_type" field
5911
   records the relocation type in case there are multiple relocations on
5912
   the same location.  FIXME: This is ugly; an alternative might be to
5913
   add new symbols with the "owner" field to some other input file.  */
5914
 
5915
struct reloc_bfd_fix_struct
5916
{
5917
  asection *src_sec;
5918
  bfd_vma src_offset;
5919
  unsigned src_type;                    /* Relocation type.  */
5920
 
5921
  asection *target_sec;
5922
  bfd_vma target_offset;
5923
  bfd_boolean translated;
5924
 
5925
  reloc_bfd_fix *next;
5926
};
5927
 
5928
 
5929
static reloc_bfd_fix *
5930
reloc_bfd_fix_init (asection *src_sec,
5931
                    bfd_vma src_offset,
5932
                    unsigned src_type,
5933
                    asection *target_sec,
5934
                    bfd_vma target_offset,
5935
                    bfd_boolean translated)
5936
{
5937
  reloc_bfd_fix *fix;
5938
 
5939
  fix = (reloc_bfd_fix *) bfd_malloc (sizeof (reloc_bfd_fix));
5940
  fix->src_sec = src_sec;
5941
  fix->src_offset = src_offset;
5942
  fix->src_type = src_type;
5943
  fix->target_sec = target_sec;
5944
  fix->target_offset = target_offset;
5945
  fix->translated = translated;
5946
 
5947
  return fix;
5948
}
5949
 
5950
 
5951
static void
5952
add_fix (asection *src_sec, reloc_bfd_fix *fix)
5953
{
5954
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
5955
 
5956
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (src_sec);
5957
  fix->next = relax_info->fix_list;
5958
  relax_info->fix_list = fix;
5959
}
5960
 
5961
 
5962
static int
5963
fix_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
5964
{
5965
  const reloc_bfd_fix *a = (const reloc_bfd_fix *) ap;
5966
  const reloc_bfd_fix *b = (const reloc_bfd_fix *) bp;
5967
 
5968
  if (a->src_offset != b->src_offset)
5969
    return (a->src_offset - b->src_offset);
5970
  return (a->src_type - b->src_type);
5971
}
5972
 
5973
 
5974
static void
5975
cache_fix_array (asection *sec)
5976
{
5977
  unsigned i, count = 0;
5978
  reloc_bfd_fix *r;
5979
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
5980
 
5981
  if (relax_info == NULL)
5982
    return;
5983
  if (relax_info->fix_list == NULL)
5984
    return;
5985
 
5986
  for (r = relax_info->fix_list; r != NULL; r = r->next)
5987
    count++;
5988
 
5989
  relax_info->fix_array =
5990
    (reloc_bfd_fix *) bfd_malloc (sizeof (reloc_bfd_fix) * count);
5991
  relax_info->fix_array_count = count;
5992
 
5993
  r = relax_info->fix_list;
5994
  for (i = 0; i < count; i++, r = r->next)
5995
    {
5996
      relax_info->fix_array[count - 1 - i] = *r;
5997
      relax_info->fix_array[count - 1 - i].next = NULL;
5998
    }
5999
 
6000
  qsort (relax_info->fix_array, relax_info->fix_array_count,
6001
         sizeof (reloc_bfd_fix), fix_compare);
6002
}
6003
 
6004
 
6005
static reloc_bfd_fix *
6006
get_bfd_fix (asection *sec, bfd_vma offset, unsigned type)
6007
{
6008
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
6009
  reloc_bfd_fix *rv;
6010
  reloc_bfd_fix key;
6011
 
6012
  if (relax_info == NULL)
6013
    return NULL;
6014
  if (relax_info->fix_list == NULL)
6015
    return NULL;
6016
 
6017
  if (relax_info->fix_array == NULL)
6018
    cache_fix_array (sec);
6019
 
6020
  key.src_offset = offset;
6021
  key.src_type = type;
6022
  rv = bsearch (&key, relax_info->fix_array,  relax_info->fix_array_count,
6023
                sizeof (reloc_bfd_fix), fix_compare);
6024
  return rv;
6025
}
6026
 
6027
 
6028
/* Section caching.  */
6029
 
6030
typedef struct section_cache_struct section_cache_t;
6031
 
6032
struct section_cache_struct
6033
{
6034
  asection *sec;
6035
 
6036
  bfd_byte *contents;           /* Cache of the section contents.  */
6037
  bfd_size_type content_length;
6038
 
6039
  property_table_entry *ptbl;   /* Cache of the section property table.  */
6040
  unsigned pte_count;
6041
 
6042
  Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs;    /* Cache of the section relocations.  */
6043
  unsigned reloc_count;
6044
};
6045
 
6046
 
6047
static void
6048
init_section_cache (section_cache_t *sec_cache)
6049
{
6050
  memset (sec_cache, 0, sizeof (*sec_cache));
6051
}
6052
 
6053
 
6054
static void
6055
clear_section_cache (section_cache_t *sec_cache)
6056
{
6057
  if (sec_cache->sec)
6058
    {
6059
      release_contents (sec_cache->sec, sec_cache->contents);
6060
      release_internal_relocs (sec_cache->sec, sec_cache->relocs);
6061
      if (sec_cache->ptbl)
6062
        free (sec_cache->ptbl);
6063
      memset (sec_cache, 0, sizeof (sec_cache));
6064
    }
6065
}
6066
 
6067
 
6068
static bfd_boolean
6069
section_cache_section (section_cache_t *sec_cache,
6070
                       asection *sec,
6071
                       struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6072
{
6073
  bfd *abfd;
6074
  property_table_entry *prop_table = NULL;
6075
  int ptblsize = 0;
6076
  bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6077
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
6078
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
6079
 
6080
  if (sec == NULL)
6081
    return FALSE;
6082
  if (sec == sec_cache->sec)
6083
    return TRUE;
6084
 
6085
  abfd = sec->owner;
6086
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
6087
 
6088
  /* Get the contents.  */
6089
  contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
6090
  if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
6091
    goto err;
6092
 
6093
  /* Get the relocations.  */
6094
  internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
6095
                                              link_info->keep_memory);
6096
 
6097
  /* Get the entry table.  */
6098
  ptblsize = xtensa_read_table_entries (abfd, sec, &prop_table,
6099
                                        XTENSA_PROP_SEC_NAME, FALSE);
6100
  if (ptblsize < 0)
6101
    goto err;
6102
 
6103
  /* Fill in the new section cache.  */
6104
  clear_section_cache (sec_cache);
6105
  memset (sec_cache, 0, sizeof (sec_cache));
6106
 
6107
  sec_cache->sec = sec;
6108
  sec_cache->contents = contents;
6109
  sec_cache->content_length = sec_size;
6110
  sec_cache->relocs = internal_relocs;
6111
  sec_cache->reloc_count = sec->reloc_count;
6112
  sec_cache->pte_count = ptblsize;
6113
  sec_cache->ptbl = prop_table;
6114
 
6115
  return TRUE;
6116
 
6117
 err:
6118
  release_contents (sec, contents);
6119
  release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
6120
  if (prop_table)
6121
    free (prop_table);
6122
  return FALSE;
6123
}
6124
 
6125
 
6126
/* Extended basic blocks.  */
6127
 
6128
/* An ebb_struct represents an Extended Basic Block.  Within this
6129
   range, we guarantee that all instructions are decodable, the
6130
   property table entries are contiguous, and no property table
6131
   specifies a segment that cannot have instructions moved.  This
6132
   structure contains caches of the contents, property table and
6133
   relocations for the specified section for easy use.  The range is
6134
   specified by ranges of indices for the byte offset, property table
6135
   offsets and relocation offsets.  These must be consistent.  */
6136
 
6137
typedef struct ebb_struct ebb_t;
6138
 
6139
struct ebb_struct
6140
{
6141
  asection *sec;
6142
 
6143
  bfd_byte *contents;           /* Cache of the section contents.  */
6144
  bfd_size_type content_length;
6145
 
6146
  property_table_entry *ptbl;   /* Cache of the section property table.  */
6147
  unsigned pte_count;
6148
 
6149
  Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs;    /* Cache of the section relocations.  */
6150
  unsigned reloc_count;
6151
 
6152
  bfd_vma start_offset;         /* Offset in section.  */
6153
  unsigned start_ptbl_idx;      /* Offset in the property table.  */
6154
  unsigned start_reloc_idx;     /* Offset in the relocations.  */
6155
 
6156
  bfd_vma end_offset;
6157
  unsigned end_ptbl_idx;
6158
  unsigned end_reloc_idx;
6159
 
6160
  bfd_boolean ends_section;     /* Is this the last ebb in a section?  */
6161
 
6162
  /* The unreachable property table at the end of this set of blocks;
6163
     NULL if the end is not an unreachable block.  */
6164
  property_table_entry *ends_unreachable;
6165
};
6166
 
6167
 
6168
enum ebb_target_enum
6169
{
6170
  EBB_NO_ALIGN = 0,
6171
  EBB_DESIRE_TGT_ALIGN,
6172
  EBB_REQUIRE_TGT_ALIGN,
6173
  EBB_REQUIRE_LOOP_ALIGN,
6174
  EBB_REQUIRE_ALIGN
6175
};
6176
 
6177
 
6178
/* proposed_action_struct is similar to the text_action_struct except
6179
   that is represents a potential transformation, not one that will
6180
   occur.  We build a list of these for an extended basic block
6181
   and use them to compute the actual actions desired.  We must be
6182
   careful that the entire set of actual actions we perform do not
6183
   break any relocations that would fit if the actions were not
6184
   performed.  */
6185
 
6186
typedef struct proposed_action_struct proposed_action;
6187
 
6188
struct proposed_action_struct
6189
{
6190
  enum ebb_target_enum align_type; /* for the target alignment */
6191
  bfd_vma alignment_pow;
6192
  text_action_t action;
6193
  bfd_vma offset;
6194
  int removed_bytes;
6195
  bfd_boolean do_action; /* If false, then we will not perform the action.  */
6196
};
6197
 
6198
 
6199
/* The ebb_constraint_struct keeps a set of proposed actions for an
6200
   extended basic block.   */
6201
 
6202
typedef struct ebb_constraint_struct ebb_constraint;
6203
 
6204
struct ebb_constraint_struct
6205
{
6206
  ebb_t ebb;
6207
  bfd_boolean start_movable;
6208
 
6209
  /* Bytes of extra space at the beginning if movable.  */
6210
  int start_extra_space;
6211
 
6212
  enum ebb_target_enum start_align;
6213
 
6214
  bfd_boolean end_movable;
6215
 
6216
  /* Bytes of extra space at the end if movable.  */
6217
  int end_extra_space;
6218
 
6219
  unsigned action_count;
6220
  unsigned action_allocated;
6221
 
6222
  /* Array of proposed actions.  */
6223
  proposed_action *actions;
6224
 
6225
  /* Action alignments -- one for each proposed action.  */
6226
  enum ebb_target_enum *action_aligns;
6227
};
6228
 
6229
 
6230
static void
6231
init_ebb_constraint (ebb_constraint *c)
6232
{
6233
  memset (c, 0, sizeof (ebb_constraint));
6234
}
6235
 
6236
 
6237
static void
6238
free_ebb_constraint (ebb_constraint *c)
6239
{
6240
  if (c->actions)
6241
    free (c->actions);
6242
}
6243
 
6244
 
6245
static void
6246
init_ebb (ebb_t *ebb,
6247
          asection *sec,
6248
          bfd_byte *contents,
6249
          bfd_size_type content_length,
6250
          property_table_entry *prop_table,
6251
          unsigned ptblsize,
6252
          Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs,
6253
          unsigned reloc_count)
6254
{
6255
  memset (ebb, 0, sizeof (ebb_t));
6256
  ebb->sec = sec;
6257
  ebb->contents = contents;
6258
  ebb->content_length = content_length;
6259
  ebb->ptbl = prop_table;
6260
  ebb->pte_count = ptblsize;
6261
  ebb->relocs = internal_relocs;
6262
  ebb->reloc_count = reloc_count;
6263
  ebb->start_offset = 0;
6264
  ebb->end_offset = ebb->content_length - 1;
6265
  ebb->start_ptbl_idx = 0;
6266
  ebb->end_ptbl_idx = ptblsize;
6267
  ebb->start_reloc_idx = 0;
6268
  ebb->end_reloc_idx = reloc_count;
6269
}
6270
 
6271
 
6272
/* Extend the ebb to all decodable contiguous sections.  The algorithm
6273
   for building a basic block around an instruction is to push it
6274
   forward until we hit the end of a section, an unreachable block or
6275
   a block that cannot be transformed.  Then we push it backwards
6276
   searching for similar conditions.  */
6277
 
6278
static bfd_boolean extend_ebb_bounds_forward (ebb_t *);
6279
static bfd_boolean extend_ebb_bounds_backward (ebb_t *);
6280
static bfd_size_type insn_block_decodable_len
6281
  (bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type, bfd_vma, bfd_size_type);
6282
 
6283
static bfd_boolean
6284
extend_ebb_bounds (ebb_t *ebb)
6285
{
6286
  if (!extend_ebb_bounds_forward (ebb))
6287
    return FALSE;
6288
  if (!extend_ebb_bounds_backward (ebb))
6289
    return FALSE;
6290
  return TRUE;
6291
}
6292
 
6293
 
6294
static bfd_boolean
6295
extend_ebb_bounds_forward (ebb_t *ebb)
6296
{
6297
  property_table_entry *the_entry, *new_entry;
6298
 
6299
  the_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->end_ptbl_idx];
6300
 
6301
  /* Stop when (1) we cannot decode an instruction, (2) we are at
6302
     the end of the property tables, (3) we hit a non-contiguous property
6303
     table entry, (4) we hit a NO_TRANSFORM region.  */
6304
 
6305
  while (1)
6306
    {
6307
      bfd_vma entry_end;
6308
      bfd_size_type insn_block_len;
6309
 
6310
      entry_end = the_entry->address - ebb->sec->vma + the_entry->size;
6311
      insn_block_len =
6312
        insn_block_decodable_len (ebb->contents, ebb->content_length,
6313
                                  ebb->end_offset,
6314
                                  entry_end - ebb->end_offset);
6315
      if (insn_block_len != (entry_end - ebb->end_offset))
6316
        {
6317
          (*_bfd_error_handler)
6318
            (_("%B(%A+0x%lx): could not decode instruction; possible configuration mismatch"),
6319
             ebb->sec->owner, ebb->sec, ebb->end_offset + insn_block_len);
6320
          return FALSE;
6321
        }
6322
      ebb->end_offset += insn_block_len;
6323
 
6324
      if (ebb->end_offset == ebb->sec->size)
6325
        ebb->ends_section = TRUE;
6326
 
6327
      /* Update the reloc counter.  */
6328
      while (ebb->end_reloc_idx + 1 < ebb->reloc_count
6329
             && (ebb->relocs[ebb->end_reloc_idx + 1].r_offset
6330
                 < ebb->end_offset))
6331
        {
6332
          ebb->end_reloc_idx++;
6333
        }
6334
 
6335
      if (ebb->end_ptbl_idx + 1 == ebb->pte_count)
6336
        return TRUE;
6337
 
6338
      new_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->end_ptbl_idx + 1];
6339
      if (((new_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_INSN) == 0)
6340
          || ((new_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM) != 0)
6341
          || ((the_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN) != 0))
6342
        break;
6343
 
6344
      if (the_entry->address + the_entry->size != new_entry->address)
6345
        break;
6346
 
6347
      the_entry = new_entry;
6348
      ebb->end_ptbl_idx++;
6349
    }
6350
 
6351
  /* Quick check for an unreachable or end of file just at the end.  */
6352
  if (ebb->end_ptbl_idx + 1 == ebb->pte_count)
6353
    {
6354
      if (ebb->end_offset == ebb->content_length)
6355
        ebb->ends_section = TRUE;
6356
    }
6357
  else
6358
    {
6359
      new_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->end_ptbl_idx + 1];
6360
      if ((new_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE) != 0
6361
          && the_entry->address + the_entry->size == new_entry->address)
6362
        ebb->ends_unreachable = new_entry;
6363
    }
6364
 
6365
  /* Any other ending requires exact alignment.  */
6366
  return TRUE;
6367
}
6368
 
6369
 
6370
static bfd_boolean
6371
extend_ebb_bounds_backward (ebb_t *ebb)
6372
{
6373
  property_table_entry *the_entry, *new_entry;
6374
 
6375
  the_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->start_ptbl_idx];
6376
 
6377
  /* Stop when (1) we cannot decode the instructions in the current entry.
6378
     (2) we are at the beginning of the property tables, (3) we hit a
6379
     non-contiguous property table entry, (4) we hit a NO_TRANSFORM region.  */
6380
 
6381
  while (1)
6382
    {
6383
      bfd_vma block_begin;
6384
      bfd_size_type insn_block_len;
6385
 
6386
      block_begin = the_entry->address - ebb->sec->vma;
6387
      insn_block_len =
6388
        insn_block_decodable_len (ebb->contents, ebb->content_length,
6389
                                  block_begin,
6390
                                  ebb->start_offset - block_begin);
6391
      if (insn_block_len != ebb->start_offset - block_begin)
6392
        {
6393
          (*_bfd_error_handler)
6394
            (_("%B(%A+0x%lx): could not decode instruction; possible configuration mismatch"),
6395
             ebb->sec->owner, ebb->sec, ebb->end_offset + insn_block_len);
6396
          return FALSE;
6397
        }
6398
      ebb->start_offset -= insn_block_len;
6399
 
6400
      /* Update the reloc counter.  */
6401
      while (ebb->start_reloc_idx > 0
6402
             && (ebb->relocs[ebb->start_reloc_idx - 1].r_offset
6403
                 >= ebb->start_offset))
6404
        {
6405
          ebb->start_reloc_idx--;
6406
        }
6407
 
6408
      if (ebb->start_ptbl_idx == 0)
6409
        return TRUE;
6410
 
6411
      new_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->start_ptbl_idx - 1];
6412
      if ((new_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_INSN) == 0
6413
          || ((new_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM) != 0)
6414
          || ((new_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN) != 0))
6415
        return TRUE;
6416
      if (new_entry->address + new_entry->size != the_entry->address)
6417
        return TRUE;
6418
 
6419
      the_entry = new_entry;
6420
      ebb->start_ptbl_idx--;
6421
    }
6422
  return TRUE;
6423
}
6424
 
6425
 
6426
static bfd_size_type
6427
insn_block_decodable_len (bfd_byte *contents,
6428
                          bfd_size_type content_len,
6429
                          bfd_vma block_offset,
6430
                          bfd_size_type block_len)
6431
{
6432
  bfd_vma offset = block_offset;
6433
 
6434
  while (offset < block_offset + block_len)
6435
    {
6436
      bfd_size_type insn_len = 0;
6437
 
6438
      insn_len = insn_decode_len (contents, content_len, offset);
6439
      if (insn_len == 0)
6440
        return (offset - block_offset);
6441
      offset += insn_len;
6442
    }
6443
  return (offset - block_offset);
6444
}
6445
 
6446
 
6447
static void
6448
ebb_propose_action (ebb_constraint *c,
6449
                    enum ebb_target_enum align_type,
6450
                    bfd_vma alignment_pow,
6451
                    text_action_t action,
6452
                    bfd_vma offset,
6453
                    int removed_bytes,
6454
                    bfd_boolean do_action)
6455
{
6456
  proposed_action *act;
6457
 
6458
  if (c->action_allocated <= c->action_count)
6459
    {
6460
      unsigned new_allocated, i;
6461
      proposed_action *new_actions;
6462
 
6463
      new_allocated = (c->action_count + 2) * 2;
6464
      new_actions = (proposed_action *)
6465
        bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (proposed_action) * new_allocated);
6466
 
6467
      for (i = 0; i < c->action_count; i++)
6468
        new_actions[i] = c->actions[i];
6469
      if (c->actions)
6470
        free (c->actions);
6471
      c->actions = new_actions;
6472
      c->action_allocated = new_allocated;
6473
    }
6474
 
6475
  act = &c->actions[c->action_count];
6476
  act->align_type = align_type;
6477
  act->alignment_pow = alignment_pow;
6478
  act->action = action;
6479
  act->offset = offset;
6480
  act->removed_bytes = removed_bytes;
6481
  act->do_action = do_action;
6482
 
6483
  c->action_count++;
6484
}
6485
 
6486
 
6487
/* Access to internal relocations, section contents and symbols.  */
6488
 
6489
/* During relaxation, we need to modify relocations, section contents,
6490
   and symbol definitions, and we need to keep the original values from
6491
   being reloaded from the input files, i.e., we need to "pin" the
6492
   modified values in memory.  We also want to continue to observe the
6493
   setting of the "keep-memory" flag.  The following functions wrap the
6494
   standard BFD functions to take care of this for us.  */
6495
 
6496
static Elf_Internal_Rela *
6497
retrieve_internal_relocs (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, bfd_boolean keep_memory)
6498
{
6499
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
6500
 
6501
  if ((sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
6502
    return NULL;
6503
 
6504
  internal_relocs = elf_section_data (sec)->relocs;
6505
  if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6506
    internal_relocs = (_bfd_elf_link_read_relocs
6507
                       (abfd, sec, NULL, NULL, keep_memory));
6508
  return internal_relocs;
6509
}
6510
 
6511
 
6512
static void
6513
pin_internal_relocs (asection *sec, Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs)
6514
{
6515
  elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = internal_relocs;
6516
}
6517
 
6518
 
6519
static void
6520
release_internal_relocs (asection *sec, Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs)
6521
{
6522
  if (internal_relocs
6523
      && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6524
    free (internal_relocs);
6525
}
6526
 
6527
 
6528
static bfd_byte *
6529
retrieve_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, bfd_boolean keep_memory)
6530
{
6531
  bfd_byte *contents;
6532
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
6533
 
6534
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
6535
  contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
6536
 
6537
  if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
6538
    {
6539
      if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, &contents))
6540
        {
6541
          if (contents)
6542
            free (contents);
6543
          return NULL;
6544
        }
6545
      if (keep_memory)
6546
        elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6547
    }
6548
  return contents;
6549
}
6550
 
6551
 
6552
static void
6553
pin_contents (asection *sec, bfd_byte *contents)
6554
{
6555
  elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6556
}
6557
 
6558
 
6559
static void
6560
release_contents (asection *sec, bfd_byte *contents)
6561
{
6562
  if (contents && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6563
    free (contents);
6564
}
6565
 
6566
 
6567
static Elf_Internal_Sym *
6568
retrieve_local_syms (bfd *input_bfd)
6569
{
6570
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6571
  Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf;
6572
  size_t locsymcount;
6573
 
6574
  symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
6575
  locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6576
 
6577
  isymbuf = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
6578
  if (isymbuf == NULL && locsymcount != 0)
6579
    isymbuf = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, locsymcount, 0,
6580
                                    NULL, NULL, NULL);
6581
 
6582
  /* Save the symbols for this input file so they won't be read again.  */
6583
  if (isymbuf && isymbuf != (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents)
6584
    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
6585
 
6586
  return isymbuf;
6587
}
6588
 
6589
 
6590
/* Code for link-time relaxation.  */
6591
 
6592
/* Initialization for relaxation: */
6593
static bfd_boolean analyze_relocations (struct bfd_link_info *);
6594
static bfd_boolean find_relaxable_sections
6595
  (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd_boolean *);
6596
static bfd_boolean collect_source_relocs
6597
  (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *);
6598
static bfd_boolean is_resolvable_asm_expansion
6599
  (bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, Elf_Internal_Rela *, struct bfd_link_info *,
6600
   bfd_boolean *);
6601
static Elf_Internal_Rela *find_associated_l32r_irel
6602
  (bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, Elf_Internal_Rela *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
6603
static bfd_boolean compute_text_actions
6604
  (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *);
6605
static bfd_boolean compute_ebb_proposed_actions (ebb_constraint *);
6606
static bfd_boolean compute_ebb_actions (ebb_constraint *);
6607
static bfd_boolean check_section_ebb_pcrels_fit
6608
  (bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, Elf_Internal_Rela *, const ebb_constraint *,
6609
   const xtensa_opcode *);
6610
static bfd_boolean check_section_ebb_reduces (const ebb_constraint *);
6611
static void text_action_add_proposed
6612
  (text_action_list *, const ebb_constraint *, asection *);
6613
static int compute_fill_extra_space (property_table_entry *);
6614
 
6615
/* First pass: */
6616
static bfd_boolean compute_removed_literals
6617
  (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *, value_map_hash_table *);
6618
static Elf_Internal_Rela *get_irel_at_offset
6619
  (asection *, Elf_Internal_Rela *, bfd_vma);
6620
static bfd_boolean is_removable_literal
6621
  (const source_reloc *, int, const source_reloc *, int, asection *,
6622
   property_table_entry *, int);
6623
static bfd_boolean remove_dead_literal
6624
  (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *, Elf_Internal_Rela *,
6625
   Elf_Internal_Rela *, source_reloc *, property_table_entry *, int);
6626
static bfd_boolean identify_literal_placement
6627
  (bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, struct bfd_link_info *,
6628
   value_map_hash_table *, bfd_boolean *, Elf_Internal_Rela *, int,
6629
   source_reloc *, property_table_entry *, int, section_cache_t *,
6630
   bfd_boolean);
6631
static bfd_boolean relocations_reach (source_reloc *, int, const r_reloc *);
6632
static bfd_boolean coalesce_shared_literal
6633
  (asection *, source_reloc *, property_table_entry *, int, value_map *);
6634
static bfd_boolean move_shared_literal
6635
  (asection *, struct bfd_link_info *, source_reloc *, property_table_entry *,
6636
   int, const r_reloc *, const literal_value *, section_cache_t *);
6637
 
6638
/* Second pass: */
6639
static bfd_boolean relax_section (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *);
6640
static bfd_boolean translate_section_fixes (asection *);
6641
static bfd_boolean translate_reloc_bfd_fix (reloc_bfd_fix *);
6642
static asection *translate_reloc (const r_reloc *, r_reloc *, asection *);
6643
static void shrink_dynamic_reloc_sections
6644
  (struct bfd_link_info *, bfd *, asection *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
6645
static bfd_boolean move_literal
6646
  (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, asection *, bfd_vma, bfd_byte *,
6647
   xtensa_relax_info *, Elf_Internal_Rela **, const literal_value *);
6648
static bfd_boolean relax_property_section
6649
  (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *);
6650
 
6651
/* Third pass: */
6652
static bfd_boolean relax_section_symbols (bfd *, asection *);
6653
 
6654
 
6655
static bfd_boolean
6656
elf_xtensa_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
6657
                          asection *sec,
6658
                          struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6659
                          bfd_boolean *again)
6660
{
6661
  static value_map_hash_table *values = NULL;
6662
  static bfd_boolean relocations_analyzed = FALSE;
6663
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
6664
 
6665
  if (!relocations_analyzed)
6666
    {
6667
      /* Do some overall initialization for relaxation.  */
6668
      values = value_map_hash_table_init ();
6669
      if (values == NULL)
6670
        return FALSE;
6671
      relaxing_section = TRUE;
6672
      if (!analyze_relocations (link_info))
6673
        return FALSE;
6674
      relocations_analyzed = TRUE;
6675
    }
6676
  *again = FALSE;
6677
 
6678
  /* Don't mess with linker-created sections.  */
6679
  if ((sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
6680
    return TRUE;
6681
 
6682
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
6683
  BFD_ASSERT (relax_info != NULL);
6684
 
6685
  switch (relax_info->visited)
6686
    {
6687
    case 0:
6688
      /* Note: It would be nice to fold this pass into
6689
         analyze_relocations, but it is important for this step that the
6690
         sections be examined in link order.  */
6691
      if (!compute_removed_literals (abfd, sec, link_info, values))
6692
        return FALSE;
6693
      *again = TRUE;
6694
      break;
6695
 
6696
    case 1:
6697
      if (values)
6698
        value_map_hash_table_delete (values);
6699
      values = NULL;
6700
      if (!relax_section (abfd, sec, link_info))
6701
        return FALSE;
6702
      *again = TRUE;
6703
      break;
6704
 
6705
    case 2:
6706
      if (!relax_section_symbols (abfd, sec))
6707
        return FALSE;
6708
      break;
6709
    }
6710
 
6711
  relax_info->visited++;
6712
  return TRUE;
6713
}
6714
 
6715
 
6716
/* Initialization for relaxation.  */
6717
 
6718
/* This function is called once at the start of relaxation.  It scans
6719
   all the input sections and marks the ones that are relaxable (i.e.,
6720
   literal sections with L32R relocations against them), and then
6721
   collects source_reloc information for all the relocations against
6722
   those relaxable sections.  During this process, it also detects
6723
   longcalls, i.e., calls relaxed by the assembler into indirect
6724
   calls, that can be optimized back into direct calls.  Within each
6725
   extended basic block (ebb) containing an optimized longcall, it
6726
   computes a set of "text actions" that can be performed to remove
6727
   the L32R associated with the longcall while optionally preserving
6728
   branch target alignments.  */
6729
 
6730
static bfd_boolean
6731
analyze_relocations (struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6732
{
6733
  bfd *abfd;
6734
  asection *sec;
6735
  bfd_boolean is_relaxable = FALSE;
6736
 
6737
  /* Initialize the per-section relaxation info.  */
6738
  for (abfd = link_info->input_bfds; abfd != NULL; abfd = abfd->link_next)
6739
    for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
6740
      {
6741
        init_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
6742
      }
6743
 
6744
  /* Mark relaxable sections (and count relocations against each one).  */
6745
  for (abfd = link_info->input_bfds; abfd != NULL; abfd = abfd->link_next)
6746
    for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
6747
      {
6748
        if (!find_relaxable_sections (abfd, sec, link_info, &is_relaxable))
6749
          return FALSE;
6750
      }
6751
 
6752
  /* Bail out if there are no relaxable sections.  */
6753
  if (!is_relaxable)
6754
    return TRUE;
6755
 
6756
  /* Allocate space for source_relocs.  */
6757
  for (abfd = link_info->input_bfds; abfd != NULL; abfd = abfd->link_next)
6758
    for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
6759
      {
6760
        xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
6761
 
6762
        relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
6763
        if (relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
6764
            || relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section)
6765
          {
6766
            relax_info->src_relocs = (source_reloc *)
6767
              bfd_malloc (relax_info->src_count * sizeof (source_reloc));
6768
          }
6769
        else
6770
          relax_info->src_count = 0;
6771
      }
6772
 
6773
  /* Collect info on relocations against each relaxable section.  */
6774
  for (abfd = link_info->input_bfds; abfd != NULL; abfd = abfd->link_next)
6775
    for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
6776
      {
6777
        if (!collect_source_relocs (abfd, sec, link_info))
6778
          return FALSE;
6779
      }
6780
 
6781
  /* Compute the text actions.  */
6782
  for (abfd = link_info->input_bfds; abfd != NULL; abfd = abfd->link_next)
6783
    for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
6784
      {
6785
        if (!compute_text_actions (abfd, sec, link_info))
6786
          return FALSE;
6787
      }
6788
 
6789
  return TRUE;
6790
}
6791
 
6792
 
6793
/* Find all the sections that might be relaxed.  The motivation for
6794
   this pass is that collect_source_relocs() needs to record _all_ the
6795
   relocations that target each relaxable section.  That is expensive
6796
   and unnecessary unless the target section is actually going to be
6797
   relaxed.  This pass identifies all such sections by checking if
6798
   they have L32Rs pointing to them.  In the process, the total number
6799
   of relocations targeting each section is also counted so that we
6800
   know how much space to allocate for source_relocs against each
6801
   relaxable literal section.  */
6802
 
6803
static bfd_boolean
6804
find_relaxable_sections (bfd *abfd,
6805
                         asection *sec,
6806
                         struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6807
                         bfd_boolean *is_relaxable_p)
6808
{
6809
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
6810
  bfd_byte *contents;
6811
  bfd_boolean ok = TRUE;
6812
  unsigned i;
6813
  xtensa_relax_info *source_relax_info;
6814
  bfd_boolean is_l32r_reloc;
6815
 
6816
  internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
6817
                                              link_info->keep_memory);
6818
  if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6819
    return ok;
6820
 
6821
  contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
6822
  if (contents == NULL && sec->size != 0)
6823
    {
6824
      ok = FALSE;
6825
      goto error_return;
6826
    }
6827
 
6828
  source_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
6829
  for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
6830
    {
6831
      Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
6832
      r_reloc r_rel;
6833
      asection *target_sec;
6834
      xtensa_relax_info *target_relax_info;
6835
 
6836
      /* If this section has not already been marked as "relaxable", and
6837
         if it contains any ASM_EXPAND relocations (marking expanded
6838
         longcalls) that can be optimized into direct calls, then mark
6839
         the section as "relaxable".  */
6840
      if (source_relax_info
6841
          && !source_relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section
6842
          && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) == R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND)
6843
        {
6844
          bfd_boolean is_reachable = FALSE;
6845
          if (is_resolvable_asm_expansion (abfd, sec, contents, irel,
6846
                                           link_info, &is_reachable)
6847
              && is_reachable)
6848
            {
6849
              source_relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section = TRUE;
6850
              *is_relaxable_p = TRUE;
6851
            }
6852
        }
6853
 
6854
      r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents,
6855
                    bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec));
6856
 
6857
      target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel);
6858
      target_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (target_sec);
6859
      if (!target_relax_info)
6860
        continue;
6861
 
6862
      /* Count PC-relative operand relocations against the target section.
6863
         Note: The conditions tested here must match the conditions under
6864
         which init_source_reloc is called in collect_source_relocs().  */
6865
      is_l32r_reloc = FALSE;
6866
      if (is_operand_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info)))
6867
        {
6868
          xtensa_opcode opcode =
6869
            get_relocation_opcode (abfd, sec, contents, irel);
6870
          if (opcode != XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
6871
            {
6872
              is_l32r_reloc = (opcode == get_l32r_opcode ());
6873
              if (!is_alt_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info))
6874
                  || is_l32r_reloc)
6875
                target_relax_info->src_count++;
6876
            }
6877
        }
6878
 
6879
      if (is_l32r_reloc && r_reloc_is_defined (&r_rel))
6880
        {
6881
          /* Mark the target section as relaxable.  */
6882
          target_relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section = TRUE;
6883
          *is_relaxable_p = TRUE;
6884
        }
6885
    }
6886
 
6887
 error_return:
6888
  release_contents (sec, contents);
6889
  release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
6890
  return ok;
6891
}
6892
 
6893
 
6894
/* Record _all_ the relocations that point to relaxable sections, and
6895
   get rid of ASM_EXPAND relocs by either converting them to
6896
   ASM_SIMPLIFY or by removing them.  */
6897
 
6898
static bfd_boolean
6899
collect_source_relocs (bfd *abfd,
6900
                       asection *sec,
6901
                       struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6902
{
6903
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
6904
  bfd_byte *contents;
6905
  bfd_boolean ok = TRUE;
6906
  unsigned i;
6907
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
6908
 
6909
  internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
6910
                                              link_info->keep_memory);
6911
  if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6912
    return ok;
6913
 
6914
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
6915
  contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
6916
  if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
6917
    {
6918
      ok = FALSE;
6919
      goto error_return;
6920
    }
6921
 
6922
  /* Record relocations against relaxable literal sections.  */
6923
  for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
6924
    {
6925
      Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
6926
      r_reloc r_rel;
6927
      asection *target_sec;
6928
      xtensa_relax_info *target_relax_info;
6929
 
6930
      r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents, sec_size);
6931
 
6932
      target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel);
6933
      target_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (target_sec);
6934
 
6935
      if (target_relax_info
6936
          && (target_relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
6937
              || target_relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section))
6938
        {
6939
          xtensa_opcode opcode = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
6940
          int opnd = -1;
6941
          bfd_boolean is_abs_literal = FALSE;
6942
 
6943
          if (is_alt_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info)))
6944
            {
6945
              /* None of the current alternate relocs are PC-relative,
6946
                 and only PC-relative relocs matter here.  However, we
6947
                 still need to record the opcode for literal
6948
                 coalescing.  */
6949
              opcode = get_relocation_opcode (abfd, sec, contents, irel);
6950
              if (opcode == get_l32r_opcode ())
6951
                {
6952
                  is_abs_literal = TRUE;
6953
                  opnd = 1;
6954
                }
6955
              else
6956
                opcode = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
6957
            }
6958
          else if (is_operand_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info)))
6959
            {
6960
              opcode = get_relocation_opcode (abfd, sec, contents, irel);
6961
              opnd = get_relocation_opnd (opcode, ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info));
6962
            }
6963
 
6964
          if (opcode != XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
6965
            {
6966
              int src_next = target_relax_info->src_next++;
6967
              source_reloc *s_reloc = &target_relax_info->src_relocs[src_next];
6968
 
6969
              init_source_reloc (s_reloc, sec, &r_rel, opcode, opnd,
6970
                                 is_abs_literal);
6971
            }
6972
        }
6973
    }
6974
 
6975
  /* Now get rid of ASM_EXPAND relocations.  At this point, the
6976
     src_relocs array for the target literal section may still be
6977
     incomplete, but it must at least contain the entries for the L32R
6978
     relocations associated with ASM_EXPANDs because they were just
6979
     added in the preceding loop over the relocations.  */
6980
 
6981
  for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
6982
    {
6983
      Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
6984
      bfd_boolean is_reachable;
6985
 
6986
      if (!is_resolvable_asm_expansion (abfd, sec, contents, irel, link_info,
6987
                                        &is_reachable))
6988
        continue;
6989
 
6990
      if (is_reachable)
6991
        {
6992
          Elf_Internal_Rela *l32r_irel;
6993
          r_reloc r_rel;
6994
          asection *target_sec;
6995
          xtensa_relax_info *target_relax_info;
6996
 
6997
          /* Mark the source_reloc for the L32R so that it will be
6998
             removed in compute_removed_literals(), along with the
6999
             associated literal.  */
7000
          l32r_irel = find_associated_l32r_irel (abfd, sec, contents,
7001
                                                 irel, internal_relocs);
7002
          if (l32r_irel == NULL)
7003
            continue;
7004
 
7005
          r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, l32r_irel, contents, sec_size);
7006
 
7007
          target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel);
7008
          target_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (target_sec);
7009
 
7010
          if (target_relax_info
7011
              && (target_relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
7012
                  || target_relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section))
7013
            {
7014
              source_reloc *s_reloc;
7015
 
7016
              /* Search the source_relocs for the entry corresponding to
7017
                 the l32r_irel.  Note: The src_relocs array is not yet
7018
                 sorted, but it wouldn't matter anyway because we're
7019
                 searching by source offset instead of target offset.  */
7020
              s_reloc = find_source_reloc (target_relax_info->src_relocs,
7021
                                           target_relax_info->src_next,
7022
                                           sec, l32r_irel);
7023
              BFD_ASSERT (s_reloc);
7024
              s_reloc->is_null = TRUE;
7025
            }
7026
 
7027
          /* Convert this reloc to ASM_SIMPLIFY.  */
7028
          irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
7029
                                       R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY);
7030
          l32r_irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_NONE);
7031
 
7032
          pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
7033
        }
7034
      else
7035
        {
7036
          /* It is resolvable but doesn't reach.  We resolve now
7037
             by eliminating the relocation -- the call will remain
7038
             expanded into L32R/CALLX.  */
7039
          irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_NONE);
7040
          pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
7041
        }
7042
    }
7043
 
7044
 error_return:
7045
  release_contents (sec, contents);
7046
  release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
7047
  return ok;
7048
}
7049
 
7050
 
7051
/* Return TRUE if the asm expansion can be resolved.  Generally it can
7052
   be resolved on a final link or when a partial link locates it in the
7053
   same section as the target.  Set "is_reachable" flag if the target of
7054
   the call is within the range of a direct call, given the current VMA
7055
   for this section and the target section.  */
7056
 
7057
bfd_boolean
7058
is_resolvable_asm_expansion (bfd *abfd,
7059
                             asection *sec,
7060
                             bfd_byte *contents,
7061
                             Elf_Internal_Rela *irel,
7062
                             struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
7063
                             bfd_boolean *is_reachable_p)
7064
{
7065
  asection *target_sec;
7066
  bfd_vma target_offset;
7067
  r_reloc r_rel;
7068
  xtensa_opcode opcode, direct_call_opcode;
7069
  bfd_vma self_address;
7070
  bfd_vma dest_address;
7071
  bfd_boolean uses_l32r;
7072
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
7073
 
7074
  *is_reachable_p = FALSE;
7075
 
7076
  if (contents == NULL)
7077
    return FALSE;
7078
 
7079
  if (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND)
7080
    return FALSE;
7081
 
7082
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
7083
  opcode = get_expanded_call_opcode (contents + irel->r_offset,
7084
                                     sec_size - irel->r_offset, &uses_l32r);
7085
  /* Optimization of longcalls that use CONST16 is not yet implemented.  */
7086
  if (!uses_l32r)
7087
    return FALSE;
7088
 
7089
  direct_call_opcode = swap_callx_for_call_opcode (opcode);
7090
  if (direct_call_opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
7091
    return FALSE;
7092
 
7093
  /* Check and see that the target resolves.  */
7094
  r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents, sec_size);
7095
  if (!r_reloc_is_defined (&r_rel))
7096
    return FALSE;
7097
 
7098
  target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel);
7099
  target_offset = r_rel.target_offset;
7100
 
7101
  /* If the target is in a shared library, then it doesn't reach.  This
7102
     isn't supposed to come up because the compiler should never generate
7103
     non-PIC calls on systems that use shared libraries, but the linker
7104
     shouldn't crash regardless.  */
7105
  if (!target_sec->output_section)
7106
    return FALSE;
7107
 
7108
  /* For relocatable sections, we can only simplify when the output
7109
     section of the target is the same as the output section of the
7110
     source.  */
7111
  if (link_info->relocatable
7112
      && (target_sec->output_section != sec->output_section
7113
          || is_reloc_sym_weak (abfd, irel)))
7114
    return FALSE;
7115
 
7116
  self_address = (sec->output_section->vma
7117
                  + sec->output_offset + irel->r_offset + 3);
7118
  dest_address = (target_sec->output_section->vma
7119
                  + target_sec->output_offset + target_offset);
7120
 
7121
  *is_reachable_p = pcrel_reloc_fits (direct_call_opcode, 0,
7122
                                      self_address, dest_address);
7123
 
7124
  if ((self_address >> CALL_SEGMENT_BITS) !=
7125
      (dest_address >> CALL_SEGMENT_BITS))
7126
    return FALSE;
7127
 
7128
  return TRUE;
7129
}
7130
 
7131
 
7132
static Elf_Internal_Rela *
7133
find_associated_l32r_irel (bfd *abfd,
7134
                           asection *sec,
7135
                           bfd_byte *contents,
7136
                           Elf_Internal_Rela *other_irel,
7137
                           Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs)
7138
{
7139
  unsigned i;
7140
 
7141
  for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
7142
    {
7143
      Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
7144
 
7145
      if (irel == other_irel)
7146
        continue;
7147
      if (irel->r_offset != other_irel->r_offset)
7148
        continue;
7149
      if (is_l32r_relocation (abfd, sec, contents, irel))
7150
        return irel;
7151
    }
7152
 
7153
  return NULL;
7154
}
7155
 
7156
 
7157
static xtensa_opcode *
7158
build_reloc_opcodes (bfd *abfd,
7159
                     asection *sec,
7160
                     bfd_byte *contents,
7161
                     Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs)
7162
{
7163
  unsigned i;
7164
  xtensa_opcode *reloc_opcodes =
7165
    (xtensa_opcode *) bfd_malloc (sizeof (xtensa_opcode) * sec->reloc_count);
7166
  for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
7167
    {
7168
      Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
7169
      reloc_opcodes[i] = get_relocation_opcode (abfd, sec, contents, irel);
7170
    }
7171
  return reloc_opcodes;
7172
}
7173
 
7174
 
7175
/* The compute_text_actions function will build a list of potential
7176
   transformation actions for code in the extended basic block of each
7177
   longcall that is optimized to a direct call.  From this list we
7178
   generate a set of actions to actually perform that optimizes for
7179
   space and, if not using size_opt, maintains branch target
7180
   alignments.
7181
 
7182
   These actions to be performed are placed on a per-section list.
7183
   The actual changes are performed by relax_section() in the second
7184
   pass.  */
7185
 
7186
bfd_boolean
7187
compute_text_actions (bfd *abfd,
7188
                      asection *sec,
7189
                      struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
7190
{
7191
  xtensa_opcode *reloc_opcodes = NULL;
7192
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
7193
  bfd_byte *contents;
7194
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
7195
  bfd_boolean ok = TRUE;
7196
  unsigned i;
7197
  property_table_entry *prop_table = 0;
7198
  int ptblsize = 0;
7199
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
7200
 
7201
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
7202
  BFD_ASSERT (relax_info);
7203
  BFD_ASSERT (relax_info->src_next == relax_info->src_count);
7204
 
7205
  /* Do nothing if the section contains no optimized longcalls.  */
7206
  if (!relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section)
7207
    return ok;
7208
 
7209
  internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
7210
                                              link_info->keep_memory);
7211
 
7212
  if (internal_relocs)
7213
    qsort (internal_relocs, sec->reloc_count, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela),
7214
           internal_reloc_compare);
7215
 
7216
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
7217
  contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
7218
  if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
7219
    {
7220
      ok = FALSE;
7221
      goto error_return;
7222
    }
7223
 
7224
  ptblsize = xtensa_read_table_entries (abfd, sec, &prop_table,
7225
                                        XTENSA_PROP_SEC_NAME, FALSE);
7226
  if (ptblsize < 0)
7227
    {
7228
      ok = FALSE;
7229
      goto error_return;
7230
    }
7231
 
7232
  for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
7233
    {
7234
      Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
7235
      bfd_vma r_offset;
7236
      property_table_entry *the_entry;
7237
      int ptbl_idx;
7238
      ebb_t *ebb;
7239
      ebb_constraint ebb_table;
7240
      bfd_size_type simplify_size;
7241
 
7242
      if (irel && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY)
7243
        continue;
7244
      r_offset = irel->r_offset;
7245
 
7246
      simplify_size = get_asm_simplify_size (contents, sec_size, r_offset);
7247
      if (simplify_size == 0)
7248
        {
7249
          (*_bfd_error_handler)
7250
            (_("%B(%A+0x%lx): could not decode instruction for XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY relocation; possible configuration mismatch"),
7251
             sec->owner, sec, r_offset);
7252
          continue;
7253
        }
7254
 
7255
      /* If the instruction table is not around, then don't do this
7256
         relaxation.  */
7257
      the_entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (prop_table, ptblsize,
7258
                                                  sec->vma + irel->r_offset);
7259
      if (the_entry == NULL || XTENSA_NO_NOP_REMOVAL)
7260
        {
7261
          text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
7262
                           ta_convert_longcall, sec, r_offset,
7263
                           0);
7264
          continue;
7265
        }
7266
 
7267
      /* If the next longcall happens to be at the same address as an
7268
         unreachable section of size 0, then skip forward.  */
7269
      ptbl_idx = the_entry - prop_table;
7270
      while ((the_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE)
7271
             && the_entry->size == 0
7272
             && ptbl_idx + 1 < ptblsize
7273
             && (prop_table[ptbl_idx + 1].address
7274
                 == prop_table[ptbl_idx].address))
7275
        {
7276
          ptbl_idx++;
7277
          the_entry++;
7278
        }
7279
 
7280
      if (the_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM)
7281
          /* NO_REORDER is OK */
7282
        continue;
7283
 
7284
      init_ebb_constraint (&ebb_table);
7285
      ebb = &ebb_table.ebb;
7286
      init_ebb (ebb, sec, contents, sec_size, prop_table, ptblsize,
7287
                internal_relocs, sec->reloc_count);
7288
      ebb->start_offset = r_offset + simplify_size;
7289
      ebb->end_offset = r_offset + simplify_size;
7290
      ebb->start_ptbl_idx = ptbl_idx;
7291
      ebb->end_ptbl_idx = ptbl_idx;
7292
      ebb->start_reloc_idx = i;
7293
      ebb->end_reloc_idx = i;
7294
 
7295
      /* Precompute the opcode for each relocation.  */
7296
      if (reloc_opcodes == NULL)
7297
        reloc_opcodes = build_reloc_opcodes (abfd, sec, contents,
7298
                                             internal_relocs);
7299
 
7300
      if (!extend_ebb_bounds (ebb)
7301
          || !compute_ebb_proposed_actions (&ebb_table)
7302
          || !compute_ebb_actions (&ebb_table)
7303
          || !check_section_ebb_pcrels_fit (abfd, sec, contents,
7304
                                            internal_relocs, &ebb_table,
7305
                                            reloc_opcodes)
7306
          || !check_section_ebb_reduces (&ebb_table))
7307
        {
7308
          /* If anything goes wrong or we get unlucky and something does
7309
             not fit, with our plan because of expansion between
7310
             critical branches, just convert to a NOP.  */
7311
 
7312
          text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
7313
                           ta_convert_longcall, sec, r_offset, 0);
7314
          i = ebb_table.ebb.end_reloc_idx;
7315
          free_ebb_constraint (&ebb_table);
7316
          continue;
7317
        }
7318
 
7319
      text_action_add_proposed (&relax_info->action_list, &ebb_table, sec);
7320
 
7321
      /* Update the index so we do not go looking at the relocations
7322
         we have already processed.  */
7323
      i = ebb_table.ebb.end_reloc_idx;
7324
      free_ebb_constraint (&ebb_table);
7325
    }
7326
 
7327
#if DEBUG
7328
  if (relax_info->action_list.head)
7329
    print_action_list (stderr, &relax_info->action_list);
7330
#endif
7331
 
7332
error_return:
7333
  release_contents (sec, contents);
7334
  release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
7335
  if (prop_table)
7336
    free (prop_table);
7337
  if (reloc_opcodes)
7338
    free (reloc_opcodes);
7339
 
7340
  return ok;
7341
}
7342
 
7343
 
7344
/* Do not widen an instruction if it is preceeded by a
7345
   loop opcode.  It might cause misalignment.  */
7346
 
7347
static bfd_boolean
7348
prev_instr_is_a_loop (bfd_byte *contents,
7349
                      bfd_size_type content_length,
7350
                      bfd_size_type offset)
7351
{
7352
  xtensa_opcode prev_opcode;
7353
 
7354
  if (offset < 3)
7355
    return FALSE;
7356
  prev_opcode = insn_decode_opcode (contents, content_length, offset-3, 0);
7357
  return (xtensa_opcode_is_loop (xtensa_default_isa, prev_opcode) == 1);
7358
}
7359
 
7360
 
7361
/* Find all of the possible actions for an extended basic block.  */
7362
 
7363
bfd_boolean
7364
compute_ebb_proposed_actions (ebb_constraint *ebb_table)
7365
{
7366
  const ebb_t *ebb = &ebb_table->ebb;
7367
  unsigned rel_idx = ebb->start_reloc_idx;
7368
  property_table_entry *entry, *start_entry, *end_entry;
7369
  bfd_vma offset = 0;
7370
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
7371
  xtensa_format fmt;
7372
  static xtensa_insnbuf insnbuf = NULL;
7373
  static xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf = NULL;
7374
 
7375
  if (insnbuf == NULL)
7376
    {
7377
      insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
7378
      slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
7379
    }
7380
 
7381
  start_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->start_ptbl_idx];
7382
  end_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->end_ptbl_idx];
7383
 
7384
  for (entry = start_entry; entry <= end_entry; entry++)
7385
    {
7386
      bfd_vma start_offset, end_offset;
7387
      bfd_size_type insn_len;
7388
 
7389
      start_offset = entry->address - ebb->sec->vma;
7390
      end_offset = entry->address + entry->size - ebb->sec->vma;
7391
 
7392
      if (entry == start_entry)
7393
        start_offset = ebb->start_offset;
7394
      if (entry == end_entry)
7395
        end_offset = ebb->end_offset;
7396
      offset = start_offset;
7397
 
7398
      if (offset == entry->address - ebb->sec->vma
7399
          && (entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_INSN_BRANCH_TARGET) != 0)
7400
        {
7401
          enum ebb_target_enum align_type = EBB_DESIRE_TGT_ALIGN;
7402
          BFD_ASSERT (offset != end_offset);
7403
          if (offset == end_offset)
7404
            return FALSE;
7405
 
7406
          insn_len = insn_decode_len (ebb->contents, ebb->content_length,
7407
                                      offset);
7408
          if (insn_len == 0)
7409
            goto decode_error;
7410
 
7411
          if (check_branch_target_aligned_address (offset, insn_len))
7412
            align_type = EBB_REQUIRE_TGT_ALIGN;
7413
 
7414
          ebb_propose_action (ebb_table, align_type, 0,
7415
                              ta_none, offset, 0, TRUE);
7416
        }
7417
 
7418
      while (offset != end_offset)
7419
        {
7420
          Elf_Internal_Rela *irel;
7421
          xtensa_opcode opcode;
7422
 
7423
          while (rel_idx < ebb->end_reloc_idx
7424
                 && (ebb->relocs[rel_idx].r_offset < offset
7425
                     || (ebb->relocs[rel_idx].r_offset == offset
7426
                         && (ELF32_R_TYPE (ebb->relocs[rel_idx].r_info)
7427
                             != R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY))))
7428
            rel_idx++;
7429
 
7430
          /* Check for longcall.  */
7431
          irel = &ebb->relocs[rel_idx];
7432
          if (irel->r_offset == offset
7433
              && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) == R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY)
7434
            {
7435
              bfd_size_type simplify_size;
7436
 
7437
              simplify_size = get_asm_simplify_size (ebb->contents,
7438
                                                     ebb->content_length,
7439
                                                     irel->r_offset);
7440
              if (simplify_size == 0)
7441
                goto decode_error;
7442
 
7443
              ebb_propose_action (ebb_table, EBB_NO_ALIGN, 0,
7444
                                  ta_convert_longcall, offset, 0, TRUE);
7445
 
7446
              offset += simplify_size;
7447
              continue;
7448
            }
7449
 
7450
          if (offset + MIN_INSN_LENGTH > ebb->content_length)
7451
            goto decode_error;
7452
          xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, &ebb->contents[offset],
7453
                                     ebb->content_length - offset);
7454
          fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
7455
          if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
7456
            goto decode_error;
7457
          insn_len = xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
7458
          if (insn_len == (bfd_size_type) XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
7459
            goto decode_error;
7460
 
7461
          if (xtensa_format_num_slots (isa, fmt) != 1)
7462
            {
7463
              offset += insn_len;
7464
              continue;
7465
            }
7466
 
7467
          xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf);
7468
          opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, slotbuf);
7469
          if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
7470
            goto decode_error;
7471
 
7472
          if ((entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_INSN_NO_DENSITY) == 0
7473
              && (entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM) == 0
7474
              && can_narrow_instruction (slotbuf, fmt, opcode) != 0)
7475
            {
7476
              /* Add an instruction narrow action.  */
7477
              ebb_propose_action (ebb_table, EBB_NO_ALIGN, 0,
7478
                                  ta_narrow_insn, offset, 0, FALSE);
7479
            }
7480
          else if ((entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM) == 0
7481
                   && can_widen_instruction (slotbuf, fmt, opcode) != 0
7482
                   && ! prev_instr_is_a_loop (ebb->contents,
7483
                                              ebb->content_length, offset))
7484
            {
7485
              /* Add an instruction widen action.  */
7486
              ebb_propose_action (ebb_table, EBB_NO_ALIGN, 0,
7487
                                  ta_widen_insn, offset, 0, FALSE);
7488
            }
7489
          else if (xtensa_opcode_is_loop (xtensa_default_isa, opcode) == 1)
7490
            {
7491
              /* Check for branch targets.  */
7492
              ebb_propose_action (ebb_table, EBB_REQUIRE_LOOP_ALIGN, 0,
7493
                                  ta_none, offset, 0, TRUE);
7494
            }
7495
 
7496
          offset += insn_len;
7497
        }
7498
    }
7499
 
7500
  if (ebb->ends_unreachable)
7501
    {
7502
      ebb_propose_action (ebb_table, EBB_NO_ALIGN, 0,
7503
                          ta_fill, ebb->end_offset, 0, TRUE);
7504
    }
7505
 
7506
  return TRUE;
7507
 
7508
 decode_error:
7509
  (*_bfd_error_handler)
7510
    (_("%B(%A+0x%lx): could not decode instruction; possible configuration mismatch"),
7511
     ebb->sec->owner, ebb->sec, offset);
7512
  return FALSE;
7513
}
7514
 
7515
 
7516
/* After all of the information has collected about the
7517
   transformations possible in an EBB, compute the appropriate actions
7518
   here in compute_ebb_actions.  We still must check later to make
7519
   sure that the actions do not break any relocations.  The algorithm
7520
   used here is pretty greedy.  Basically, it removes as many no-ops
7521
   as possible so that the end of the EBB has the same alignment
7522
   characteristics as the original.  First, it uses narrowing, then
7523
   fill space at the end of the EBB, and finally widenings.  If that
7524
   does not work, it tries again with one fewer no-op removed.  The
7525
   optimization will only be performed if all of the branch targets
7526
   that were aligned before transformation are also aligned after the
7527
   transformation.
7528
 
7529
   When the size_opt flag is set, ignore the branch target alignments,
7530
   narrow all wide instructions, and remove all no-ops unless the end
7531
   of the EBB prevents it.  */
7532
 
7533
bfd_boolean
7534
compute_ebb_actions (ebb_constraint *ebb_table)
7535
{
7536
  unsigned i = 0;
7537
  unsigned j;
7538
  int removed_bytes = 0;
7539
  ebb_t *ebb = &ebb_table->ebb;
7540
  unsigned seg_idx_start = 0;
7541
  unsigned seg_idx_end = 0;
7542
 
7543
  /* We perform this like the assembler relaxation algorithm: Start by
7544
     assuming all instructions are narrow and all no-ops removed; then
7545
     walk through....  */
7546
 
7547
  /* For each segment of this that has a solid constraint, check to
7548
     see if there are any combinations that will keep the constraint.
7549
     If so, use it.  */
7550
  for (seg_idx_end = 0; seg_idx_end < ebb_table->action_count; seg_idx_end++)
7551
    {
7552
      bfd_boolean requires_text_end_align = FALSE;
7553
      unsigned longcall_count = 0;
7554
      unsigned longcall_convert_count = 0;
7555
      unsigned narrowable_count = 0;
7556
      unsigned narrowable_convert_count = 0;
7557
      unsigned widenable_count = 0;
7558
      unsigned widenable_convert_count = 0;
7559
 
7560
      proposed_action *action = NULL;
7561
      int align = (1 << ebb_table->ebb.sec->alignment_power);
7562
 
7563
      seg_idx_start = seg_idx_end;
7564
 
7565
      for (i = seg_idx_start; i < ebb_table->action_count; i++)
7566
        {
7567
          action = &ebb_table->actions[i];
7568
          if (action->action == ta_convert_longcall)
7569
            longcall_count++;
7570
          if (action->action == ta_narrow_insn)
7571
            narrowable_count++;
7572
          if (action->action == ta_widen_insn)
7573
            widenable_count++;
7574
          if (action->action == ta_fill)
7575
            break;
7576
          if (action->align_type == EBB_REQUIRE_LOOP_ALIGN)
7577
            break;
7578
          if (action->align_type == EBB_REQUIRE_TGT_ALIGN
7579
              && !elf32xtensa_size_opt)
7580
            break;
7581
        }
7582
      seg_idx_end = i;
7583
 
7584
      if (seg_idx_end == ebb_table->action_count && !ebb->ends_unreachable)
7585
        requires_text_end_align = TRUE;
7586
 
7587
      if (elf32xtensa_size_opt && !requires_text_end_align
7588
          && action->align_type != EBB_REQUIRE_LOOP_ALIGN
7589
          && action->align_type != EBB_REQUIRE_TGT_ALIGN)
7590
        {
7591
          longcall_convert_count = longcall_count;
7592
          narrowable_convert_count = narrowable_count;
7593
          widenable_convert_count = 0;
7594
        }
7595
      else
7596
        {
7597
          /* There is a constraint.  Convert the max number of longcalls.  */
7598
          narrowable_convert_count = 0;
7599
          longcall_convert_count = 0;
7600
          widenable_convert_count = 0;
7601
 
7602
          for (j = 0; j < longcall_count; j++)
7603
            {
7604
              int removed = (longcall_count - j) * 3 & (align - 1);
7605
              unsigned desire_narrow = (align - removed) & (align - 1);
7606
              unsigned desire_widen = removed;
7607
              if (desire_narrow <= narrowable_count)
7608
                {
7609
                  narrowable_convert_count = desire_narrow;
7610
                  narrowable_convert_count +=
7611
                    (align * ((narrowable_count - narrowable_convert_count)
7612
                              / align));
7613
                  longcall_convert_count = (longcall_count - j);
7614
                  widenable_convert_count = 0;
7615
                  break;
7616
                }
7617
              if (desire_widen <= widenable_count && !elf32xtensa_size_opt)
7618
                {
7619
                  narrowable_convert_count = 0;
7620
                  longcall_convert_count = longcall_count - j;
7621
                  widenable_convert_count = desire_widen;
7622
                  break;
7623
                }
7624
            }
7625
        }
7626
 
7627
      /* Now the number of conversions are saved.  Do them.  */
7628
      for (i = seg_idx_start; i < seg_idx_end; i++)
7629
        {
7630
          action = &ebb_table->actions[i];
7631
          switch (action->action)
7632
            {
7633
            case ta_convert_longcall:
7634
              if (longcall_convert_count != 0)
7635
                {
7636
                  action->action = ta_remove_longcall;
7637
                  action->do_action = TRUE;
7638
                  action->removed_bytes += 3;
7639
                  longcall_convert_count--;
7640
                }
7641
              break;
7642
            case ta_narrow_insn:
7643
              if (narrowable_convert_count != 0)
7644
                {
7645
                  action->do_action = TRUE;
7646
                  action->removed_bytes += 1;
7647
                  narrowable_convert_count--;
7648
                }
7649
              break;
7650
            case ta_widen_insn:
7651
              if (widenable_convert_count != 0)
7652
                {
7653
                  action->do_action = TRUE;
7654
                  action->removed_bytes -= 1;
7655
                  widenable_convert_count--;
7656
                }
7657
              break;
7658
            default:
7659
              break;
7660
            }
7661
        }
7662
    }
7663
 
7664
  /* Now we move on to some local opts.  Try to remove each of the
7665
     remaining longcalls.  */
7666
 
7667
  if (ebb_table->ebb.ends_section || ebb_table->ebb.ends_unreachable)
7668
    {
7669
      removed_bytes = 0;
7670
      for (i = 0; i < ebb_table->action_count; i++)
7671
        {
7672
          int old_removed_bytes = removed_bytes;
7673
          proposed_action *action = &ebb_table->actions[i];
7674
 
7675
          if (action->do_action && action->action == ta_convert_longcall)
7676
            {
7677
              bfd_boolean bad_alignment = FALSE;
7678
              removed_bytes += 3;
7679
              for (j = i + 1; j < ebb_table->action_count; j++)
7680
                {
7681
                  proposed_action *new_action = &ebb_table->actions[j];
7682
                  bfd_vma offset = new_action->offset;
7683
                  if (new_action->align_type == EBB_REQUIRE_TGT_ALIGN)
7684
                    {
7685
                      if (!check_branch_target_aligned
7686
                          (ebb_table->ebb.contents,
7687
                           ebb_table->ebb.content_length,
7688
                           offset, offset - removed_bytes))
7689
                        {
7690
                          bad_alignment = TRUE;
7691
                          break;
7692
                        }
7693
                    }
7694
                  if (new_action->align_type == EBB_REQUIRE_LOOP_ALIGN)
7695
                    {
7696
                      if (!check_loop_aligned (ebb_table->ebb.contents,
7697
                                               ebb_table->ebb.content_length,
7698
                                               offset,
7699
                                               offset - removed_bytes))
7700
                        {
7701
                          bad_alignment = TRUE;
7702
                          break;
7703
                        }
7704
                    }
7705
                  if (new_action->action == ta_narrow_insn
7706
                      && !new_action->do_action
7707
                      && ebb_table->ebb.sec->alignment_power == 2)
7708
                    {
7709
                      /* Narrow an instruction and we are done.  */
7710
                      new_action->do_action = TRUE;
7711
                      new_action->removed_bytes += 1;
7712
                      bad_alignment = FALSE;
7713
                      break;
7714
                    }
7715
                  if (new_action->action == ta_widen_insn
7716
                      && new_action->do_action
7717
                      && ebb_table->ebb.sec->alignment_power == 2)
7718
                    {
7719
                      /* Narrow an instruction and we are done.  */
7720
                      new_action->do_action = FALSE;
7721
                      new_action->removed_bytes += 1;
7722
                      bad_alignment = FALSE;
7723
                      break;
7724
                    }
7725
                  if (new_action->do_action)
7726
                    removed_bytes += new_action->removed_bytes;
7727
                }
7728
              if (!bad_alignment)
7729
                {
7730
                  action->removed_bytes += 3;
7731
                  action->action = ta_remove_longcall;
7732
                  action->do_action = TRUE;
7733
                }
7734
            }
7735
          removed_bytes = old_removed_bytes;
7736
          if (action->do_action)
7737
            removed_bytes += action->removed_bytes;
7738
        }
7739
    }
7740
 
7741
  removed_bytes = 0;
7742
  for (i = 0; i < ebb_table->action_count; ++i)
7743
    {
7744
      proposed_action *action = &ebb_table->actions[i];
7745
      if (action->do_action)
7746
        removed_bytes += action->removed_bytes;
7747
    }
7748
 
7749
  if ((removed_bytes % (1 << ebb_table->ebb.sec->alignment_power)) != 0
7750
      && ebb->ends_unreachable)
7751
    {
7752
      proposed_action *action;
7753
      int br;
7754
      int extra_space;
7755
 
7756
      BFD_ASSERT (ebb_table->action_count != 0);
7757
      action = &ebb_table->actions[ebb_table->action_count - 1];
7758
      BFD_ASSERT (action->action == ta_fill);
7759
      BFD_ASSERT (ebb->ends_unreachable->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE);
7760
 
7761
      extra_space = compute_fill_extra_space (ebb->ends_unreachable);
7762
      br = action->removed_bytes + removed_bytes + extra_space;
7763
      br = br & ((1 << ebb->sec->alignment_power ) - 1);
7764
 
7765
      action->removed_bytes = extra_space - br;
7766
    }
7767
  return TRUE;
7768
}
7769
 
7770
 
7771
/* The xlate_map is a sorted array of address mappings designed to
7772
   answer the offset_with_removed_text() query with a binary search instead
7773
   of a linear search through the section's action_list.  */
7774
 
7775
typedef struct xlate_map_entry xlate_map_entry_t;
7776
typedef struct xlate_map xlate_map_t;
7777
 
7778
struct xlate_map_entry
7779
{
7780
  unsigned orig_address;
7781
  unsigned new_address;
7782
  unsigned size;
7783
};
7784
 
7785
struct xlate_map
7786
{
7787
  unsigned entry_count;
7788
  xlate_map_entry_t *entry;
7789
};
7790
 
7791
 
7792
static int
7793
xlate_compare (const void *a_v, const void *b_v)
7794
{
7795
  const xlate_map_entry_t *a = (const xlate_map_entry_t *) a_v;
7796
  const xlate_map_entry_t *b = (const xlate_map_entry_t *) b_v;
7797
  if (a->orig_address < b->orig_address)
7798
    return -1;
7799
  if (a->orig_address > (b->orig_address + b->size - 1))
7800
    return 1;
7801
  return 0;
7802
}
7803
 
7804
 
7805
static bfd_vma
7806
xlate_offset_with_removed_text (const xlate_map_t *map,
7807
                                text_action_list *action_list,
7808
                                bfd_vma offset)
7809
{
7810
  xlate_map_entry_t tmp;
7811
  void *r;
7812
  xlate_map_entry_t *e;
7813
 
7814
  if (map == NULL)
7815
    return offset_with_removed_text (action_list, offset);
7816
 
7817
  if (map->entry_count == 0)
7818
    return offset;
7819
 
7820
  tmp.orig_address = offset;
7821
  tmp.new_address = offset;
7822
  tmp.size = 1;
7823
 
7824
  r = bsearch (&offset, map->entry, map->entry_count,
7825
               sizeof (xlate_map_entry_t), &xlate_compare);
7826
  e = (xlate_map_entry_t *) r;
7827
 
7828
  BFD_ASSERT (e != NULL);
7829
  if (e == NULL)
7830
    return offset;
7831
  return e->new_address - e->orig_address + offset;
7832
}
7833
 
7834
 
7835
/* Build a binary searchable offset translation map from a section's
7836
   action list.  */
7837
 
7838
static xlate_map_t *
7839
build_xlate_map (asection *sec, xtensa_relax_info *relax_info)
7840
{
7841
  xlate_map_t *map = (xlate_map_t *) bfd_malloc (sizeof (xlate_map_t));
7842
  text_action_list *action_list = &relax_info->action_list;
7843
  unsigned num_actions = 0;
7844
  text_action *r;
7845
  int removed;
7846
  xlate_map_entry_t *current_entry;
7847
 
7848
  if (map == NULL)
7849
    return NULL;
7850
 
7851
  num_actions = action_list_count (action_list);
7852
  map->entry = (xlate_map_entry_t *)
7853
    bfd_malloc (sizeof (xlate_map_entry_t) * (num_actions + 1));
7854
  if (map->entry == NULL)
7855
    {
7856
      free (map);
7857
      return NULL;
7858
    }
7859
  map->entry_count = 0;
7860
 
7861
  removed = 0;
7862
  current_entry = &map->entry[0];
7863
 
7864
  current_entry->orig_address = 0;
7865
  current_entry->new_address = 0;
7866
  current_entry->size = 0;
7867
 
7868
  for (r = action_list->head; r != NULL; r = r->next)
7869
    {
7870
      unsigned orig_size = 0;
7871
      switch (r->action)
7872
        {
7873
        case ta_none:
7874
        case ta_remove_insn:
7875
        case ta_convert_longcall:
7876
        case ta_remove_literal:
7877
        case ta_add_literal:
7878
          break;
7879
        case ta_remove_longcall:
7880
          orig_size = 6;
7881
          break;
7882
        case ta_narrow_insn:
7883
          orig_size = 3;
7884
          break;
7885
        case ta_widen_insn:
7886
          orig_size = 2;
7887
          break;
7888
        case ta_fill:
7889
          break;
7890
        }
7891
      current_entry->size =
7892
        r->offset + orig_size - current_entry->orig_address;
7893
      if (current_entry->size != 0)
7894
        {
7895
          current_entry++;
7896
          map->entry_count++;
7897
        }
7898
      current_entry->orig_address = r->offset + orig_size;
7899
      removed += r->removed_bytes;
7900
      current_entry->new_address = r->offset + orig_size - removed;
7901
      current_entry->size = 0;
7902
    }
7903
 
7904
  current_entry->size = (bfd_get_section_limit (sec->owner, sec)
7905
                         - current_entry->orig_address);
7906
  if (current_entry->size != 0)
7907
    map->entry_count++;
7908
 
7909
  return map;
7910
}
7911
 
7912
 
7913
/* Free an offset translation map.  */
7914
 
7915
static void
7916
free_xlate_map (xlate_map_t *map)
7917
{
7918
  if (map && map->entry)
7919
    free (map->entry);
7920
  if (map)
7921
    free (map);
7922
}
7923
 
7924
 
7925
/* Use check_section_ebb_pcrels_fit to make sure that all of the
7926
   relocations in a section will fit if a proposed set of actions
7927
   are performed.  */
7928
 
7929
static bfd_boolean
7930
check_section_ebb_pcrels_fit (bfd *abfd,
7931
                              asection *sec,
7932
                              bfd_byte *contents,
7933
                              Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs,
7934
                              const ebb_constraint *constraint,
7935
                              const xtensa_opcode *reloc_opcodes)
7936
{
7937
  unsigned i, j;
7938
  Elf_Internal_Rela *irel;
7939
  xlate_map_t *xmap = NULL;
7940
  bfd_boolean ok = TRUE;
7941
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
7942
 
7943
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
7944
 
7945
  if (relax_info && sec->reloc_count > 100)
7946
    {
7947
      xmap = build_xlate_map (sec, relax_info);
7948
      /* NULL indicates out of memory, but the slow version
7949
         can still be used.  */
7950
    }
7951
 
7952
  for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
7953
    {
7954
      r_reloc r_rel;
7955
      bfd_vma orig_self_offset, orig_target_offset;
7956
      bfd_vma self_offset, target_offset;
7957
      int r_type;
7958
      reloc_howto_type *howto;
7959
      int self_removed_bytes, target_removed_bytes;
7960
 
7961
      irel = &internal_relocs[i];
7962
      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
7963
 
7964
      howto = &elf_howto_table[r_type];
7965
      /* We maintain the required invariant: PC-relative relocations
7966
         that fit before linking must fit after linking.  Thus we only
7967
         need to deal with relocations to the same section that are
7968
         PC-relative.  */
7969
      if (r_type == R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY
7970
          || r_type == R_XTENSA_32_PCREL
7971
          || !howto->pc_relative)
7972
        continue;
7973
 
7974
      r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents,
7975
                    bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec));
7976
 
7977
      if (r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel) != sec)
7978
        continue;
7979
 
7980
      orig_self_offset = irel->r_offset;
7981
      orig_target_offset = r_rel.target_offset;
7982
 
7983
      self_offset = orig_self_offset;
7984
      target_offset = orig_target_offset;
7985
 
7986
      if (relax_info)
7987
        {
7988
          self_offset =
7989
            xlate_offset_with_removed_text (xmap, &relax_info->action_list,
7990
                                            orig_self_offset);
7991
          target_offset =
7992
            xlate_offset_with_removed_text (xmap, &relax_info->action_list,
7993
                                            orig_target_offset);
7994
        }
7995
 
7996
      self_removed_bytes = 0;
7997
      target_removed_bytes = 0;
7998
 
7999
      for (j = 0; j < constraint->action_count; ++j)
8000
        {
8001
          proposed_action *action = &constraint->actions[j];
8002
          bfd_vma offset = action->offset;
8003
          int removed_bytes = action->removed_bytes;
8004
          if (offset < orig_self_offset
8005
              || (offset == orig_self_offset && action->action == ta_fill
8006
                  && action->removed_bytes < 0))
8007
            self_removed_bytes += removed_bytes;
8008
          if (offset < orig_target_offset
8009
              || (offset == orig_target_offset && action->action == ta_fill
8010
                  && action->removed_bytes < 0))
8011
            target_removed_bytes += removed_bytes;
8012
        }
8013
      self_offset -= self_removed_bytes;
8014
      target_offset -= target_removed_bytes;
8015
 
8016
      /* Try to encode it.  Get the operand and check.  */
8017
      if (is_alt_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info)))
8018
        {
8019
          /* None of the current alternate relocs are PC-relative,
8020
             and only PC-relative relocs matter here.  */
8021
        }
8022
      else
8023
        {
8024
          xtensa_opcode opcode;
8025
          int opnum;
8026
 
8027
          if (reloc_opcodes)
8028
            opcode = reloc_opcodes[i];
8029
          else
8030
            opcode = get_relocation_opcode (abfd, sec, contents, irel);
8031
          if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
8032
            {
8033
              ok = FALSE;
8034
              break;
8035
            }
8036
 
8037
          opnum = get_relocation_opnd (opcode, ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info));
8038
          if (opnum == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
8039
            {
8040
              ok = FALSE;
8041
              break;
8042
            }
8043
 
8044
          if (!pcrel_reloc_fits (opcode, opnum, self_offset, target_offset))
8045
            {
8046
              ok = FALSE;
8047
              break;
8048
            }
8049
        }
8050
    }
8051
 
8052
  if (xmap)
8053
    free_xlate_map (xmap);
8054
 
8055
  return ok;
8056
}
8057
 
8058
 
8059
static bfd_boolean
8060
check_section_ebb_reduces (const ebb_constraint *constraint)
8061
{
8062
  int removed = 0;
8063
  unsigned i;
8064
 
8065
  for (i = 0; i < constraint->action_count; i++)
8066
    {
8067
      const proposed_action *action = &constraint->actions[i];
8068
      if (action->do_action)
8069
        removed += action->removed_bytes;
8070
    }
8071
  if (removed < 0)
8072
    return FALSE;
8073
 
8074
  return TRUE;
8075
}
8076
 
8077
 
8078
void
8079
text_action_add_proposed (text_action_list *l,
8080
                          const ebb_constraint *ebb_table,
8081
                          asection *sec)
8082
{
8083
  unsigned i;
8084
 
8085
  for (i = 0; i < ebb_table->action_count; i++)
8086
    {
8087
      proposed_action *action = &ebb_table->actions[i];
8088
 
8089
      if (!action->do_action)
8090
        continue;
8091
      switch (action->action)
8092
        {
8093
        case ta_remove_insn:
8094
        case ta_remove_longcall:
8095
        case ta_convert_longcall:
8096
        case ta_narrow_insn:
8097
        case ta_widen_insn:
8098
        case ta_fill:
8099
        case ta_remove_literal:
8100
          text_action_add (l, action->action, sec, action->offset,
8101
                           action->removed_bytes);
8102
          break;
8103
        case ta_none:
8104
          break;
8105
        default:
8106
          BFD_ASSERT (0);
8107
          break;
8108
        }
8109
    }
8110
}
8111
 
8112
 
8113
int
8114
compute_fill_extra_space (property_table_entry *entry)
8115
{
8116
  int fill_extra_space;
8117
 
8118
  if (!entry)
8119
    return 0;
8120
 
8121
  if ((entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE) == 0)
8122
    return 0;
8123
 
8124
  fill_extra_space = entry->size;
8125
  if ((entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN) != 0)
8126
    {
8127
      /* Fill bytes for alignment:
8128
         (2**n)-1 - (addr + (2**n)-1) & (2**n -1) */
8129
      int pow = GET_XTENSA_PROP_ALIGNMENT (entry->flags);
8130
      int nsm = (1 << pow) - 1;
8131
      bfd_vma addr = entry->address + entry->size;
8132
      bfd_vma align_fill = nsm - ((addr + nsm) & nsm);
8133
      fill_extra_space += align_fill;
8134
    }
8135
  return fill_extra_space;
8136
}
8137
 
8138
 
8139
/* First relaxation pass.  */
8140
 
8141
/* If the section contains relaxable literals, check each literal to
8142
   see if it has the same value as another literal that has already
8143
   been seen, either in the current section or a previous one.  If so,
8144
   add an entry to the per-section list of removed literals.  The
8145
   actual changes are deferred until the next pass.  */
8146
 
8147
static bfd_boolean
8148
compute_removed_literals (bfd *abfd,
8149
                          asection *sec,
8150
                          struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
8151
                          value_map_hash_table *values)
8152
{
8153
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
8154
  bfd_byte *contents;
8155
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
8156
  source_reloc *src_relocs, *rel;
8157
  bfd_boolean ok = TRUE;
8158
  property_table_entry *prop_table = NULL;
8159
  int ptblsize;
8160
  int i, prev_i;
8161
  bfd_boolean last_loc_is_prev = FALSE;
8162
  bfd_vma last_target_offset = 0;
8163
  section_cache_t target_sec_cache;
8164
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
8165
 
8166
  init_section_cache (&target_sec_cache);
8167
 
8168
  /* Do nothing if it is not a relaxable literal section.  */
8169
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
8170
  BFD_ASSERT (relax_info);
8171
  if (!relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section)
8172
    return ok;
8173
 
8174
  internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
8175
                                              link_info->keep_memory);
8176
 
8177
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
8178
  contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
8179
  if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
8180
    {
8181
      ok = FALSE;
8182
      goto error_return;
8183
    }
8184
 
8185
  /* Sort the source_relocs by target offset.  */
8186
  src_relocs = relax_info->src_relocs;
8187
  qsort (src_relocs, relax_info->src_count,
8188
         sizeof (source_reloc), source_reloc_compare);
8189
  qsort (internal_relocs, sec->reloc_count, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela),
8190
         internal_reloc_compare);
8191
 
8192
  ptblsize = xtensa_read_table_entries (abfd, sec, &prop_table,
8193
                                        XTENSA_PROP_SEC_NAME, FALSE);
8194
  if (ptblsize < 0)
8195
    {
8196
      ok = FALSE;
8197
      goto error_return;
8198
    }
8199
 
8200
  prev_i = -1;
8201
  for (i = 0; i < relax_info->src_count; i++)
8202
    {
8203
      Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = NULL;
8204
 
8205
      rel = &src_relocs[i];
8206
      if (get_l32r_opcode () != rel->opcode)
8207
        continue;
8208
      irel = get_irel_at_offset (sec, internal_relocs,
8209
                                 rel->r_rel.target_offset);
8210
 
8211
      /* If the relocation on this is not a simple R_XTENSA_32 or
8212
         R_XTENSA_PLT then do not consider it.  This may happen when
8213
         the difference of two symbols is used in a literal.  */
8214
      if (irel && (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_32
8215
                   && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_PLT))
8216
        continue;
8217
 
8218
      /* If the target_offset for this relocation is the same as the
8219
         previous relocation, then we've already considered whether the
8220
         literal can be coalesced.  Skip to the next one....  */
8221
      if (i != 0 && prev_i != -1
8222
          && src_relocs[i-1].r_rel.target_offset == rel->r_rel.target_offset)
8223
        continue;
8224
      prev_i = i;
8225
 
8226
      if (last_loc_is_prev &&
8227
          last_target_offset + 4 != rel->r_rel.target_offset)
8228
        last_loc_is_prev = FALSE;
8229
 
8230
      /* Check if the relocation was from an L32R that is being removed
8231
         because a CALLX was converted to a direct CALL, and check if
8232
         there are no other relocations to the literal.  */
8233
      if (is_removable_literal (rel, i, src_relocs, relax_info->src_count,
8234
                                sec, prop_table, ptblsize))
8235
        {
8236
          if (!remove_dead_literal (abfd, sec, link_info, internal_relocs,
8237
                                    irel, rel, prop_table, ptblsize))
8238
            {
8239
              ok = FALSE;
8240
              goto error_return;
8241
            }
8242
          last_target_offset = rel->r_rel.target_offset;
8243
          continue;
8244
        }
8245
 
8246
      if (!identify_literal_placement (abfd, sec, contents, link_info,
8247
                                       values,
8248
                                       &last_loc_is_prev, irel,
8249
                                       relax_info->src_count - i, rel,
8250
                                       prop_table, ptblsize,
8251
                                       &target_sec_cache, rel->is_abs_literal))
8252
        {
8253
          ok = FALSE;
8254
          goto error_return;
8255
        }
8256
      last_target_offset = rel->r_rel.target_offset;
8257
    }
8258
 
8259
#if DEBUG
8260
  print_removed_literals (stderr, &relax_info->removed_list);
8261
  print_action_list (stderr, &relax_info->action_list);
8262
#endif /* DEBUG */
8263
 
8264
error_return:
8265
  if (prop_table) free (prop_table);
8266
  clear_section_cache (&target_sec_cache);
8267
 
8268
  release_contents (sec, contents);
8269
  release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
8270
  return ok;
8271
}
8272
 
8273
 
8274
static Elf_Internal_Rela *
8275
get_irel_at_offset (asection *sec,
8276
                    Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs,
8277
                    bfd_vma offset)
8278
{
8279
  unsigned i;
8280
  Elf_Internal_Rela *irel;
8281
  unsigned r_type;
8282
  Elf_Internal_Rela key;
8283
 
8284
  if (!internal_relocs)
8285
    return NULL;
8286
 
8287
  key.r_offset = offset;
8288
  irel = bsearch (&key, internal_relocs, sec->reloc_count,
8289
                  sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela), internal_reloc_matches);
8290
  if (!irel)
8291
    return NULL;
8292
 
8293
  /* bsearch does not guarantee which will be returned if there are
8294
     multiple matches.  We need the first that is not an alignment.  */
8295
  i = irel - internal_relocs;
8296
  while (i > 0)
8297
    {
8298
      if (internal_relocs[i-1].r_offset != offset)
8299
        break;
8300
      i--;
8301
    }
8302
  for ( ; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
8303
    {
8304
      irel = &internal_relocs[i];
8305
      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
8306
      if (irel->r_offset == offset && r_type != R_XTENSA_NONE)
8307
        return irel;
8308
    }
8309
 
8310
  return NULL;
8311
}
8312
 
8313
 
8314
bfd_boolean
8315
is_removable_literal (const source_reloc *rel,
8316
                      int i,
8317
                      const source_reloc *src_relocs,
8318
                      int src_count,
8319
                      asection *sec,
8320
                      property_table_entry *prop_table,
8321
                      int ptblsize)
8322
{
8323
  const source_reloc *curr_rel;
8324
  property_table_entry *entry;
8325
 
8326
  if (!rel->is_null)
8327
    return FALSE;
8328
 
8329
  entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (prop_table, ptblsize,
8330
                                          sec->vma + rel->r_rel.target_offset);
8331
  if (entry && (entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM))
8332
    return FALSE;
8333
 
8334
  for (++i; i < src_count; ++i)
8335
    {
8336
      curr_rel = &src_relocs[i];
8337
      /* If all others have the same target offset....  */
8338
      if (curr_rel->r_rel.target_offset != rel->r_rel.target_offset)
8339
        return TRUE;
8340
 
8341
      if (!curr_rel->is_null
8342
          && !xtensa_is_property_section (curr_rel->source_sec)
8343
          && !(curr_rel->source_sec->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
8344
        return FALSE;
8345
    }
8346
  return TRUE;
8347
}
8348
 
8349
 
8350
bfd_boolean
8351
remove_dead_literal (bfd *abfd,
8352
                     asection *sec,
8353
                     struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
8354
                     Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs,
8355
                     Elf_Internal_Rela *irel,
8356
                     source_reloc *rel,
8357
                     property_table_entry *prop_table,
8358
                     int ptblsize)
8359
{
8360
  property_table_entry *entry;
8361
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
8362
 
8363
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
8364
  if (!relax_info)
8365
    return FALSE;
8366
 
8367
  entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (prop_table, ptblsize,
8368
                                          sec->vma + rel->r_rel.target_offset);
8369
 
8370
  /* Mark the unused literal so that it will be removed.  */
8371
  add_removed_literal (&relax_info->removed_list, &rel->r_rel, NULL);
8372
 
8373
  text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
8374
                   ta_remove_literal, sec, rel->r_rel.target_offset, 4);
8375
 
8376
  /* If the section is 4-byte aligned, do not add fill.  */
8377
  if (sec->alignment_power > 2)
8378
    {
8379
      int fill_extra_space;
8380
      bfd_vma entry_sec_offset;
8381
      text_action *fa;
8382
      property_table_entry *the_add_entry;
8383
      int removed_diff;
8384
 
8385
      if (entry)
8386
        entry_sec_offset = entry->address - sec->vma + entry->size;
8387
      else
8388
        entry_sec_offset = rel->r_rel.target_offset + 4;
8389
 
8390
      /* If the literal range is at the end of the section,
8391
         do not add fill.  */
8392
      the_add_entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (prop_table, ptblsize,
8393
                                                      entry_sec_offset);
8394
      fill_extra_space = compute_fill_extra_space (the_add_entry);
8395
 
8396
      fa = find_fill_action (&relax_info->action_list, sec, entry_sec_offset);
8397
      removed_diff = compute_removed_action_diff (fa, sec, entry_sec_offset,
8398
                                                  -4, fill_extra_space);
8399
      if (fa)
8400
        adjust_fill_action (fa, removed_diff);
8401
      else
8402
        text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
8403
                         ta_fill, sec, entry_sec_offset, removed_diff);
8404
    }
8405
 
8406
  /* Zero out the relocation on this literal location.  */
8407
  if (irel)
8408
    {
8409
      if (elf_hash_table (link_info)->dynamic_sections_created)
8410
        shrink_dynamic_reloc_sections (link_info, abfd, sec, irel);
8411
 
8412
      irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_NONE);
8413
      pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
8414
    }
8415
 
8416
  /* Do not modify "last_loc_is_prev".  */
8417
  return TRUE;
8418
}
8419
 
8420
 
8421
bfd_boolean
8422
identify_literal_placement (bfd *abfd,
8423
                            asection *sec,
8424
                            bfd_byte *contents,
8425
                            struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
8426
                            value_map_hash_table *values,
8427
                            bfd_boolean *last_loc_is_prev_p,
8428
                            Elf_Internal_Rela *irel,
8429
                            int remaining_src_rels,
8430
                            source_reloc *rel,
8431
                            property_table_entry *prop_table,
8432
                            int ptblsize,
8433
                            section_cache_t *target_sec_cache,
8434
                            bfd_boolean is_abs_literal)
8435
{
8436
  literal_value val;
8437
  value_map *val_map;
8438
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
8439
  bfd_boolean literal_placed = FALSE;
8440
  r_reloc r_rel;
8441
  unsigned long value;
8442
  bfd_boolean final_static_link;
8443
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
8444
 
8445
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
8446
  if (!relax_info)
8447
    return FALSE;
8448
 
8449
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
8450
 
8451
  final_static_link =
8452
    (!link_info->relocatable
8453
     && !elf_hash_table (link_info)->dynamic_sections_created);
8454
 
8455
  /* The placement algorithm first checks to see if the literal is
8456
     already in the value map.  If so and the value map is reachable
8457
     from all uses, then the literal is moved to that location.  If
8458
     not, then we identify the last location where a fresh literal was
8459
     placed.  If the literal can be safely moved there, then we do so.
8460
     If not, then we assume that the literal is not to move and leave
8461
     the literal where it is, marking it as the last literal
8462
     location.  */
8463
 
8464
  /* Find the literal value.  */
8465
  value = 0;
8466
  r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents, sec_size);
8467
  if (!irel)
8468
    {
8469
      BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_rel.target_offset < sec_size);
8470
      value = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + rel->r_rel.target_offset);
8471
    }
8472
  init_literal_value (&val, &r_rel, value, is_abs_literal);
8473
 
8474
  /* Check if we've seen another literal with the same value that
8475
     is in the same output section.  */
8476
  val_map = value_map_get_cached_value (values, &val, final_static_link);
8477
 
8478
  if (val_map
8479
      && (r_reloc_get_section (&val_map->loc)->output_section
8480
          == sec->output_section)
8481
      && relocations_reach (rel, remaining_src_rels, &val_map->loc)
8482
      && coalesce_shared_literal (sec, rel, prop_table, ptblsize, val_map))
8483
    {
8484
      /* No change to last_loc_is_prev.  */
8485
      literal_placed = TRUE;
8486
    }
8487
 
8488
  /* For relocatable links, do not try to move literals.  To do it
8489
     correctly might increase the number of relocations in an input
8490
     section making the default relocatable linking fail.  */
8491
  if (!link_info->relocatable && !literal_placed
8492
      && values->has_last_loc && !(*last_loc_is_prev_p))
8493
    {
8494
      asection *target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&values->last_loc);
8495
      if (target_sec && target_sec->output_section == sec->output_section)
8496
        {
8497
          /* Increment the virtual offset.  */
8498
          r_reloc try_loc = values->last_loc;
8499
          try_loc.virtual_offset += 4;
8500
 
8501
          /* There is a last loc that was in the same output section.  */
8502
          if (relocations_reach (rel, remaining_src_rels, &try_loc)
8503
              && move_shared_literal (sec, link_info, rel,
8504
                                      prop_table, ptblsize,
8505
                                      &try_loc, &val, target_sec_cache))
8506
            {
8507
              values->last_loc.virtual_offset += 4;
8508
              literal_placed = TRUE;
8509
              if (!val_map)
8510
                val_map = add_value_map (values, &val, &try_loc,
8511
                                         final_static_link);
8512
              else
8513
                val_map->loc = try_loc;
8514
            }
8515
        }
8516
    }
8517
 
8518
  if (!literal_placed)
8519
    {
8520
      /* Nothing worked, leave the literal alone but update the last loc.  */
8521
      values->has_last_loc = TRUE;
8522
      values->last_loc = rel->r_rel;
8523
      if (!val_map)
8524
        val_map = add_value_map (values, &val, &rel->r_rel, final_static_link);
8525
      else
8526
        val_map->loc = rel->r_rel;
8527
      *last_loc_is_prev_p = TRUE;
8528
    }
8529
 
8530
  return TRUE;
8531
}
8532
 
8533
 
8534
/* Check if the original relocations (presumably on L32R instructions)
8535
   identified by reloc[0..N] can be changed to reference the literal
8536
   identified by r_rel.  If r_rel is out of range for any of the
8537
   original relocations, then we don't want to coalesce the original
8538
   literal with the one at r_rel.  We only check reloc[0..N], where the
8539
   offsets are all the same as for reloc[0] (i.e., they're all
8540
   referencing the same literal) and where N is also bounded by the
8541
   number of remaining entries in the "reloc" array.  The "reloc" array
8542
   is sorted by target offset so we know all the entries for the same
8543
   literal will be contiguous.  */
8544
 
8545
static bfd_boolean
8546
relocations_reach (source_reloc *reloc,
8547
                   int remaining_relocs,
8548
                   const r_reloc *r_rel)
8549
{
8550
  bfd_vma from_offset, source_address, dest_address;
8551
  asection *sec;
8552
  int i;
8553
 
8554
  if (!r_reloc_is_defined (r_rel))
8555
    return FALSE;
8556
 
8557
  sec = r_reloc_get_section (r_rel);
8558
  from_offset = reloc[0].r_rel.target_offset;
8559
 
8560
  for (i = 0; i < remaining_relocs; i++)
8561
    {
8562
      if (reloc[i].r_rel.target_offset != from_offset)
8563
        break;
8564
 
8565
      /* Ignore relocations that have been removed.  */
8566
      if (reloc[i].is_null)
8567
        continue;
8568
 
8569
      /* The original and new output section for these must be the same
8570
         in order to coalesce.  */
8571
      if (r_reloc_get_section (&reloc[i].r_rel)->output_section
8572
          != sec->output_section)
8573
        return FALSE;
8574
 
8575
      /* Absolute literals in the same output section can always be
8576
         combined.  */
8577
      if (reloc[i].is_abs_literal)
8578
        continue;
8579
 
8580
      /* A literal with no PC-relative relocations can be moved anywhere.  */
8581
      if (reloc[i].opnd != -1)
8582
        {
8583
          /* Otherwise, check to see that it fits.  */
8584
          source_address = (reloc[i].source_sec->output_section->vma
8585
                            + reloc[i].source_sec->output_offset
8586
                            + reloc[i].r_rel.rela.r_offset);
8587
          dest_address = (sec->output_section->vma
8588
                          + sec->output_offset
8589
                          + r_rel->target_offset);
8590
 
8591
          if (!pcrel_reloc_fits (reloc[i].opcode, reloc[i].opnd,
8592
                                 source_address, dest_address))
8593
            return FALSE;
8594
        }
8595
    }
8596
 
8597
  return TRUE;
8598
}
8599
 
8600
 
8601
/* Move a literal to another literal location because it is
8602
   the same as the other literal value.  */
8603
 
8604
static bfd_boolean
8605
coalesce_shared_literal (asection *sec,
8606
                         source_reloc *rel,
8607
                         property_table_entry *prop_table,
8608
                         int ptblsize,
8609
                         value_map *val_map)
8610
{
8611
  property_table_entry *entry;
8612
  text_action *fa;
8613
  property_table_entry *the_add_entry;
8614
  int removed_diff;
8615
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
8616
 
8617
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
8618
  if (!relax_info)
8619
    return FALSE;
8620
 
8621
  entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry
8622
    (prop_table, ptblsize, sec->vma + rel->r_rel.target_offset);
8623
  if (entry && (entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM))
8624
    return TRUE;
8625
 
8626
  /* Mark that the literal will be coalesced.  */
8627
  add_removed_literal (&relax_info->removed_list, &rel->r_rel, &val_map->loc);
8628
 
8629
  text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
8630
                   ta_remove_literal, sec, rel->r_rel.target_offset, 4);
8631
 
8632
  /* If the section is 4-byte aligned, do not add fill.  */
8633
  if (sec->alignment_power > 2)
8634
    {
8635
      int fill_extra_space;
8636
      bfd_vma entry_sec_offset;
8637
 
8638
      if (entry)
8639
        entry_sec_offset = entry->address - sec->vma + entry->size;
8640
      else
8641
        entry_sec_offset = rel->r_rel.target_offset + 4;
8642
 
8643
      /* If the literal range is at the end of the section,
8644
         do not add fill.  */
8645
      fill_extra_space = 0;
8646
      the_add_entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (prop_table, ptblsize,
8647
                                                      entry_sec_offset);
8648
      if (the_add_entry && (the_add_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE))
8649
        fill_extra_space = the_add_entry->size;
8650
 
8651
      fa = find_fill_action (&relax_info->action_list, sec, entry_sec_offset);
8652
      removed_diff = compute_removed_action_diff (fa, sec, entry_sec_offset,
8653
                                                  -4, fill_extra_space);
8654
      if (fa)
8655
        adjust_fill_action (fa, removed_diff);
8656
      else
8657
        text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
8658
                         ta_fill, sec, entry_sec_offset, removed_diff);
8659
    }
8660
 
8661
  return TRUE;
8662
}
8663
 
8664
 
8665
/* Move a literal to another location.  This may actually increase the
8666
   total amount of space used because of alignments so we need to do
8667
   this carefully.  Also, it may make a branch go out of range.  */
8668
 
8669
static bfd_boolean
8670
move_shared_literal (asection *sec,
8671
                     struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
8672
                     source_reloc *rel,
8673
                     property_table_entry *prop_table,
8674
                     int ptblsize,
8675
                     const r_reloc *target_loc,
8676
                     const literal_value *lit_value,
8677
                     section_cache_t *target_sec_cache)
8678
{
8679
  property_table_entry *the_add_entry, *src_entry, *target_entry = NULL;
8680
  text_action *fa, *target_fa;
8681
  int removed_diff;
8682
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info, *target_relax_info;
8683
  asection *target_sec;
8684
  ebb_t *ebb;
8685
  ebb_constraint ebb_table;
8686
  bfd_boolean relocs_fit;
8687
 
8688
  /* If this routine always returns FALSE, the literals that cannot be
8689
     coalesced will not be moved.  */
8690
  if (elf32xtensa_no_literal_movement)
8691
    return FALSE;
8692
 
8693
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
8694
  if (!relax_info)
8695
    return FALSE;
8696
 
8697
  target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (target_loc);
8698
  target_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (target_sec);
8699
 
8700
  /* Literals to undefined sections may not be moved because they
8701
     must report an error.  */
8702
  if (bfd_is_und_section (target_sec))
8703
    return FALSE;
8704
 
8705
  src_entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry
8706
    (prop_table, ptblsize, sec->vma + rel->r_rel.target_offset);
8707
 
8708
  if (!section_cache_section (target_sec_cache, target_sec, link_info))
8709
    return FALSE;
8710
 
8711
  target_entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry
8712
    (target_sec_cache->ptbl, target_sec_cache->pte_count,
8713
     target_sec->vma + target_loc->target_offset);
8714
 
8715
  if (!target_entry)
8716
    return FALSE;
8717
 
8718
  /* Make sure that we have not broken any branches.  */
8719
  relocs_fit = FALSE;
8720
 
8721
  init_ebb_constraint (&ebb_table);
8722
  ebb = &ebb_table.ebb;
8723
  init_ebb (ebb, target_sec_cache->sec, target_sec_cache->contents,
8724
            target_sec_cache->content_length,
8725
            target_sec_cache->ptbl, target_sec_cache->pte_count,
8726
            target_sec_cache->relocs, target_sec_cache->reloc_count);
8727
 
8728
  /* Propose to add 4 bytes + worst-case alignment size increase to
8729
     destination.  */
8730
  ebb_propose_action (&ebb_table, EBB_NO_ALIGN, 0,
8731
                      ta_fill, target_loc->target_offset,
8732
                      -4 - (1 << target_sec->alignment_power), TRUE);
8733
 
8734
  /* Check all of the PC-relative relocations to make sure they still fit.  */
8735
  relocs_fit = check_section_ebb_pcrels_fit (target_sec->owner, target_sec,
8736
                                             target_sec_cache->contents,
8737
                                             target_sec_cache->relocs,
8738
                                             &ebb_table, NULL);
8739
 
8740
  if (!relocs_fit)
8741
    return FALSE;
8742
 
8743
  text_action_add_literal (&target_relax_info->action_list,
8744
                           ta_add_literal, target_loc, lit_value, -4);
8745
 
8746
  if (target_sec->alignment_power > 2 && target_entry != src_entry)
8747
    {
8748
      /* May need to add or remove some fill to maintain alignment.  */
8749
      int fill_extra_space;
8750
      bfd_vma entry_sec_offset;
8751
 
8752
      entry_sec_offset =
8753
        target_entry->address - target_sec->vma + target_entry->size;
8754
 
8755
      /* If the literal range is at the end of the section,
8756
         do not add fill.  */
8757
      fill_extra_space = 0;
8758
      the_add_entry =
8759
        elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (target_sec_cache->ptbl,
8760
                                        target_sec_cache->pte_count,
8761
                                        entry_sec_offset);
8762
      if (the_add_entry && (the_add_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE))
8763
        fill_extra_space = the_add_entry->size;
8764
 
8765
      target_fa = find_fill_action (&target_relax_info->action_list,
8766
                                    target_sec, entry_sec_offset);
8767
      removed_diff = compute_removed_action_diff (target_fa, target_sec,
8768
                                                  entry_sec_offset, 4,
8769
                                                  fill_extra_space);
8770
      if (target_fa)
8771
        adjust_fill_action (target_fa, removed_diff);
8772
      else
8773
        text_action_add (&target_relax_info->action_list,
8774
                         ta_fill, target_sec, entry_sec_offset, removed_diff);
8775
    }
8776
 
8777
  /* Mark that the literal will be moved to the new location.  */
8778
  add_removed_literal (&relax_info->removed_list, &rel->r_rel, target_loc);
8779
 
8780
  /* Remove the literal.  */
8781
  text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
8782
                   ta_remove_literal, sec, rel->r_rel.target_offset, 4);
8783
 
8784
  /* If the section is 4-byte aligned, do not add fill.  */
8785
  if (sec->alignment_power > 2 && target_entry != src_entry)
8786
    {
8787
      int fill_extra_space;
8788
      bfd_vma entry_sec_offset;
8789
 
8790
      if (src_entry)
8791
        entry_sec_offset = src_entry->address - sec->vma + src_entry->size;
8792
      else
8793
        entry_sec_offset = rel->r_rel.target_offset+4;
8794
 
8795
      /* If the literal range is at the end of the section,
8796
         do not add fill.  */
8797
      fill_extra_space = 0;
8798
      the_add_entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (prop_table, ptblsize,
8799
                                                      entry_sec_offset);
8800
      if (the_add_entry && (the_add_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE))
8801
        fill_extra_space = the_add_entry->size;
8802
 
8803
      fa = find_fill_action (&relax_info->action_list, sec, entry_sec_offset);
8804
      removed_diff = compute_removed_action_diff (fa, sec, entry_sec_offset,
8805
                                                  -4, fill_extra_space);
8806
      if (fa)
8807
        adjust_fill_action (fa, removed_diff);
8808
      else
8809
        text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
8810
                         ta_fill, sec, entry_sec_offset, removed_diff);
8811
    }
8812
 
8813
  return TRUE;
8814
}
8815
 
8816
 
8817
/* Second relaxation pass.  */
8818
 
8819
/* Modify all of the relocations to point to the right spot, and if this
8820
   is a relaxable section, delete the unwanted literals and fix the
8821
   section size.  */
8822
 
8823
bfd_boolean
8824
relax_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
8825
{
8826
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
8827
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
8828
  bfd_byte *contents;
8829
  bfd_boolean ok = TRUE;
8830
  unsigned i;
8831
  bfd_boolean rv = FALSE;
8832
  bfd_boolean virtual_action;
8833
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
8834
 
8835
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
8836
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
8837
  BFD_ASSERT (relax_info);
8838
 
8839
  /* First translate any of the fixes that have been added already.  */
8840
  translate_section_fixes (sec);
8841
 
8842
  /* Handle property sections (e.g., literal tables) specially.  */
8843
  if (xtensa_is_property_section (sec))
8844
    {
8845
      BFD_ASSERT (!relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section);
8846
      return relax_property_section (abfd, sec, link_info);
8847
    }
8848
 
8849
  internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
8850
                                              link_info->keep_memory);
8851
  contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
8852
  if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
8853
    {
8854
      ok = FALSE;
8855
      goto error_return;
8856
    }
8857
 
8858
  if (internal_relocs)
8859
    {
8860
      for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
8861
        {
8862
          Elf_Internal_Rela *irel;
8863
          xtensa_relax_info *target_relax_info;
8864
          bfd_vma source_offset, old_source_offset;
8865
          r_reloc r_rel;
8866
          unsigned r_type;
8867
          asection *target_sec;
8868
 
8869
          /* Locally change the source address.
8870
             Translate the target to the new target address.
8871
             If it points to this section and has been removed,
8872
             NULLify it.
8873
             Write it back.  */
8874
 
8875
          irel = &internal_relocs[i];
8876
          source_offset = irel->r_offset;
8877
          old_source_offset = source_offset;
8878
 
8879
          r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
8880
          r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents,
8881
                        bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec));
8882
 
8883
          /* If this section could have changed then we may need to
8884
             change the relocation's offset.  */
8885
 
8886
          if (relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
8887
              || relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section)
8888
            {
8889
              pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
8890
 
8891
              if (r_type != R_XTENSA_NONE
8892
                  && find_removed_literal (&relax_info->removed_list,
8893
                                           irel->r_offset))
8894
                {
8895
                  /* Remove this relocation.  */
8896
                  if (elf_hash_table (link_info)->dynamic_sections_created)
8897
                    shrink_dynamic_reloc_sections (link_info, abfd, sec, irel);
8898
                  irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_NONE);
8899
                  irel->r_offset = offset_with_removed_text
8900
                    (&relax_info->action_list, irel->r_offset);
8901
                  continue;
8902
                }
8903
 
8904
              if (r_type == R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY)
8905
                {
8906
                  text_action *action =
8907
                    find_insn_action (&relax_info->action_list,
8908
                                      irel->r_offset);
8909
                  if (action && (action->action == ta_convert_longcall
8910
                                 || action->action == ta_remove_longcall))
8911
                    {
8912
                      bfd_reloc_status_type retval;
8913
                      char *error_message = NULL;
8914
 
8915
                      retval = contract_asm_expansion (contents, sec_size,
8916
                                                       irel, &error_message);
8917
                      if (retval != bfd_reloc_ok)
8918
                        {
8919
                          (*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
8920
                            (link_info, error_message, abfd, sec,
8921
                             irel->r_offset);
8922
                          goto error_return;
8923
                        }
8924
                      /* Update the action so that the code that moves
8925
                         the contents will do the right thing.  */
8926
                      if (action->action == ta_remove_longcall)
8927
                        action->action = ta_remove_insn;
8928
                      else
8929
                        action->action = ta_none;
8930
                      /* Refresh the info in the r_rel.  */
8931
                      r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents, sec_size);
8932
                      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
8933
                    }
8934
                }
8935
 
8936
              source_offset = offset_with_removed_text
8937
                (&relax_info->action_list, irel->r_offset);
8938
              irel->r_offset = source_offset;
8939
            }
8940
 
8941
          /* If the target section could have changed then
8942
             we may need to change the relocation's target offset.  */
8943
 
8944
          target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel);
8945
 
8946
          /* For a reference to a discarded section from a DWARF section,
8947
             i.e., where action_discarded is PRETEND, the symbol will
8948
             eventually be modified to refer to the kept section (at least if
8949
             the kept and discarded sections are the same size).  Anticipate
8950
             that here and adjust things accordingly.  */
8951
          if (! elf_xtensa_ignore_discarded_relocs (sec)
8952
              && elf_xtensa_action_discarded (sec) == PRETEND
8953
              && sec->sec_info_type != ELF_INFO_TYPE_STABS
8954
              && target_sec != NULL
8955
              && elf_discarded_section (target_sec))
8956
            {
8957
              /* It would be natural to call _bfd_elf_check_kept_section
8958
                 here, but it's not exported from elflink.c.  It's also a
8959
                 fairly expensive check.  Adjusting the relocations to the
8960
                 discarded section is fairly harmless; it will only adjust
8961
                 some addends and difference values.  If it turns out that
8962
                 _bfd_elf_check_kept_section fails later, it won't matter,
8963
                 so just compare the section names to find the right group
8964
                 member.  */
8965
              asection *kept = target_sec->kept_section;
8966
              if (kept != NULL)
8967
                {
8968
                  if ((kept->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
8969
                    {
8970
                      asection *first = elf_next_in_group (kept);
8971
                      asection *s = first;
8972
 
8973
                      kept = NULL;
8974
                      while (s != NULL)
8975
                        {
8976
                          if (strcmp (s->name, target_sec->name) == 0)
8977
                            {
8978
                              kept = s;
8979
                              break;
8980
                            }
8981
                          s = elf_next_in_group (s);
8982
                          if (s == first)
8983
                            break;
8984
                        }
8985
                    }
8986
                }
8987
              if (kept != NULL
8988
                  && ((target_sec->rawsize != 0
8989
                       ? target_sec->rawsize : target_sec->size)
8990
                      == (kept->rawsize != 0 ? kept->rawsize : kept->size)))
8991
                target_sec = kept;
8992
            }
8993
 
8994
          target_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (target_sec);
8995
          if (target_relax_info
8996
              && (target_relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
8997
                  || target_relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section))
8998
            {
8999
              r_reloc new_reloc;
9000
              target_sec = translate_reloc (&r_rel, &new_reloc, target_sec);
9001
 
9002
              if (r_type == R_XTENSA_DIFF8
9003
                  || r_type == R_XTENSA_DIFF16
9004
                  || r_type == R_XTENSA_DIFF32)
9005
                {
9006
                  bfd_vma diff_value = 0, new_end_offset, diff_mask = 0;
9007
 
9008
                  if (bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec) < old_source_offset)
9009
                    {
9010
                      (*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
9011
                        (link_info, _("invalid relocation address"),
9012
                         abfd, sec, old_source_offset);
9013
                      goto error_return;
9014
                    }
9015
 
9016
                  switch (r_type)
9017
                    {
9018
                    case R_XTENSA_DIFF8:
9019
                      diff_value =
9020
                        bfd_get_8 (abfd, &contents[old_source_offset]);
9021
                      break;
9022
                    case R_XTENSA_DIFF16:
9023
                      diff_value =
9024
                        bfd_get_16 (abfd, &contents[old_source_offset]);
9025
                      break;
9026
                    case R_XTENSA_DIFF32:
9027
                      diff_value =
9028
                        bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[old_source_offset]);
9029
                      break;
9030
                    }
9031
 
9032
                  new_end_offset = offset_with_removed_text
9033
                    (&target_relax_info->action_list,
9034
                     r_rel.target_offset + diff_value);
9035
                  diff_value = new_end_offset - new_reloc.target_offset;
9036
 
9037
                  switch (r_type)
9038
                    {
9039
                    case R_XTENSA_DIFF8:
9040
                      diff_mask = 0xff;
9041
                      bfd_put_8 (abfd, diff_value,
9042
                                 &contents[old_source_offset]);
9043
                      break;
9044
                    case R_XTENSA_DIFF16:
9045
                      diff_mask = 0xffff;
9046
                      bfd_put_16 (abfd, diff_value,
9047
                                  &contents[old_source_offset]);
9048
                      break;
9049
                    case R_XTENSA_DIFF32:
9050
                      diff_mask = 0xffffffff;
9051
                      bfd_put_32 (abfd, diff_value,
9052
                                  &contents[old_source_offset]);
9053
                      break;
9054
                    }
9055
 
9056
                  /* Check for overflow.  */
9057
                  if ((diff_value & ~diff_mask) != 0)
9058
                    {
9059
                      (*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
9060
                        (link_info, _("overflow after relaxation"),
9061
                         abfd, sec, old_source_offset);
9062
                      goto error_return;
9063
                    }
9064
 
9065
                  pin_contents (sec, contents);
9066
                }
9067
 
9068
              /* If the relocation still references a section in the same
9069
                 input file, modify the relocation directly instead of
9070
                 adding a "fix" record.  */
9071
              if (target_sec->owner == abfd)
9072
                {
9073
                  unsigned r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (new_reloc.rela.r_info);
9074
                  irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
9075
                  irel->r_addend = new_reloc.rela.r_addend;
9076
                  pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
9077
                }
9078
              else
9079
                {
9080
                  bfd_vma addend_displacement;
9081
                  reloc_bfd_fix *fix;
9082
 
9083
                  addend_displacement =
9084
                    new_reloc.target_offset + new_reloc.virtual_offset;
9085
                  fix = reloc_bfd_fix_init (sec, source_offset, r_type,
9086
                                            target_sec,
9087
                                            addend_displacement, TRUE);
9088
                  add_fix (sec, fix);
9089
                }
9090
            }
9091
        }
9092
    }
9093
 
9094
  if ((relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
9095
       || relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section)
9096
      && relax_info->action_list.head)
9097
    {
9098
      /* Walk through the planned actions and build up a table
9099
         of move, copy and fill records.  Use the move, copy and
9100
         fill records to perform the actions once.  */
9101
 
9102
      int removed = 0;
9103
      bfd_size_type final_size, copy_size, orig_insn_size;
9104
      bfd_byte *scratch = NULL;
9105
      bfd_byte *dup_contents = NULL;
9106
      bfd_size_type orig_size = sec->size;
9107
      bfd_vma orig_dot = 0;
9108
      bfd_vma orig_dot_copied = 0; /* Byte copied already from
9109
                                            orig dot in physical memory.  */
9110
      bfd_vma orig_dot_vo = 0; /* Virtual offset from orig_dot.  */
9111
      bfd_vma dup_dot = 0;
9112
 
9113
      text_action *action = relax_info->action_list.head;
9114
 
9115
      final_size = sec->size;
9116
      for (action = relax_info->action_list.head; action;
9117
           action = action->next)
9118
        {
9119
          final_size -= action->removed_bytes;
9120
        }
9121
 
9122
      scratch = (bfd_byte *) bfd_zmalloc (final_size);
9123
      dup_contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_zmalloc (final_size);
9124
 
9125
      /* The dot is the current fill location.  */
9126
#if DEBUG
9127
      print_action_list (stderr, &relax_info->action_list);
9128
#endif
9129
 
9130
      for (action = relax_info->action_list.head; action;
9131
           action = action->next)
9132
        {
9133
          virtual_action = FALSE;
9134
          if (action->offset > orig_dot)
9135
            {
9136
              orig_dot += orig_dot_copied;
9137
              orig_dot_copied = 0;
9138
              orig_dot_vo = 0;
9139
              /* Out of the virtual world.  */
9140
            }
9141
 
9142
          if (action->offset > orig_dot)
9143
            {
9144
              copy_size = action->offset - orig_dot;
9145
              memmove (&dup_contents[dup_dot], &contents[orig_dot], copy_size);
9146
              orig_dot += copy_size;
9147
              dup_dot += copy_size;
9148
              BFD_ASSERT (action->offset == orig_dot);
9149
            }
9150
          else if (action->offset < orig_dot)
9151
            {
9152
              if (action->action == ta_fill
9153
                  && action->offset - action->removed_bytes == orig_dot)
9154
                {
9155
                  /* This is OK because the fill only effects the dup_dot.  */
9156
                }
9157
              else if (action->action == ta_add_literal)
9158
                {
9159
                  /* TBD.  Might need to handle this.  */
9160
                }
9161
            }
9162
          if (action->offset == orig_dot)
9163
            {
9164
              if (action->virtual_offset > orig_dot_vo)
9165
                {
9166
                  if (orig_dot_vo == 0)
9167
                    {
9168
                      /* Need to copy virtual_offset bytes.  Probably four.  */
9169
                      copy_size = action->virtual_offset - orig_dot_vo;
9170
                      memmove (&dup_contents[dup_dot],
9171
                               &contents[orig_dot], copy_size);
9172
                      orig_dot_copied = copy_size;
9173
                      dup_dot += copy_size;
9174
                    }
9175
                  virtual_action = TRUE;
9176
                }
9177
              else
9178
                BFD_ASSERT (action->virtual_offset <= orig_dot_vo);
9179
            }
9180
          switch (action->action)
9181
            {
9182
            case ta_remove_literal:
9183
            case ta_remove_insn:
9184
              BFD_ASSERT (action->removed_bytes >= 0);
9185
              orig_dot += action->removed_bytes;
9186
              break;
9187
 
9188
            case ta_narrow_insn:
9189
              orig_insn_size = 3;
9190
              copy_size = 2;
9191
              memmove (scratch, &contents[orig_dot], orig_insn_size);
9192
              BFD_ASSERT (action->removed_bytes == 1);
9193
              rv = narrow_instruction (scratch, final_size, 0);
9194
              BFD_ASSERT (rv);
9195
              memmove (&dup_contents[dup_dot], scratch, copy_size);
9196
              orig_dot += orig_insn_size;
9197
              dup_dot += copy_size;
9198
              break;
9199
 
9200
            case ta_fill:
9201
              if (action->removed_bytes >= 0)
9202
                orig_dot += action->removed_bytes;
9203
              else
9204
                {
9205
                  /* Already zeroed in dup_contents.  Just bump the
9206
                     counters.  */
9207
                  dup_dot += (-action->removed_bytes);
9208
                }
9209
              break;
9210
 
9211
            case ta_none:
9212
              BFD_ASSERT (action->removed_bytes == 0);
9213
              break;
9214
 
9215
            case ta_convert_longcall:
9216
            case ta_remove_longcall:
9217
              /* These will be removed or converted before we get here.  */
9218
              BFD_ASSERT (0);
9219
              break;
9220
 
9221
            case ta_widen_insn:
9222
              orig_insn_size = 2;
9223
              copy_size = 3;
9224
              memmove (scratch, &contents[orig_dot], orig_insn_size);
9225
              BFD_ASSERT (action->removed_bytes == -1);
9226
              rv = widen_instruction (scratch, final_size, 0);
9227
              BFD_ASSERT (rv);
9228
              memmove (&dup_contents[dup_dot], scratch, copy_size);
9229
              orig_dot += orig_insn_size;
9230
              dup_dot += copy_size;
9231
              break;
9232
 
9233
            case ta_add_literal:
9234
              orig_insn_size = 0;
9235
              copy_size = 4;
9236
              BFD_ASSERT (action->removed_bytes == -4);
9237
              /* TBD -- place the literal value here and insert
9238
                 into the table.  */
9239
              memset (&dup_contents[dup_dot], 0, 4);
9240
              pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
9241
              pin_contents (sec, contents);
9242
 
9243
              if (!move_literal (abfd, link_info, sec, dup_dot, dup_contents,
9244
                                 relax_info, &internal_relocs, &action->value))
9245
                goto error_return;
9246
 
9247
              if (virtual_action)
9248
                orig_dot_vo += copy_size;
9249
 
9250
              orig_dot += orig_insn_size;
9251
              dup_dot += copy_size;
9252
              break;
9253
 
9254
            default:
9255
              /* Not implemented yet.  */
9256
              BFD_ASSERT (0);
9257
              break;
9258
            }
9259
 
9260
          removed += action->removed_bytes;
9261
          BFD_ASSERT (dup_dot <= final_size);
9262
          BFD_ASSERT (orig_dot <= orig_size);
9263
        }
9264
 
9265
      orig_dot += orig_dot_copied;
9266
      orig_dot_copied = 0;
9267
 
9268
      if (orig_dot != orig_size)
9269
        {
9270
          copy_size = orig_size - orig_dot;
9271
          BFD_ASSERT (orig_size > orig_dot);
9272
          BFD_ASSERT (dup_dot + copy_size == final_size);
9273
          memmove (&dup_contents[dup_dot], &contents[orig_dot], copy_size);
9274
          orig_dot += copy_size;
9275
          dup_dot += copy_size;
9276
        }
9277
      BFD_ASSERT (orig_size == orig_dot);
9278
      BFD_ASSERT (final_size == dup_dot);
9279
 
9280
      /* Move the dup_contents back.  */
9281
      if (final_size > orig_size)
9282
        {
9283
          /* Contents need to be reallocated.  Swap the dup_contents into
9284
             contents.  */
9285
          sec->contents = dup_contents;
9286
          free (contents);
9287
          contents = dup_contents;
9288
          pin_contents (sec, contents);
9289
        }
9290
      else
9291
        {
9292
          BFD_ASSERT (final_size <= orig_size);
9293
          memset (contents, 0, orig_size);
9294
          memcpy (contents, dup_contents, final_size);
9295
          free (dup_contents);
9296
        }
9297
      free (scratch);
9298
      pin_contents (sec, contents);
9299
 
9300
      if (sec->rawsize == 0)
9301
        sec->rawsize = sec->size;
9302
      sec->size = final_size;
9303
    }
9304
 
9305
 error_return:
9306
  release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
9307
  release_contents (sec, contents);
9308
  return ok;
9309
}
9310
 
9311
 
9312
static bfd_boolean
9313
translate_section_fixes (asection *sec)
9314
{
9315
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
9316
  reloc_bfd_fix *r;
9317
 
9318
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
9319
  if (!relax_info)
9320
    return TRUE;
9321
 
9322
  for (r = relax_info->fix_list; r != NULL; r = r->next)
9323
    if (!translate_reloc_bfd_fix (r))
9324
      return FALSE;
9325
 
9326
  return TRUE;
9327
}
9328
 
9329
 
9330
/* Translate a fix given the mapping in the relax info for the target
9331
   section.  If it has already been translated, no work is required.  */
9332
 
9333
static bfd_boolean
9334
translate_reloc_bfd_fix (reloc_bfd_fix *fix)
9335
{
9336
  reloc_bfd_fix new_fix;
9337
  asection *sec;
9338
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
9339
  removed_literal *removed;
9340
  bfd_vma new_offset, target_offset;
9341
 
9342
  if (fix->translated)
9343
    return TRUE;
9344
 
9345
  sec = fix->target_sec;
9346
  target_offset = fix->target_offset;
9347
 
9348
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
9349
  if (!relax_info)
9350
    {
9351
      fix->translated = TRUE;
9352
      return TRUE;
9353
    }
9354
 
9355
  new_fix = *fix;
9356
 
9357
  /* The fix does not need to be translated if the section cannot change.  */
9358
  if (!relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
9359
      && !relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section)
9360
    {
9361
      fix->translated = TRUE;
9362
      return TRUE;
9363
    }
9364
 
9365
  /* If the literal has been moved and this relocation was on an
9366
     opcode, then the relocation should move to the new literal
9367
     location.  Otherwise, the relocation should move within the
9368
     section.  */
9369
 
9370
  removed = FALSE;
9371
  if (is_operand_relocation (fix->src_type))
9372
    {
9373
      /* Check if the original relocation is against a literal being
9374
         removed.  */
9375
      removed = find_removed_literal (&relax_info->removed_list,
9376
                                      target_offset);
9377
    }
9378
 
9379
  if (removed)
9380
    {
9381
      asection *new_sec;
9382
 
9383
      /* The fact that there is still a relocation to this literal indicates
9384
         that the literal is being coalesced, not simply removed.  */
9385
      BFD_ASSERT (removed->to.abfd != NULL);
9386
 
9387
      /* This was moved to some other address (possibly another section).  */
9388
      new_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&removed->to);
9389
      if (new_sec != sec)
9390
        {
9391
          sec = new_sec;
9392
          relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
9393
          if (!relax_info ||
9394
              (!relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
9395
               && !relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section))
9396
            {
9397
              target_offset = removed->to.target_offset;
9398
              new_fix.target_sec = new_sec;
9399
              new_fix.target_offset = target_offset;
9400
              new_fix.translated = TRUE;
9401
              *fix = new_fix;
9402
              return TRUE;
9403
            }
9404
        }
9405
      target_offset = removed->to.target_offset;
9406
      new_fix.target_sec = new_sec;
9407
    }
9408
 
9409
  /* The target address may have been moved within its section.  */
9410
  new_offset = offset_with_removed_text (&relax_info->action_list,
9411
                                         target_offset);
9412
 
9413
  new_fix.target_offset = new_offset;
9414
  new_fix.target_offset = new_offset;
9415
  new_fix.translated = TRUE;
9416
  *fix = new_fix;
9417
  return TRUE;
9418
}
9419
 
9420
 
9421
/* Fix up a relocation to take account of removed literals.  */
9422
 
9423
static asection *
9424
translate_reloc (const r_reloc *orig_rel, r_reloc *new_rel, asection *sec)
9425
{
9426
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
9427
  removed_literal *removed;
9428
  bfd_vma target_offset, base_offset;
9429
  text_action *act;
9430
 
9431
  *new_rel = *orig_rel;
9432
 
9433
  if (!r_reloc_is_defined (orig_rel))
9434
    return sec ;
9435
 
9436
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
9437
  BFD_ASSERT (relax_info && (relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
9438
                             || relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section));
9439
 
9440
  target_offset = orig_rel->target_offset;
9441
 
9442
  removed = FALSE;
9443
  if (is_operand_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (orig_rel->rela.r_info)))
9444
    {
9445
      /* Check if the original relocation is against a literal being
9446
         removed.  */
9447
      removed = find_removed_literal (&relax_info->removed_list,
9448
                                      target_offset);
9449
    }
9450
  if (removed && removed->to.abfd)
9451
    {
9452
      asection *new_sec;
9453
 
9454
      /* The fact that there is still a relocation to this literal indicates
9455
         that the literal is being coalesced, not simply removed.  */
9456
      BFD_ASSERT (removed->to.abfd != NULL);
9457
 
9458
      /* This was moved to some other address
9459
         (possibly in another section).  */
9460
      *new_rel = removed->to;
9461
      new_sec = r_reloc_get_section (new_rel);
9462
      if (new_sec != sec)
9463
        {
9464
          sec = new_sec;
9465
          relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
9466
          if (!relax_info
9467
              || (!relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
9468
                  && !relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section))
9469
            return sec;
9470
        }
9471
      target_offset = new_rel->target_offset;
9472
    }
9473
 
9474
  /* Find the base offset of the reloc symbol, excluding any addend from the
9475
     reloc or from the section contents (for a partial_inplace reloc).  Then
9476
     find the adjusted values of the offsets due to relaxation.  The base
9477
     offset is needed to determine the change to the reloc's addend; the reloc
9478
     addend should not be adjusted due to relaxations located before the base
9479
     offset.  */
9480
 
9481
  base_offset = r_reloc_get_target_offset (new_rel) - new_rel->rela.r_addend;
9482
  act = relax_info->action_list.head;
9483
  if (base_offset <= target_offset)
9484
    {
9485
      int base_removed = removed_by_actions (&act, base_offset, FALSE);
9486
      int addend_removed = removed_by_actions (&act, target_offset, FALSE);
9487
      new_rel->target_offset = target_offset - base_removed - addend_removed;
9488
      new_rel->rela.r_addend -= addend_removed;
9489
    }
9490
  else
9491
    {
9492
      /* Handle a negative addend.  The base offset comes first.  */
9493
      int tgt_removed = removed_by_actions (&act, target_offset, FALSE);
9494
      int addend_removed = removed_by_actions (&act, base_offset, FALSE);
9495
      new_rel->target_offset = target_offset - tgt_removed;
9496
      new_rel->rela.r_addend += addend_removed;
9497
    }
9498
 
9499
  return sec;
9500
}
9501
 
9502
 
9503
/* For dynamic links, there may be a dynamic relocation for each
9504
   literal.  The number of dynamic relocations must be computed in
9505
   size_dynamic_sections, which occurs before relaxation.  When a
9506
   literal is removed, this function checks if there is a corresponding
9507
   dynamic relocation and shrinks the size of the appropriate dynamic
9508
   relocation section accordingly.  At this point, the contents of the
9509
   dynamic relocation sections have not yet been filled in, so there's
9510
   nothing else that needs to be done.  */
9511
 
9512
static void
9513
shrink_dynamic_reloc_sections (struct bfd_link_info *info,
9514
                               bfd *abfd,
9515
                               asection *input_section,
9516
                               Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
9517
{
9518
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
9519
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9520
  struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
9521
  unsigned long r_symndx;
9522
  int r_type;
9523
  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9524
  bfd_boolean dynamic_symbol;
9525
 
9526
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
9527
  if (htab == NULL)
9528
    return;
9529
 
9530
  symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
9531
  sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
9532
 
9533
  r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
9534
  r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
9535
 
9536
  if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
9537
    h = NULL;
9538
  else
9539
    h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
9540
 
9541
  dynamic_symbol = elf_xtensa_dynamic_symbol_p (h, info);
9542
 
9543
  if ((r_type == R_XTENSA_32 || r_type == R_XTENSA_PLT)
9544
      && (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
9545
      && (dynamic_symbol || info->shared))
9546
    {
9547
      asection *srel;
9548
      bfd_boolean is_plt = FALSE;
9549
 
9550
      if (dynamic_symbol && r_type == R_XTENSA_PLT)
9551
        {
9552
          srel = htab->srelplt;
9553
          is_plt = TRUE;
9554
        }
9555
      else
9556
        srel = htab->srelgot;
9557
 
9558
      /* Reduce size of the .rela.* section by one reloc.  */
9559
      BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
9560
      BFD_ASSERT (srel->size >= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9561
      srel->size -= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9562
 
9563
      if (is_plt)
9564
        {
9565
          asection *splt, *sgotplt, *srelgot;
9566
          int reloc_index, chunk;
9567
 
9568
          /* Find the PLT reloc index of the entry being removed.  This
9569
             is computed from the size of ".rela.plt".  It is needed to
9570
             figure out which PLT chunk to resize.  Usually "last index
9571
             = size - 1" since the index starts at zero, but in this
9572
             context, the size has just been decremented so there's no
9573
             need to subtract one.  */
9574
          reloc_index = srel->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9575
 
9576
          chunk = reloc_index / PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK;
9577
          splt = elf_xtensa_get_plt_section (info, chunk);
9578
          sgotplt = elf_xtensa_get_gotplt_section (info, chunk);
9579
          BFD_ASSERT (splt != NULL && sgotplt != NULL);
9580
 
9581
          /* Check if an entire PLT chunk has just been eliminated.  */
9582
          if (reloc_index % PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK == 0)
9583
            {
9584
              /* The two magic GOT entries for that chunk can go away.  */
9585
              srelgot = htab->srelgot;
9586
              BFD_ASSERT (srelgot != NULL);
9587
              srelgot->reloc_count -= 2;
9588
              srelgot->size -= 2 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9589
              sgotplt->size -= 8;
9590
 
9591
              /* There should be only one entry left (and it will be
9592
                 removed below).  */
9593
              BFD_ASSERT (sgotplt->size == 4);
9594
              BFD_ASSERT (splt->size == PLT_ENTRY_SIZE);
9595
            }
9596
 
9597
          BFD_ASSERT (sgotplt->size >= 4);
9598
          BFD_ASSERT (splt->size >= PLT_ENTRY_SIZE);
9599
 
9600
          sgotplt->size -= 4;
9601
          splt->size -= PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
9602
        }
9603
    }
9604
}
9605
 
9606
 
9607
/* Take an r_rel and move it to another section.  This usually
9608
   requires extending the interal_relocation array and pinning it.  If
9609
   the original r_rel is from the same BFD, we can complete this here.
9610
   Otherwise, we add a fix record to let the final link fix the
9611
   appropriate address.  Contents and internal relocations for the
9612
   section must be pinned after calling this routine.  */
9613
 
9614
static bfd_boolean
9615
move_literal (bfd *abfd,
9616
              struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
9617
              asection *sec,
9618
              bfd_vma offset,
9619
              bfd_byte *contents,
9620
              xtensa_relax_info *relax_info,
9621
              Elf_Internal_Rela **internal_relocs_p,
9622
              const literal_value *lit)
9623
{
9624
  Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = NULL;
9625
  size_t new_relocs_count = 0;
9626
  Elf_Internal_Rela this_rela;
9627
  const r_reloc *r_rel;
9628
 
9629
  r_rel = &lit->r_rel;
9630
  BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs == *internal_relocs_p);
9631
 
9632
  if (r_reloc_is_const (r_rel))
9633
    bfd_put_32 (abfd, lit->value, contents + offset);
9634
  else
9635
    {
9636
      int r_type;
9637
      unsigned i;
9638
      asection *target_sec;
9639
      reloc_bfd_fix *fix;
9640
      unsigned insert_at;
9641
 
9642
      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (r_rel->rela.r_info);
9643
      target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (r_rel);
9644
 
9645
      /* This is the difficult case.  We have to create a fix up.  */
9646
      this_rela.r_offset = offset;
9647
      this_rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
9648
      this_rela.r_addend =
9649
        r_rel->target_offset - r_reloc_get_target_offset (r_rel);
9650
      bfd_put_32 (abfd, lit->value, contents + offset);
9651
 
9652
      /* Currently, we cannot move relocations during a relocatable link.  */
9653
      BFD_ASSERT (!link_info->relocatable);
9654
      fix = reloc_bfd_fix_init (sec, offset, r_type,
9655
                                r_reloc_get_section (r_rel),
9656
                                r_rel->target_offset + r_rel->virtual_offset,
9657
                                FALSE);
9658
      /* We also need to mark that relocations are needed here.  */
9659
      sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
9660
 
9661
      translate_reloc_bfd_fix (fix);
9662
      /* This fix has not yet been translated.  */
9663
      add_fix (sec, fix);
9664
 
9665
      /* Add the relocation.  If we have already allocated our own
9666
         space for the relocations and we have room for more, then use
9667
         it.  Otherwise, allocate new space and move the literals.  */
9668
      insert_at = sec->reloc_count;
9669
      for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; ++i)
9670
        {
9671
          if (this_rela.r_offset < (*internal_relocs_p)[i].r_offset)
9672
            {
9673
              insert_at = i;
9674
              break;
9675
            }
9676
        }
9677
 
9678
      if (*internal_relocs_p != relax_info->allocated_relocs
9679
          || sec->reloc_count + 1 > relax_info->allocated_relocs_count)
9680
        {
9681
          BFD_ASSERT (relax_info->allocated_relocs == NULL
9682
                      || sec->reloc_count == relax_info->relocs_count);
9683
 
9684
          if (relax_info->allocated_relocs_count == 0)
9685
            new_relocs_count = (sec->reloc_count + 2) * 2;
9686
          else
9687
            new_relocs_count = (relax_info->allocated_relocs_count + 2) * 2;
9688
 
9689
          new_relocs = (Elf_Internal_Rela *)
9690
            bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela) * (new_relocs_count));
9691
          if (!new_relocs)
9692
            return FALSE;
9693
 
9694
          /* We could handle this more quickly by finding the split point.  */
9695
          if (insert_at != 0)
9696
            memcpy (new_relocs, *internal_relocs_p,
9697
                    insert_at * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela));
9698
 
9699
          new_relocs[insert_at] = this_rela;
9700
 
9701
          if (insert_at != sec->reloc_count)
9702
            memcpy (new_relocs + insert_at + 1,
9703
                    (*internal_relocs_p) + insert_at,
9704
                    (sec->reloc_count - insert_at)
9705
                    * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela));
9706
 
9707
          if (*internal_relocs_p != relax_info->allocated_relocs)
9708
            {
9709
              /* The first time we re-allocate, we can only free the
9710
                 old relocs if they were allocated with bfd_malloc.
9711
                 This is not true when keep_memory is in effect.  */
9712
              if (!link_info->keep_memory)
9713
                free (*internal_relocs_p);
9714
            }
9715
          else
9716
            free (*internal_relocs_p);
9717
          relax_info->allocated_relocs = new_relocs;
9718
          relax_info->allocated_relocs_count = new_relocs_count;
9719
          elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = new_relocs;
9720
          sec->reloc_count++;
9721
          relax_info->relocs_count = sec->reloc_count;
9722
          *internal_relocs_p = new_relocs;
9723
        }
9724
      else
9725
        {
9726
          if (insert_at != sec->reloc_count)
9727
            {
9728
              unsigned idx;
9729
              for (idx = sec->reloc_count; idx > insert_at; idx--)
9730
                (*internal_relocs_p)[idx] = (*internal_relocs_p)[idx-1];
9731
            }
9732
          (*internal_relocs_p)[insert_at] = this_rela;
9733
          sec->reloc_count++;
9734
          if (relax_info->allocated_relocs)
9735
            relax_info->relocs_count = sec->reloc_count;
9736
        }
9737
    }
9738
  return TRUE;
9739
}
9740
 
9741
 
9742
/* This is similar to relax_section except that when a target is moved,
9743
   we shift addresses up.  We also need to modify the size.  This
9744
   algorithm does NOT allow for relocations into the middle of the
9745
   property sections.  */
9746
 
9747
static bfd_boolean
9748
relax_property_section (bfd *abfd,
9749
                        asection *sec,
9750
                        struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
9751
{
9752
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
9753
  bfd_byte *contents;
9754
  unsigned i;
9755
  bfd_boolean ok = TRUE;
9756
  bfd_boolean is_full_prop_section;
9757
  size_t last_zfill_target_offset = 0;
9758
  asection *last_zfill_target_sec = NULL;
9759
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
9760
  bfd_size_type entry_size;
9761
 
9762
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
9763
  internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
9764
                                              link_info->keep_memory);
9765
  contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
9766
  if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
9767
    {
9768
      ok = FALSE;
9769
      goto error_return;
9770
    }
9771
 
9772
  is_full_prop_section = xtensa_is_proptable_section (sec);
9773
  if (is_full_prop_section)
9774
    entry_size = 12;
9775
  else
9776
    entry_size = 8;
9777
 
9778
  if (internal_relocs)
9779
    {
9780
      for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
9781
        {
9782
          Elf_Internal_Rela *irel;
9783
          xtensa_relax_info *target_relax_info;
9784
          unsigned r_type;
9785
          asection *target_sec;
9786
          literal_value val;
9787
          bfd_byte *size_p, *flags_p;
9788
 
9789
          /* Locally change the source address.
9790
             Translate the target to the new target address.
9791
             If it points to this section and has been removed, MOVE IT.
9792
             Also, don't forget to modify the associated SIZE at
9793
             (offset + 4).  */
9794
 
9795
          irel = &internal_relocs[i];
9796
          r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
9797
          if (r_type == R_XTENSA_NONE)
9798
            continue;
9799
 
9800
          /* Find the literal value.  */
9801
          r_reloc_init (&val.r_rel, abfd, irel, contents, sec_size);
9802
          size_p = &contents[irel->r_offset + 4];
9803
          flags_p = NULL;
9804
          if (is_full_prop_section)
9805
            flags_p = &contents[irel->r_offset + 8];
9806
          BFD_ASSERT (irel->r_offset + entry_size <= sec_size);
9807
 
9808
          target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&val.r_rel);
9809
          target_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (target_sec);
9810
 
9811
          if (target_relax_info
9812
              && (target_relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
9813
                  || target_relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section ))
9814
            {
9815
              /* Translate the relocation's destination.  */
9816
              bfd_vma old_offset = val.r_rel.target_offset;
9817
              bfd_vma new_offset;
9818
              long old_size, new_size;
9819
              text_action *act = target_relax_info->action_list.head;
9820
              new_offset = old_offset -
9821
                removed_by_actions (&act, old_offset, FALSE);
9822
 
9823
              /* Assert that we are not out of bounds.  */
9824
              old_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, size_p);
9825
              new_size = old_size;
9826
 
9827
              if (old_size == 0)
9828
                {
9829
                  /* Only the first zero-sized unreachable entry is
9830
                     allowed to expand.  In this case the new offset
9831
                     should be the offset before the fill and the new
9832
                     size is the expansion size.  For other zero-sized
9833
                     entries the resulting size should be zero with an
9834
                     offset before or after the fill address depending
9835
                     on whether the expanding unreachable entry
9836
                     preceeds it.  */
9837
                  if (last_zfill_target_sec == 0
9838
                      || last_zfill_target_sec != target_sec
9839
                      || last_zfill_target_offset != old_offset)
9840
                    {
9841
                      bfd_vma new_end_offset = new_offset;
9842
 
9843
                      /* Recompute the new_offset, but this time don't
9844
                         include any fill inserted by relaxation.  */
9845
                      act = target_relax_info->action_list.head;
9846
                      new_offset = old_offset -
9847
                        removed_by_actions (&act, old_offset, TRUE);
9848
 
9849
                      /* If it is not unreachable and we have not yet
9850
                         seen an unreachable at this address, place it
9851
                         before the fill address.  */
9852
                      if (flags_p && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, flags_p)
9853
                                      & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE) != 0)
9854
                        {
9855
                          new_size = new_end_offset - new_offset;
9856
 
9857
                          last_zfill_target_sec = target_sec;
9858
                          last_zfill_target_offset = old_offset;
9859
                        }
9860
                    }
9861
                }
9862
              else
9863
                new_size -=
9864
                    removed_by_actions (&act, old_offset + old_size, TRUE);
9865
 
9866
              if (new_size != old_size)
9867
                {
9868
                  bfd_put_32 (abfd, new_size, size_p);
9869
                  pin_contents (sec, contents);
9870
                }
9871
 
9872
              if (new_offset != old_offset)
9873
                {
9874
                  bfd_vma diff = new_offset - old_offset;
9875
                  irel->r_addend += diff;
9876
                  pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
9877
                }
9878
            }
9879
        }
9880
    }
9881
 
9882
  /* Combine adjacent property table entries.  This is also done in
9883
     finish_dynamic_sections() but at that point it's too late to
9884
     reclaim the space in the output section, so we do this twice.  */
9885
 
9886
  if (internal_relocs && (!link_info->relocatable
9887
                          || xtensa_is_littable_section (sec)))
9888
    {
9889
      Elf_Internal_Rela *last_irel = NULL;
9890
      Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *next_rel, *rel_end;
9891
      int removed_bytes = 0;
9892
      bfd_vma offset;
9893
      flagword predef_flags;
9894
 
9895
      predef_flags = xtensa_get_property_predef_flags (sec);
9896
 
9897
      /* Walk over memory and relocations at the same time.
9898
         This REQUIRES that the internal_relocs be sorted by offset.  */
9899
      qsort (internal_relocs, sec->reloc_count, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela),
9900
             internal_reloc_compare);
9901
 
9902
      pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
9903
      pin_contents (sec, contents);
9904
 
9905
      next_rel = internal_relocs;
9906
      rel_end = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count;
9907
 
9908
      BFD_ASSERT (sec->size % entry_size == 0);
9909
 
9910
      for (offset = 0; offset < sec->size; offset += entry_size)
9911
        {
9912
          Elf_Internal_Rela *offset_rel, *extra_rel;
9913
          bfd_vma bytes_to_remove, size, actual_offset;
9914
          bfd_boolean remove_this_rel;
9915
          flagword flags;
9916
 
9917
          /* Find the first relocation for the entry at the current offset.
9918
             Adjust the offsets of any extra relocations for the previous
9919
             entry.  */
9920
          offset_rel = NULL;
9921
          if (next_rel)
9922
            {
9923
              for (irel = next_rel; irel < rel_end; irel++)
9924
                {
9925
                  if ((irel->r_offset == offset
9926
                       && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_NONE)
9927
                      || irel->r_offset > offset)
9928
                    {
9929
                      offset_rel = irel;
9930
                      break;
9931
                    }
9932
                  irel->r_offset -= removed_bytes;
9933
                }
9934
            }
9935
 
9936
          /* Find the next relocation (if there are any left).  */
9937
          extra_rel = NULL;
9938
          if (offset_rel)
9939
            {
9940
              for (irel = offset_rel + 1; irel < rel_end; irel++)
9941
                {
9942
                  if (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_NONE)
9943
                    {
9944
                      extra_rel = irel;
9945
                      break;
9946
                    }
9947
                }
9948
            }
9949
 
9950
          /* Check if there are relocations on the current entry.  There
9951
             should usually be a relocation on the offset field.  If there
9952
             are relocations on the size or flags, then we can't optimize
9953
             this entry.  Also, find the next relocation to examine on the
9954
             next iteration.  */
9955
          if (offset_rel)
9956
            {
9957
              if (offset_rel->r_offset >= offset + entry_size)
9958
                {
9959
                  next_rel = offset_rel;
9960
                  /* There are no relocations on the current entry, but we
9961
                     might still be able to remove it if the size is zero.  */
9962
                  offset_rel = NULL;
9963
                }
9964
              else if (offset_rel->r_offset > offset
9965
                       || (extra_rel
9966
                           && extra_rel->r_offset < offset + entry_size))
9967
                {
9968
                  /* There is a relocation on the size or flags, so we can't
9969
                     do anything with this entry.  Continue with the next.  */
9970
                  next_rel = offset_rel;
9971
                  continue;
9972
                }
9973
              else
9974
                {
9975
                  BFD_ASSERT (offset_rel->r_offset == offset);
9976
                  offset_rel->r_offset -= removed_bytes;
9977
                  next_rel = offset_rel + 1;
9978
                }
9979
            }
9980
          else
9981
            next_rel = NULL;
9982
 
9983
          remove_this_rel = FALSE;
9984
          bytes_to_remove = 0;
9985
          actual_offset = offset - removed_bytes;
9986
          size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[actual_offset + 4]);
9987
 
9988
          if (is_full_prop_section)
9989
            flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[actual_offset + 8]);
9990
          else
9991
            flags = predef_flags;
9992
 
9993
          if (size == 0
9994
              && (flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN) == 0
9995
              && (flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE) == 0)
9996
            {
9997
              /* Always remove entries with zero size and no alignment.  */
9998
              bytes_to_remove = entry_size;
9999
              if (offset_rel)
10000
                remove_this_rel = TRUE;
10001
            }
10002
          else if (offset_rel
10003
                   && ELF32_R_TYPE (offset_rel->r_info) == R_XTENSA_32)
10004
            {
10005
              if (last_irel)
10006
                {
10007
                  flagword old_flags;
10008
                  bfd_vma old_size =
10009
                    bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[last_irel->r_offset + 4]);
10010
                  bfd_vma old_address =
10011
                    (last_irel->r_addend
10012
                     + bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[last_irel->r_offset]));
10013
                  bfd_vma new_address =
10014
                    (offset_rel->r_addend
10015
                     + bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[actual_offset]));
10016
                  if (is_full_prop_section)
10017
                    old_flags = bfd_get_32
10018
                      (abfd, &contents[last_irel->r_offset + 8]);
10019
                  else
10020
                    old_flags = predef_flags;
10021
 
10022
                  if ((ELF32_R_SYM (offset_rel->r_info)
10023
                       == ELF32_R_SYM (last_irel->r_info))
10024
                      && old_address + old_size == new_address
10025
                      && old_flags == flags
10026
                      && (old_flags & XTENSA_PROP_INSN_BRANCH_TARGET) == 0
10027
                      && (old_flags & XTENSA_PROP_INSN_LOOP_TARGET) == 0)
10028
                    {
10029
                      /* Fix the old size.  */
10030
                      bfd_put_32 (abfd, old_size + size,
10031
                                  &contents[last_irel->r_offset + 4]);
10032
                      bytes_to_remove = entry_size;
10033
                      remove_this_rel = TRUE;
10034
                    }
10035
                  else
10036
                    last_irel = offset_rel;
10037
                }
10038
              else
10039
                last_irel = offset_rel;
10040
            }
10041
 
10042
          if (remove_this_rel)
10043
            {
10044
              offset_rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_NONE);
10045
              offset_rel->r_offset = 0;
10046
            }
10047
 
10048
          if (bytes_to_remove != 0)
10049
            {
10050
              removed_bytes += bytes_to_remove;
10051
              if (offset + bytes_to_remove < sec->size)
10052
                memmove (&contents[actual_offset],
10053
                         &contents[actual_offset + bytes_to_remove],
10054
                         sec->size - offset - bytes_to_remove);
10055
            }
10056
        }
10057
 
10058
      if (removed_bytes)
10059
        {
10060
          /* Fix up any extra relocations on the last entry.  */
10061
          for (irel = next_rel; irel < rel_end; irel++)
10062
            irel->r_offset -= removed_bytes;
10063
 
10064
          /* Clear the removed bytes.  */
10065
          memset (&contents[sec->size - removed_bytes], 0, removed_bytes);
10066
 
10067
          if (sec->rawsize == 0)
10068
            sec->rawsize = sec->size;
10069
          sec->size -= removed_bytes;
10070
 
10071
          if (xtensa_is_littable_section (sec))
10072
            {
10073
              asection *sgotloc = elf_xtensa_hash_table (link_info)->sgotloc;
10074
              if (sgotloc)
10075
                sgotloc->size -= removed_bytes;
10076
            }
10077
        }
10078
    }
10079
 
10080
 error_return:
10081
  release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
10082
  release_contents (sec, contents);
10083
  return ok;
10084
}
10085
 
10086
 
10087
/* Third relaxation pass.  */
10088
 
10089
/* Change symbol values to account for removed literals.  */
10090
 
10091
bfd_boolean
10092
relax_section_symbols (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
10093
{
10094
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
10095
  unsigned int sec_shndx;
10096
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
10097
  Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf;
10098
  unsigned i, num_syms, num_locals;
10099
 
10100
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
10101
  BFD_ASSERT (relax_info);
10102
 
10103
  if (!relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
10104
      && !relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section)
10105
    return TRUE;
10106
 
10107
  sec_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
10108
 
10109
  symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
10110
  isymbuf = retrieve_local_syms (abfd);
10111
 
10112
  num_syms = symtab_hdr->sh_size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Sym);
10113
  num_locals = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
10114
 
10115
  /* Adjust the local symbols defined in this section.  */
10116
  for (i = 0; i < num_locals; i++)
10117
    {
10118
      Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = &isymbuf[i];
10119
 
10120
      if (isym->st_shndx == sec_shndx)
10121
        {
10122
          text_action *act = relax_info->action_list.head;
10123
          bfd_vma orig_addr = isym->st_value;
10124
 
10125
          isym->st_value -= removed_by_actions (&act, orig_addr, FALSE);
10126
 
10127
          if (ELF32_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_FUNC)
10128
            isym->st_size -=
10129
              removed_by_actions (&act, orig_addr + isym->st_size, FALSE);
10130
        }
10131
    }
10132
 
10133
  /* Now adjust the global symbols defined in this section.  */
10134
  for (i = 0; i < (num_syms - num_locals); i++)
10135
    {
10136
      struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym_hash;
10137
 
10138
      sym_hash = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[i];
10139
 
10140
      if (sym_hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
10141
        sym_hash = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) sym_hash->root.u.i.link;
10142
 
10143
      if ((sym_hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
10144
           || sym_hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
10145
          && sym_hash->root.u.def.section == sec)
10146
        {
10147
          text_action *act = relax_info->action_list.head;
10148
          bfd_vma orig_addr = sym_hash->root.u.def.value;
10149
 
10150
          sym_hash->root.u.def.value -=
10151
            removed_by_actions (&act, orig_addr, FALSE);
10152
 
10153
          if (sym_hash->type == STT_FUNC)
10154
            sym_hash->size -=
10155
              removed_by_actions (&act, orig_addr + sym_hash->size, FALSE);
10156
        }
10157
    }
10158
 
10159
  return TRUE;
10160
}
10161
 
10162
 
10163
/* "Fix" handling functions, called while performing relocations.  */
10164
 
10165
static bfd_boolean
10166
do_fix_for_relocatable_link (Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
10167
                             bfd *input_bfd,
10168
                             asection *input_section,
10169
                             bfd_byte *contents)
10170
{
10171
  r_reloc r_rel;
10172
  asection *sec, *old_sec;
10173
  bfd_vma old_offset;
10174
  int r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
10175
  reloc_bfd_fix *fix;
10176
 
10177
  if (r_type == R_XTENSA_NONE)
10178
    return TRUE;
10179
 
10180
  fix = get_bfd_fix (input_section, rel->r_offset, r_type);
10181
  if (!fix)
10182
    return TRUE;
10183
 
10184
  r_reloc_init (&r_rel, input_bfd, rel, contents,
10185
                bfd_get_section_limit (input_bfd, input_section));
10186
  old_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel);
10187
  old_offset = r_rel.target_offset;
10188
 
10189
  if (!old_sec || !r_reloc_is_defined (&r_rel))
10190
    {
10191
      if (r_type != R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND)
10192
        {
10193
          (*_bfd_error_handler)
10194
            (_("%B(%A+0x%lx): unexpected fix for %s relocation"),
10195
             input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
10196
             elf_howto_table[r_type].name);
10197
          return FALSE;
10198
        }
10199
      /* Leave it be.  Resolution will happen in a later stage.  */
10200
    }
10201
  else
10202
    {
10203
      sec = fix->target_sec;
10204
      rel->r_addend += ((sec->output_offset + fix->target_offset)
10205
                        - (old_sec->output_offset + old_offset));
10206
    }
10207
  return TRUE;
10208
}
10209
 
10210
 
10211
static void
10212
do_fix_for_final_link (Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
10213
                       bfd *input_bfd,
10214
                       asection *input_section,
10215
                       bfd_byte *contents,
10216
                       bfd_vma *relocationp)
10217
{
10218
  asection *sec;
10219
  int r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
10220
  reloc_bfd_fix *fix;
10221
  bfd_vma fixup_diff;
10222
 
10223
  if (r_type == R_XTENSA_NONE)
10224
    return;
10225
 
10226
  fix = get_bfd_fix (input_section, rel->r_offset, r_type);
10227
  if (!fix)
10228
    return;
10229
 
10230
  sec = fix->target_sec;
10231
 
10232
  fixup_diff = rel->r_addend;
10233
  if (elf_howto_table[fix->src_type].partial_inplace)
10234
    {
10235
      bfd_vma inplace_val;
10236
      BFD_ASSERT (fix->src_offset
10237
                  < bfd_get_section_limit (input_bfd, input_section));
10238
      inplace_val = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, &contents[fix->src_offset]);
10239
      fixup_diff += inplace_val;
10240
    }
10241
 
10242
  *relocationp = (sec->output_section->vma
10243
                  + sec->output_offset
10244
                  + fix->target_offset - fixup_diff);
10245
}
10246
 
10247
 
10248
/* Miscellaneous utility functions....  */
10249
 
10250
static asection *
10251
elf_xtensa_get_plt_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, int chunk)
10252
{
10253
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
10254
  bfd *dynobj;
10255
  char plt_name[10];
10256
 
10257
  if (chunk == 0)
10258
    {
10259
      htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
10260
      if (htab == NULL)
10261
        return NULL;
10262
 
10263
      return htab->splt;
10264
    }
10265
 
10266
  dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
10267
  sprintf (plt_name, ".plt.%u", chunk);
10268
  return bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, plt_name);
10269
}
10270
 
10271
 
10272
static asection *
10273
elf_xtensa_get_gotplt_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, int chunk)
10274
{
10275
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
10276
  bfd *dynobj;
10277
  char got_name[14];
10278
 
10279
  if (chunk == 0)
10280
    {
10281
      htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
10282
      if (htab == NULL)
10283
        return NULL;
10284
      return htab->sgotplt;
10285
    }
10286
 
10287
  dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
10288
  sprintf (got_name, ".got.plt.%u", chunk);
10289
  return bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, got_name);
10290
}
10291
 
10292
 
10293
/* Get the input section for a given symbol index.
10294
   If the symbol is:
10295
   . a section symbol, return the section;
10296
   . a common symbol, return the common section;
10297
   . an undefined symbol, return the undefined section;
10298
   . an indirect symbol, follow the links;
10299
   . an absolute value, return the absolute section.  */
10300
 
10301
static asection *
10302
get_elf_r_symndx_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned long r_symndx)
10303
{
10304
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
10305
  asection *target_sec = NULL;
10306
  if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
10307
    {
10308
      Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf;
10309
      unsigned int section_index;
10310
 
10311
      isymbuf = retrieve_local_syms (abfd);
10312
      section_index = isymbuf[r_symndx].st_shndx;
10313
 
10314
      if (section_index == SHN_UNDEF)
10315
        target_sec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
10316
      else if (section_index == SHN_ABS)
10317
        target_sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
10318
      else if (section_index == SHN_COMMON)
10319
        target_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
10320
      else
10321
        target_sec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, section_index);
10322
    }
10323
  else
10324
    {
10325
      unsigned long indx = r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
10326
      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[indx];
10327
 
10328
      while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
10329
             || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
10330
        h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
10331
 
10332
      switch (h->root.type)
10333
        {
10334
        case bfd_link_hash_defined:
10335
        case  bfd_link_hash_defweak:
10336
          target_sec = h->root.u.def.section;
10337
          break;
10338
        case bfd_link_hash_common:
10339
          target_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
10340
          break;
10341
        case bfd_link_hash_undefined:
10342
        case bfd_link_hash_undefweak:
10343
          target_sec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
10344
          break;
10345
        default: /* New indirect warning.  */
10346
          target_sec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
10347
          break;
10348
        }
10349
    }
10350
  return target_sec;
10351
}
10352
 
10353
 
10354
static struct elf_link_hash_entry *
10355
get_elf_r_symndx_hash_entry (bfd *abfd, unsigned long r_symndx)
10356
{
10357
  unsigned long indx;
10358
  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
10359
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
10360
 
10361
  if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
10362
    return NULL;
10363
 
10364
  indx = r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
10365
  h = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[indx];
10366
  while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
10367
         || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
10368
    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
10369
  return h;
10370
}
10371
 
10372
 
10373
/* Get the section-relative offset for a symbol number.  */
10374
 
10375
static bfd_vma
10376
get_elf_r_symndx_offset (bfd *abfd, unsigned long r_symndx)
10377
{
10378
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
10379
  bfd_vma offset = 0;
10380
 
10381
  if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
10382
    {
10383
      Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf;
10384
      isymbuf = retrieve_local_syms (abfd);
10385
      offset = isymbuf[r_symndx].st_value;
10386
    }
10387
  else
10388
    {
10389
      unsigned long indx = r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
10390
      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h =
10391
        elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[indx];
10392
 
10393
      while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
10394
             || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
10395
        h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
10396
      if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
10397
          || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
10398
        offset = h->root.u.def.value;
10399
    }
10400
  return offset;
10401
}
10402
 
10403
 
10404
static bfd_boolean
10405
is_reloc_sym_weak (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
10406
{
10407
  unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
10408
  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
10409
 
10410
  h = get_elf_r_symndx_hash_entry (abfd, r_symndx);
10411
  if (h && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
10412
    return TRUE;
10413
  return FALSE;
10414
}
10415
 
10416
 
10417
static bfd_boolean
10418
pcrel_reloc_fits (xtensa_opcode opc,
10419
                  int opnd,
10420
                  bfd_vma self_address,
10421
                  bfd_vma dest_address)
10422
{
10423
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
10424
  uint32 valp = dest_address;
10425
  if (xtensa_operand_do_reloc (isa, opc, opnd, &valp, self_address)
10426
      || xtensa_operand_encode (isa, opc, opnd, &valp))
10427
    return FALSE;
10428
  return TRUE;
10429
}
10430
 
10431
 
10432
static bfd_boolean
10433
xtensa_is_property_section (asection *sec)
10434
{
10435
  if (xtensa_is_insntable_section (sec)
10436
      || xtensa_is_littable_section (sec)
10437
      || xtensa_is_proptable_section (sec))
10438
    return TRUE;
10439
 
10440
  return FALSE;
10441
}
10442
 
10443
 
10444
static bfd_boolean
10445
xtensa_is_insntable_section (asection *sec)
10446
{
10447
  if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, XTENSA_INSN_SEC_NAME)
10448
      || CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".gnu.linkonce.x."))
10449
    return TRUE;
10450
 
10451
  return FALSE;
10452
}
10453
 
10454
 
10455
static bfd_boolean
10456
xtensa_is_littable_section (asection *sec)
10457
{
10458
  if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, XTENSA_LIT_SEC_NAME)
10459
      || CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".gnu.linkonce.p."))
10460
    return TRUE;
10461
 
10462
  return FALSE;
10463
}
10464
 
10465
 
10466
static bfd_boolean
10467
xtensa_is_proptable_section (asection *sec)
10468
{
10469
  if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, XTENSA_PROP_SEC_NAME)
10470
      || CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".gnu.linkonce.prop."))
10471
    return TRUE;
10472
 
10473
  return FALSE;
10474
}
10475
 
10476
 
10477
static int
10478
internal_reloc_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
10479
{
10480
  const Elf_Internal_Rela *a = (const Elf_Internal_Rela *) ap;
10481
  const Elf_Internal_Rela *b = (const Elf_Internal_Rela *) bp;
10482
 
10483
  if (a->r_offset != b->r_offset)
10484
    return (a->r_offset - b->r_offset);
10485
 
10486
  /* We don't need to sort on these criteria for correctness,
10487
     but enforcing a more strict ordering prevents unstable qsort
10488
     from behaving differently with different implementations.
10489
     Without the code below we get correct but different results
10490
     on Solaris 2.7 and 2.8.  We would like to always produce the
10491
     same results no matter the host.  */
10492
 
10493
  if (a->r_info != b->r_info)
10494
    return (a->r_info - b->r_info);
10495
 
10496
  return (a->r_addend - b->r_addend);
10497
}
10498
 
10499
 
10500
static int
10501
internal_reloc_matches (const void *ap, const void *bp)
10502
{
10503
  const Elf_Internal_Rela *a = (const Elf_Internal_Rela *) ap;
10504
  const Elf_Internal_Rela *b = (const Elf_Internal_Rela *) bp;
10505
 
10506
  /* Check if one entry overlaps with the other; this shouldn't happen
10507
     except when searching for a match.  */
10508
  return (a->r_offset - b->r_offset);
10509
}
10510
 
10511
 
10512
/* Predicate function used to look up a section in a particular group.  */
10513
 
10514
static bfd_boolean
10515
match_section_group (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *sec, void *inf)
10516
{
10517
  const char *gname = inf;
10518
  const char *group_name = elf_group_name (sec);
10519
 
10520
  return (group_name == gname
10521
          || (group_name != NULL
10522
              && gname != NULL
10523
              && strcmp (group_name, gname) == 0));
10524
}
10525
 
10526
 
10527
static int linkonce_len = sizeof (".gnu.linkonce.") - 1;
10528
 
10529
static char *
10530
xtensa_property_section_name (asection *sec, const char *base_name)
10531
{
10532
  const char *suffix, *group_name;
10533
  char *prop_sec_name;
10534
 
10535
  group_name = elf_group_name (sec);
10536
  if (group_name)
10537
    {
10538
      suffix = strrchr (sec->name, '.');
10539
      if (suffix == sec->name)
10540
        suffix = 0;
10541
      prop_sec_name = (char *) bfd_malloc (strlen (base_name) + 1
10542
                                           + (suffix ? strlen (suffix) : 0));
10543
      strcpy (prop_sec_name, base_name);
10544
      if (suffix)
10545
        strcat (prop_sec_name, suffix);
10546
    }
10547
  else if (strncmp (sec->name, ".gnu.linkonce.", linkonce_len) == 0)
10548
    {
10549
      char *linkonce_kind = 0;
10550
 
10551
      if (strcmp (base_name, XTENSA_INSN_SEC_NAME) == 0)
10552
        linkonce_kind = "x.";
10553
      else if (strcmp (base_name, XTENSA_LIT_SEC_NAME) == 0)
10554
        linkonce_kind = "p.";
10555
      else if (strcmp (base_name, XTENSA_PROP_SEC_NAME) == 0)
10556
        linkonce_kind = "prop.";
10557
      else
10558
        abort ();
10559
 
10560
      prop_sec_name = (char *) bfd_malloc (strlen (sec->name)
10561
                                           + strlen (linkonce_kind) + 1);
10562
      memcpy (prop_sec_name, ".gnu.linkonce.", linkonce_len);
10563
      strcpy (prop_sec_name + linkonce_len, linkonce_kind);
10564
 
10565
      suffix = sec->name + linkonce_len;
10566
      /* For backward compatibility, replace "t." instead of inserting
10567
         the new linkonce_kind (but not for "prop" sections).  */
10568
      if (CONST_STRNEQ (suffix, "t.") && linkonce_kind[1] == '.')
10569
        suffix += 2;
10570
      strcat (prop_sec_name + linkonce_len, suffix);
10571
    }
10572
  else
10573
    prop_sec_name = strdup (base_name);
10574
 
10575
  return prop_sec_name;
10576
}
10577
 
10578
 
10579
static asection *
10580
xtensa_get_property_section (asection *sec, const char *base_name)
10581
{
10582
  char *prop_sec_name;
10583
  asection *prop_sec;
10584
 
10585
  prop_sec_name = xtensa_property_section_name (sec, base_name);
10586
  prop_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name_if (sec->owner, prop_sec_name,
10587
                                         match_section_group,
10588
                                         (void *) elf_group_name (sec));
10589
  free (prop_sec_name);
10590
  return prop_sec;
10591
}
10592
 
10593
 
10594
asection *
10595
xtensa_make_property_section (asection *sec, const char *base_name)
10596
{
10597
  char *prop_sec_name;
10598
  asection *prop_sec;
10599
 
10600
  /* Check if the section already exists.  */
10601
  prop_sec_name = xtensa_property_section_name (sec, base_name);
10602
  prop_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name_if (sec->owner, prop_sec_name,
10603
                                         match_section_group,
10604
                                         (void *) elf_group_name (sec));
10605
  /* If not, create it.  */
10606
  if (! prop_sec)
10607
    {
10608
      flagword flags = (SEC_RELOC | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_READONLY);
10609
      flags |= (bfd_get_section_flags (sec->owner, sec)
10610
                & (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES));
10611
 
10612
      prop_sec = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags
10613
        (sec->owner, strdup (prop_sec_name), flags);
10614
      if (! prop_sec)
10615
        return 0;
10616
 
10617
      elf_group_name (prop_sec) = elf_group_name (sec);
10618
    }
10619
 
10620
  free (prop_sec_name);
10621
  return prop_sec;
10622
}
10623
 
10624
 
10625
flagword
10626
xtensa_get_property_predef_flags (asection *sec)
10627
{
10628
  if (xtensa_is_insntable_section (sec))
10629
    return (XTENSA_PROP_INSN
10630
            | XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM
10631
            | XTENSA_PROP_INSN_NO_REORDER);
10632
 
10633
  if (xtensa_is_littable_section (sec))
10634
    return (XTENSA_PROP_LITERAL
10635
            | XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM
10636
            | XTENSA_PROP_INSN_NO_REORDER);
10637
 
10638
  return 0;
10639
}
10640
 
10641
 
10642
/* Other functions called directly by the linker.  */
10643
 
10644
bfd_boolean
10645
xtensa_callback_required_dependence (bfd *abfd,
10646
                                     asection *sec,
10647
                                     struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
10648
                                     deps_callback_t callback,
10649
                                     void *closure)
10650
{
10651
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
10652
  bfd_byte *contents;
10653
  unsigned i;
10654
  bfd_boolean ok = TRUE;
10655
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
10656
 
10657
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
10658
 
10659
  /* ".plt*" sections have no explicit relocations but they contain L32R
10660
     instructions that reference the corresponding ".got.plt*" sections.  */
10661
  if ((sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
10662
      && CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".plt"))
10663
    {
10664
      asection *sgotplt;
10665
 
10666
      /* Find the corresponding ".got.plt*" section.  */
10667
      if (sec->name[4] == '\0')
10668
        sgotplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (sec->owner, ".got.plt");
10669
      else
10670
        {
10671
          char got_name[14];
10672
          int chunk = 0;
10673
 
10674
          BFD_ASSERT (sec->name[4] == '.');
10675
          chunk = strtol (&sec->name[5], NULL, 10);
10676
 
10677
          sprintf (got_name, ".got.plt.%u", chunk);
10678
          sgotplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (sec->owner, got_name);
10679
        }
10680
      BFD_ASSERT (sgotplt);
10681
 
10682
      /* Assume worst-case offsets: L32R at the very end of the ".plt"
10683
         section referencing a literal at the very beginning of
10684
         ".got.plt".  This is very close to the real dependence, anyway.  */
10685
      (*callback) (sec, sec_size, sgotplt, 0, closure);
10686
    }
10687
 
10688
  /* Only ELF files are supported for Xtensa.  Check here to avoid a segfault
10689
     when building uclibc, which runs "ld -b binary /dev/null".  */
10690
  if (bfd_get_flavour (abfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
10691
    return ok;
10692
 
10693
  internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
10694
                                              link_info->keep_memory);
10695
  if (internal_relocs == NULL
10696
      || sec->reloc_count == 0)
10697
    return ok;
10698
 
10699
  /* Cache the contents for the duration of this scan.  */
10700
  contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
10701
  if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
10702
    {
10703
      ok = FALSE;
10704
      goto error_return;
10705
    }
10706
 
10707
  if (!xtensa_default_isa)
10708
    xtensa_default_isa = xtensa_isa_init (0, 0);
10709
 
10710
  for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
10711
    {
10712
      Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
10713
      if (is_l32r_relocation (abfd, sec, contents, irel))
10714
        {
10715
          r_reloc l32r_rel;
10716
          asection *target_sec;
10717
          bfd_vma target_offset;
10718
 
10719
          r_reloc_init (&l32r_rel, abfd, irel, contents, sec_size);
10720
          target_sec = NULL;
10721
          target_offset = 0;
10722
          /* L32Rs must be local to the input file.  */
10723
          if (r_reloc_is_defined (&l32r_rel))
10724
            {
10725
              target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&l32r_rel);
10726
              target_offset = l32r_rel.target_offset;
10727
            }
10728
          (*callback) (sec, irel->r_offset, target_sec, target_offset,
10729
                       closure);
10730
        }
10731
    }
10732
 
10733
 error_return:
10734
  release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
10735
  release_contents (sec, contents);
10736
  return ok;
10737
}
10738
 
10739
/* The default literal sections should always be marked as "code" (i.e.,
10740
   SHF_EXECINSTR).  This is particularly important for the Linux kernel
10741
   module loader so that the literals are not placed after the text.  */
10742
static const struct bfd_elf_special_section elf_xtensa_special_sections[] =
10743
{
10744
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini.literal"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
10745
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init.literal"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
10746
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".literal"),      0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
10747
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".xtensa.info"),  0, SHT_NOTE,     0 },
10748
  { NULL,                       0,      0, 0,            0 }
10749
};
10750
 
10751
#ifndef ELF_ARCH
10752
#define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM               bfd_elf32_xtensa_le_vec
10753
#define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME              "elf32-xtensa-le"
10754
#define TARGET_BIG_SYM                  bfd_elf32_xtensa_be_vec
10755
#define TARGET_BIG_NAME                 "elf32-xtensa-be"
10756
#define ELF_ARCH                        bfd_arch_xtensa
10757
 
10758
#define ELF_MACHINE_CODE                EM_XTENSA
10759
#define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1                EM_XTENSA_OLD
10760
 
10761
#if XCHAL_HAVE_MMU
10762
#define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE                 (1 << XCHAL_MMU_MIN_PTE_PAGE_SIZE)
10763
#else /* !XCHAL_HAVE_MMU */
10764
#define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE                 1
10765
#endif /* !XCHAL_HAVE_MMU */
10766
#endif /* ELF_ARCH */
10767
 
10768
#define elf_backend_can_gc_sections     1
10769
#define elf_backend_can_refcount        1
10770
#define elf_backend_plt_readonly        1
10771
#define elf_backend_got_header_size     4
10772
#define elf_backend_want_dynbss         0
10773
#define elf_backend_want_got_plt        1
10774
 
10775
#define elf_info_to_howto                    elf_xtensa_info_to_howto_rela
10776
 
10777
#define bfd_elf32_mkobject                   elf_xtensa_mkobject
10778
 
10779
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data elf_xtensa_merge_private_bfd_data
10780
#define bfd_elf32_new_section_hook           elf_xtensa_new_section_hook
10781
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_print_private_bfd_data elf_xtensa_print_private_bfd_data
10782
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section          elf_xtensa_relax_section
10783
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup      elf_xtensa_reloc_type_lookup
10784
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup \
10785
  elf_xtensa_reloc_name_lookup
10786
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags      elf_xtensa_set_private_flags
10787
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create elf_xtensa_link_hash_table_create
10788
 
10789
#define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol    elf_xtensa_adjust_dynamic_symbol
10790
#define elf_backend_check_relocs             elf_xtensa_check_relocs
10791
#define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections  elf_xtensa_create_dynamic_sections
10792
#define elf_backend_discard_info             elf_xtensa_discard_info
10793
#define elf_backend_ignore_discarded_relocs  elf_xtensa_ignore_discarded_relocs
10794
#define elf_backend_final_write_processing   elf_xtensa_final_write_processing
10795
#define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections  elf_xtensa_finish_dynamic_sections
10796
#define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol    elf_xtensa_finish_dynamic_symbol
10797
#define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook             elf_xtensa_gc_mark_hook
10798
#define elf_backend_gc_sweep_hook            elf_xtensa_gc_sweep_hook
10799
#define elf_backend_grok_prstatus            elf_xtensa_grok_prstatus
10800
#define elf_backend_grok_psinfo              elf_xtensa_grok_psinfo
10801
#define elf_backend_hide_symbol              elf_xtensa_hide_symbol
10802
#define elf_backend_object_p                 elf_xtensa_object_p
10803
#define elf_backend_reloc_type_class         elf_xtensa_reloc_type_class
10804
#define elf_backend_relocate_section         elf_xtensa_relocate_section
10805
#define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections    elf_xtensa_size_dynamic_sections
10806
#define elf_backend_always_size_sections     elf_xtensa_always_size_sections
10807
#define elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym \
10808
  ((bfd_boolean (*) (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, asection *)) bfd_true)
10809
#define elf_backend_special_sections         elf_xtensa_special_sections
10810
#define elf_backend_action_discarded         elf_xtensa_action_discarded
10811
#define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol     elf_xtensa_copy_indirect_symbol
10812
 
10813
#include "elf32-target.h"

powered by: WebSVN 2.1.0

© copyright 1999-2024 OpenCores.org, equivalent to Oliscience, all rights reserved. OpenCores®, registered trademark.